+ All Categories
Home > Documents > 2003-avalon.pdf - Dealer E Process

2003-avalon.pdf - Dealer E Process

Date post: 07-Feb-2023
Category:
Upload: khangminh22
View: 0 times
Download: 0 times
Share this document with a friend
350
’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206) i 2003 AVALON (OM41401U) Foreword Welcome to the growing group of valueconscious people who drive Toyotas. We are proud of the advanced engineering and quality construction of each vehicle we build. This Owner’s Manual explains the operation of your new Toyota. Please read it thoroughly and have all the occupants follow the instructions carefully. Doing so will help you enjoy many years of safe and troublefree motoring. For important information about this manual and your Toyota, read the following pages carefully. When it comes to service, remember that your Toyota dealer knows your vehicle best and is interested in your complete satisfaction. He will provide quality maintenance and any other assistance you may require. If there is not a Toyota dealer near you, or you need emergency assistance for any reason, please call the following number: D U.S. OWNERS: Toyota Customer Assistance Center Tollfree: 18003314331 D CANADIAN OWNERS: Toyota Canada Customer Interaction Centre Tollfree: 1888TOYOTA8 (18888696828) Please leave this Owner’s Manual in this vehicle at the time of resale. The next owner will need this information also. All information and specifications in this manual are current at the time of printing. However, because of Toyota’s policy of continual product improvement, we reserve the right to make changes at any time without notice. Please note that this manual applies to all models and explains all equipment, including options. Therefore, you may find some explanations for equipment not installed on your vehicle. © 2002 TOYOTA MOTOR CORPORATION All rights reserved. This material may not be reproduced or copied, in whole or in part, without the written permission of Toyota Motor Corporation.
Transcript

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

i2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Foreword

Welcome to the growing group of value−conscious people who drive Toyotas. We are proud of the advanced engineering andquality construction of each vehicle we build.

This Owner’s Manual explains the operation of your new Toyota. Please read it thoroughly and have all the occupantsfollow the instructions carefully. Doing so will help you enjoy many years of safe and trouble−free motoring. Forimportant information about this manual and your Toyota, read the following pages carefully.

When it comes to service, remember that your Toyota dealer knows your vehicle best and is interested in your completesatisfaction. He will provide quality maintenance and any other assistance you may require.

If there is not a Toyota dealer near you, or you need emergency assistance for any reason, please call the following number:

� U.S. OWNERS: Toyota Customer Assistance Center Toll−free: 1−800−331−4331

� CANADIAN OWNERS: Toyota Canada Customer Interaction Centre Toll−free: 1−888−TOYOTA−8 (1−888−869−6828)

Please leave this Owner’s Manual in this vehicle at the time of resale. The next owner will need this information also.

All information and specifications in this manual are current at the time of printing. However, because of Toyota’s policy ofcontinual product improvement, we reserve the right to make changes at any time without notice.

Please note that this manual applies to all models and explains all equipment, including options. Therefore, you mayfind some explanations for equipment not installed on your vehicle.

© 2002 TOYOTA MOTOR CORPORATION

All rights reserved. This material may not be reproduced or copied, in whole or in part, without the written permission of ToyotaMotor Corporation.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

ii 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Important information about this manual

Safety and vehicle damage warnings

Throughout this manual, you will see safety and vehicle dam-age warnings. You must follow these warnings carefully toavoid possible injury or damage.

The types of warnings, what they look like, and how they areused in this manual are explained as follows:

CAUTION

This is a warning against something which may causeinjury to people if the warning is ignored. You areinformed about what you must or must not do inorder to avoid or reduce the risk to yourself and otherpeople.

NOTICE

This is a warning against something which may causedamage to the vehicle or its equipment if the warningis ignored. You are informed about what you must ormust not do in order to avoid or reduce the risk ofdamage to your vehicle and its equipment.

Safety symbol

When you see the safety symbolshown above, it means: “Do not...”;“Do not do this”; or “Do not let thishappen”.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

iii 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Important information about your Toyota

New vehicle warranty

Your new vehicle is covered by the following Toyota limitedwarranties:

� New vehicle warranty

� Emission control systems warranty

� Others

For further information, please refer to the “Owner’s War-ranty Information Booklet” or “Owner’s Manual Supple-ment”.

Your responsibility formaintenance

It is the owner’s responsibility to make sure that the speci-fied maintenance is performed. Section 6 gives details ofthese maintenance requirements. Also included in Section6 is general maintenance. For scheduled maintenance in-formation, please refer to the “Scheduled MaintenanceGuide” or “Owner’s Manual Supplement”.

Accessories, spare parts andmodification of your Toyota

A wide variety of non−genuine spare parts and accessoriesfor Toyota vehicles are currently available in the market.You should know that Toyota does not warrant these prod-ucts and is not responsible for their performance, repair, orreplacement, or for any damage they may cause to, oradverse effect they may have on, your Toyota vehicle.

This vehicle should not be modified with non−genuineToyota products. Modification with non−genuine Toyotaproducts could affect its performance, safety or durability,and may even violate governmental regulations. In addi-tion, damage or performance problems resulting from themodification may not be covered under warranty.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

iv 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Spark ignition system of yourToyota

The spark ignition system in your Toyota meets all require-ments of the Canadian Interference−Causing EquipmentStandard.

Installation of a mobile two−wayradio system

As the installation of a mobile two−way radio system inyour vehicle could affect electronic systems such as multi-port fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injectionsystem, cruise control system, anti−lock brake system,traction control system, vehicle skid control system, SRSairbag system and seat belt pretensioner system, be sureto check with your Toyota dealer for precautionary mea-sures or special instructions regarding installation.

Scrapping of your Toyota

The SRS airbag and seat belt pretensioner devices in yourToyota contain explosive chemicals. If the vehicle isscrapped with the airbags and pretensioners left as theyare, this may cause an accident such as fire. Be sure tohave the systems of the SRS airbag and seat belt preten-sioner removed and disposed of by the qualified serviceshop or by your Toyota dealer before you dispose of yourvehicle.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

12003 AVALON (OM41401U)

OPERATION OF INSTRUMENTS ANDCONTROLSOverview of instruments and controlsInstrument panel overview 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Instrument cluster overview 8. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Indicator symbols on the instrument panel 11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 1− 1

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Side vents

2. Side defroster outlets

3. Instrument cluster and/ormulti−information display

4. Garage door opener

5. Center vents

6. Auxiliary boxes

7. Front personal light, interior light and/orelectric moon roof switch

8. Power door lock switches

9. Power window switches

10. Glove box

11. Trunk opener main switch

12. Rear vents

13. Power outlet (115 VAC)

14. Power outlet (12 VDC)

15. Cup holder

16. Automatic transmission selector lever

17. Hood lock release lever

18. Parking brake pedal

19. Window lock switch

Instrument panel overview�With bucket front seat (view A)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

32003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Power rear view mirror control switches

2. Headlight and turn signal switch andfront fog light switch

3. Wiper and washer switches

4. Emergency flasher switch

5. Car audio

6. Air conditioning controls

7. Rear window and outside rear viewmirror defogger switch

8. Cigarette lighter and ashtray

9. Ignition switch

10. Power outlet main switch

11. Traction control system off switch

12. Cruise control switch

13. Tilt steering lock release lever

14. Trunk lid lock release switch

15. Instrument panel light control knob

�With bucket front seat (view B with manual air conditioning controls)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

4 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Power rear view mirror control switches

2. Headlight and turn signal switch andfront fog light switch

3. Wiper and washer switches

4. Emergency flasher switch

5. Car audio

6. Air conditioning controls

7. Rear window and outside rear viewmirror defogger switch

8. Cigarette lighter and ashtray

9. Seat heater switches

10. Ignition switch

11. Power outlet main switch

12. Traction control system off switch

13. Cruise control switch

14. Tilt steering lock release lever

15. Trunk lid lock release switch

16. Instrument panel light control knob

�With bucket front seat (view B with automatic air conditioning controls)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

52003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Side vents

2. Side defroster outlets

3. Instrument cluster and/ormulti−information display

4. Automatic transmission selector lever

5. Garage door opener

6. Center vents

7. Auxiliary boxes

8. Front personal light, interior light and/orelectric moon roof switch

9. Power door lock switches

10. Power window switches

11. Glove box

12. Cup holder

13. Trunk opener main switch

14. Hood lock release lever

15. Parking brake pedal

16. Window lock switch

�With bench type front seat (view A)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

6 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Power rear view mirror control switches

2. Headlight and turn signal switch andfront fog light switch

3. Wiper and washer switches

4. Emergency flasher switch

5. Car audio

6. Air conditioning controls

7. Rear window and outside rear viewmirror defogger switch

8. Cigarette lighter and ashtray

9. Power outlet (115 VAC)

10. Power outlet (12 VDC)

11. Ignition switch

12. Power outlet main switch

13. Traction control system off switch

14. Cruise control switch

15. Tilt steering lock release lever

16. Trunk lid lock release switch

17. Instrument panel light control knob

�With bench type front seat (view B with manual air conditioning controls)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

72003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Power rear view mirror control switches

2. Headlight and turn signal switch andfront fog light switch

3. Wiper and washer switches

4. Emergency flasher switch

5. Car audio

6. Air conditioning controls

7. Rear window and outside rear viewmirror defogger switch

8. Seat heater switches

9. Cigarette lighter and ashtray

10. Power outlet (115 VAC)

11. Power outlet (12 VDC)

12. Ignition switch

13. Power outlet main switch

14. Traction control system off switch

15. Cruise control switch

16. Tilt steering lock release lever

17. Trunk lid lock release switch

18. Instrument panel light control knob

�With bench type front seat (view B with automatic air conditioning controls)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

8 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Engine coolant temperature gauge

2. Tachometer

3. Service reminder indicators andindicator lights

4. Speedometer

5. Engine immobiliser system indicatorlight

6. Odometer and two trip meters

7. Clock

8. Outside temperature display

9. “ADJ” button∗

10. “MODE” button∗

11. “ODO/TRIP” button

12. Fuel gauge

∗: This button is used to adjust the clock. For details, see “Clock” in Section 1−9.

Instrument cluster overview�Type A

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

92003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Engine coolant temperature gauge

2. Tachometer

3. Service reminder indicators andindicator lights

4. Speedometer

5. Theft deterrent system/Engineimmobiliser system indicator light

6. Clock∗

7. Outside temperature display∗

8. Multi−information display

9. “LIGHT” button∗

10. “MODE” button∗

11. “RESET/ADJ” button∗

12. “DISPLAY” button∗

13. Odometer and two trip meters

14. “ODO/TRIP” button

15. Fuel gauge

∗: This button is used to operate the multi−information display. For details, see “Multi−information display” in Section 1−9.

�Type B

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

10 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Engine coolant temperature gauge

2. Tachometer

3. Service reminder indicators andindicator lights

4. Speedometer

5. Theft deterrent system/Engineimmobiliser system indicator light

6. Clock∗

7. Outside temperature display∗

8. Odometer and two trip meters

9. “ODO/TRIP” button

10. Fuel gauge

∗: For details, please refer to the separate “Navigation system Owner’s manual”.

�Type C

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

112003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Brake system warning light∗1

Driver’s seat belt reminder light∗1

Discharge warning light∗1

Malfunction indicator lamp∗1

Low engine oil pressure warning light∗1

or

Low fuel level warning light∗1

Anti−lock brake system warning light∗1or

Open door warning light∗1

Rear light failure warning light∗1

SRS warning light∗1

Low windshield washer fluid level warning light∗1

Front outside passenger’s seat belt reminderlight∗1

Vehicle skid control system and traction controlsystem warning light∗1

Headlight high beam indicator light

Indicator symbols on the instrument panel

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

12 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

∗1: For details, see “Service reminder indicators and warningbuzzers” in Section 1−5.

∗2: If this light flashes, see “Cruise control” in Section 1−6.

Turn signal indicator lights

Slip indicator light

Cruise control indicator light∗2

Overdrive−off indicator light

Automatic transmission indicator lights

Traction control system off indicator light

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

132003 AVALON (OM41401U)

OPERATION OF INSTRUMENTS ANDCONTROLSKeys and DoorsKeys 14. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine immobiliser system 17. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Side doors 18. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power windows 27. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Trunk lid 29. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hood 34. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Theft deterrent system 35. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel tank cap 37. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electric moon roof 38. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 1− 2

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

14 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Your vehicle is supplied with two kindsof keys.

1. Master key—This key works in everylock.

2. Sub key—This key will not work in theglove box, trunk and armrest door inthe rear seat.

To protect things locked in the glove boxor trunk when you have your vehicleparked, leave the sub key with the atten-dant.

Since the doors and trunk lid can belocked without a key, you should alwayscarry a spare master key in case youaccidentally lock your keys inside the ve-hicle.

KEY NUMBER PLATE

Your key number is shown on the plate.Keep the plate in a safe place such asyour wallet, not in the vehicle.

If you should lose your keys or if youneed additional keys, duplicates can bemade by a Toyota dealer using the keynumber.

We recommend you to write down the keynumber and keep it in safe place.

Your vehicle is supplied with two kindsof keys.

1. Master key (black)—This key works inevery lock. Your Toyota dealer willneed it to make you a new key withbuilt−in transponder chip.

2. Sub key (gray)—This key will not workin the glove box, trunk and armrestdoor in the rear seat.

A transponder chip for engine immobilisersystem has been filled in the head of themaster and sub keys. These chips areneeded to enable the system to functioncorrectly, so be careful not to lose thesekeys. If you make your own duplicate key,you will not be able to cancel the systemor start the engine.

Keys (without engineimmobiliser system)

Keys (with engine immobilisersystem)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

152003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To protect things locked in the glove boxor trunk when you have your vehicleparked, leave the sub key with the atten-dant.

Since the doors and trunk lid can belocked without a key, you should alwayscarry a spare master key in case youaccidentally lock your keys inside the ve-hicle.

NOTICE

When using a key containing a trans-ponder chip, observe the followingprecautions:

� When starting the engine, do notuse the key with a key ring restingon the key grip and do not pressthe key ring against the key grip.Otherwise the engine may not start,or may stop soon after it starts.

� When starting the engine, do notuse the key with other transponderkeys around (including keys of oth-er vehicles) and do not press otherkey plates against the key grip.Otherwise the engine may not start,or may stop soon after it starts. Ifthis happens, remove the key onceand then insert it again after takingoff other transponder keys (includ-ing keys of other vehicles) from thering or while gripping or coveringthem with your hand to start theengine.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

16 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Do not bend the key grip.

� Do not cover the key grip with anymaterial that cuts off electromagnet-ic waves.

� Do not knock the key hard againstother objects.

� Do not leave the key exposed tohigh temperatures for a long period,such as on the dashboard and hoodunder the direct sunlight.

� Do not put the key in water orwash it in an ultrasonic washer.

� Do not use the key with electromag-netic materials. KEY NUMBER PLATE

Your key number is shown on the plate.Keep the plate in a safe place such asyour wallet, not in the vehicle.

If you should lose your keys or if youneed additional keys, duplicates can bemade by a Toyota dealer using the keynumber.

We recommend you to write down the keynumber and keep it in safe place.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

172003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The engine immobiliser system is atheft prevention system. When you in-sert the key in the ignition switch, thetransponder chip in the key’s headtransmits an electronic code to the ve-hicle. The engine will start, only whenthe electronic code in the chip corre-sponds to the registered ID code forthe vehicle.

The system is automatically set when thekey is removed from the ignition switch.The indicator light will start flashing toshow the system is set.

If any of the following indicator conditionsoccurs, contact your Toyota dealer.

� The indicator light stays on exceptwhen the theft deterrent system is set-ting or activating. (See “Theft deterrentsystem” in this section.)

� The indicator light does not start flash-ing when the key is removed from theignition switch.

� The indicator light flashes unsteady.

Inserting the registered key in the ignitionswitch automatically cancels the system,which enables the engine to start. Theindicator light will go off.

For your Toyota dealer to make you anew key with built−in transponder chip,your dealer will need your key numberand master key. However, there is a limitto the number of additional keys yourToyota dealer can make for you.

If you make your own duplicate key,you will not be able to cancel the sys-tem or start the engine.

NOTICE

Do not modify, remove or disas-semble the engine immobiliser sys-tem. If any unauthorized changes ormodifications are made, the properoperation of the system cannot beguaranteed.

Engine immobiliser system

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

18 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

For vehicles sold in U.S.A.

FCC ID: MOZ RI−4ETYMADE IN JAPAN

FCC ID: NT8−15607YU3FXCVRMADE IN CANADA

FCC ID: NT8−15607YU3FXCVRMADE IN MEXICO

This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC Rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions:

(1) This device may not cause harmfulinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference received, includ-ing interference that may cause unde-sired operation.

CAUTION

Changes or modifications not ex-pressly approved by the party respon-sible for compliance could void theuser’s authority to operate the equip-ment.

For vehicles sold in Canada

This device complies with RSS−210 ofIndustry Canada. Operation is subject tothe following two conditions:

(1) This device may not cause interfer-ence, and (2) this device must acceptany interference, including interferencethat may cause undesired operation ofthe device.

LOCKING AND UNLOCKING WITH KEY

Insert the key into the keyhole and turnit.

To lock: Turn the key forward.To unlock: Turn the key backward.

All the doors lock and unlock simulta-neously with either front door. In the driv-er’s door lock, turning the key once willunlock the driver’s door and twice in suc-cession will unlock all the doors simulta-neously.

Side doors—

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

192003 AVALON (OM41401U)

When all the doors are unlocked simulta-neously with a key or wireless remotecontrol transmitter, the interior lights andignition switch light come on for about 15seconds and then fade out, even if thedoor is not opened. (For further informa-tion, see “Interior light”, “Front personaland interior lights” and “Ignition switchlight” in Section 1−4.)

LOCKING AND UNLOCKING WITHINSIDE LOCK KNOB

Move the lock knob.

To lock: Push the knob forward.To unlock: Pull the knob backward.

The front doors can be opened by pullingthe inside handle even if the lock knobsare in the locked position.

CAUTION

Do not pull the inside handle of thefront doors while driving. The doorswill open and an accident may occur.Toyota strongly recommends that allchildren be placed in the rear seat ofthe vehicle.

Closing the door with the lock knob in thelock position will also lock the door. Becareful not to lock your keys in the ve-hicle.

The door cannot be locked if you leavethe key in the ignition switch.

If the vehicle is subjected to a severefrontal, rear or side impact with the igni-tion switch turned to the “ON” position, alldoors will unlock automatically after a fewseconds.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

20 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Driver’s side

Passenger’s side

LOCKING AND UNLOCKING WITHPOWER DOOR LOCK SWITCH

Push the switch.

To lock: Push the switch on the front side.To unlock: Push the switch on the rearside.

All the doors lock or unlock simultaneous-ly.

REAR DOOR CHILD−PROTECTORS

Move the lock knob to the “LOCK”position as shown on the label.

This feature allows you to lock a reardoor so it can be opened from the outsideonly, not from inside. We recommend us-ing this feature whenever small childrenare in the vehicle.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

212003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

Before driving, be sure that the doorsare closed and locked, especiallywhen small children are in the ve-hicle. Along with the proper use ofseat belts, locking the doors helpsprevent the driver and passengersfrom being thrown out from the ve-hicle during an accident. It also helpsprevent the doors from being openedunintentionally.

You can select the following modes ofthe automatic locking and unlockingfunctions. The initial mode is mode 1.

� Mode 1—Automatic locking linkedwith the shift position

All doors are automatically locked whenthe selector lever is moved out of the“P” position after the ignition switch isturned to the “ON” position and all thedoors are closed.

� Mode 2—Functions cancelled

Automatic door locking and unlockingfunctions do not activate in this mode.

� Mode 3—Automatic locking and un-locking linked with the shift position

Locking function—All doors are auto-matically locked when the selector le-ver is moved out of the “P” positionafter the ignition switch is turned to the“ON” position and all the doors areclosed.

Unlocking function—All doors are auto-matically unlocked when the selectorlever is moved to the “P” position whenthe ignition switch is turned to the“ON” position.

� Mode 4—Automatic locking and un-locking linked with the shift positionand ignition switch

Locking function—All doors are auto-matically locked when the selector le-ver is moved out of the “P” positionafter the ignition switch is turned to the“ON” position and all the doors areclosed.

Unlocking function—All doors are auto-matically unlocked when the ignitionswitch is turned from the “ON” positionto the “ACC” or “LOCK” position.

CHANGING THE MODE

The mode toggles through from mode1 to mode 4. To change the mode, dothe following:

1. Shift the selector lever into the “P”position and close all doors.

2. Push the power door lock switch onthe rear side to unlock the doors.

3. Turn the ignition switch to the “ON”position.

4. Within 10 seconds after the ignitionswitch is turned to the “ON” position,push and hold the power door lockswitch on the front side for about 5seconds.

—Automatic door locking andunlocking functions

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

22 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

5. Open door warning light will flash toindicate that the mode has beenchanged.

The flashing of the open door warninglight indicates the mode which has beenselected.

� Flashing once, the function haschanged to mode 1.

� Flashing twice, the function haschanged to mode 2.

� Flashing three times, the function haschanged to mode 3.

� Flashing four times, the function haschanged to mode 4.

Locking operation

Unlocking operation

The wireless remote control system isdesigned to lock or unlock all thedoors, open the trunk lid, or activatethe “PANIC” mode from a distancewithin approximately 1 m (3 ft.) of thevehicle.

LOCKING AND UNLOCKING THEDOORS

To lock or unlock all the doors, pushthe “LOCK” or “UNLOCK” switch of thetransmitter slowly and securely.

To lock: Push the “LOCK” switch. All thedoors are locked simultaneously. At thistime one beep will be heard, and parkinglights, side marker lights, license platelights and tail lights flash once.

Check to see that the doors are securelylocked.

If any of the doors is not securely closed,or if the key is in the ignition switch,locking cannot be performed by the“LOCK” switch and a beep will sound con-tinuously for 10 seconds.

—Wireless remote control

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

232003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To unlock: Push the “UNLOCK” switchonce to unlock the driver’s door alone.Pushing the switch twice within 3 secondsunlocks all the doors simultaneously. Eachtime the “UNLOCK” switch is pushed, twobeeps will be heard, and the parkinglights, side marker lights, license platelights and tail lights flash twice.

If the ignition key is in the “ON” position,unlocking cannot be performed by the“UNLOCK” switch.

When all the doors are unlocked simulta-neously with a key or wireless remotecontrol transmitter, the interior lights andignition switch light come on for about 15seconds and then fade out, even if thedoor is not opened. (For further informa-tion, see “Interior light”, “Front personaland interior lights” and “Ignition switchlight” in Section 1−4.)

You have 30 seconds to open a door afterusing the wireless remote unlock feature.If a door is not opened by then, all thedoors will be automatically locked again.

If the “LOCK” or “UNLOCK” switch is keptpressed in, the locking or unlocking opera-tion is not repeated. Release the buttonand then push again.

OPENING THE TRUNK LID

To open the trunk lid, push the trunklid open switch of the transmitter for 1second. A long beep will sound.

If the ignition key is in the “ON” position,the trunk lid cannot be opened by thetrunk lid open switch.

To open the trunk lid with the master key,see “Trunk lid” in this section.

“PANIC” SWITCH

Pushing the “PANIC” switch blows thehorn intermittently and flashes theheadlights, tail lights and interior light.

The “PANIC” switch is used to deter ve-hicle theft when you witness anyone at-tempting to break into or damage yourvehicle.

The alarm will last for one minute. To stopalarm midway, do the following:

� Push the “PANIC” switch once again.

� Unlock any doors with the key or wire-less remote control transmitter.

� Open the trunk lid with the key or wire-less remote control transmitter.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

24 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Turn the key from the “LOCK” to “ON”position.

The “PANIC” mode does not work whenthe ignition key is in the “ON” position.

SWITCHING BEEP SOUND ON AND OFF

You can switch the beep sound on andoff. (The beep sound is on initially andafter battery replacement.)

To switch the beep sound on and off:

With the driver’s door opened—

1. Insert the ignition key and remove it.

2. Within 5 seconds, insert the ignitionkey again and turn it to the “ON” posi-tion.

3. After 10 seconds, push the same“LOCK”, “UNLOCK”, “PANIC” or trunklid open switch twice within 10 sec-onds.Two beep sounds inform you that theprogram has been switched on or off.

If this procedure is not followed exactly,the beep sound will not operate as ex-pected.

Check the beep sound ON/OFF operationby pushing the transmitter switch after youfinish this procedure. If the beep does notoperate as expected, repeat this proce-dure from step 1.

WIRELESS REMOTE CONTROLTRANSMITTER

The wireless remote control transmitter isan electronic component. Observe the fol-lowing instructions in order not to causedamage to the transmitter.

� Do not leave the transmitter on placeswhere the temperature becomes highsuch as on the dashboard.

� Do not disassemble it.

� Avoid knocking it hard against otherobjects or dropping it.

� Avoid putting it in water.

You can use up to 4 wireless remote con-trol transmitters for the same vehicle.Contact your Toyota dealer for detailedinformation.

If the wireless remote control transmitterdoes not actuate the doors or trunk lid, oroperate from a normal distance:

� Check for closeness to a radio trans-mitter such as a radio station or anairport which can interfere with normaloperation of the transmitter.

� The battery may have been consumed.Check the battery in the transmitter. Toreplace the battery, see following“REPLACING TRANSMITTERBATTERY”.

If you lose your transmitter, contact yourToyota dealer as soon as possible toavoid the possibility of theft, or an acci-dent. (See “If you lose your wireless re-mote control transmitter” in Section 4.)

For vehicles sold in U.S.A.

This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC Rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions:

(1) This device may not cause harmfulinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference received, includ-ing interference that may cause unde-sired operation.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

252003 AVALON (OM41401U)

NOTICE:This equipment has been tested andfound to comply with the limits for aClass B digital device, pursuant to Part15 of the FCC Rules. These limits aredesigned to provide reasonable protec-tion against harmful interference in aresidential installation. This equipmentgenerates, uses and can radiate radiofrequency energy and, if not installedand used in accordance with the instruc-tions, may cause harmful interference toradio communications. However, thereis no guarantee that interference will notoccur in a particular installation. If thisequipment does cause harmful interfer-ence to radio or television reception,which can be determined by turning theequipment off and on, the user is en-couraged to try to correct the interfer-ence by one or more of the followingmeasures:

� Reorient or relocate the receiving an-tenna.

� Increase the separation between theequipment and receiver.

� Connect the equipment into an outleton a circuit different from that towhich the receiver is connected.

� Consult the dealer or an experiencedradio/TV technician for help.

FCC WARNING:Changes or modifications not ex-pressly approved by the party respon-sible for compliance could void theuser’s authority to operate the equip-ment.

For vehicles sold in Canada

Operation is subject to the following twoconditions:

(1) this device may not cause interfer-ence, and (2) this device must acceptany interference, including interferencethat may cause undesired operation ofthe device.

REPLACING TRANSMITTER BATTERY

For replacement, use a CR2016 lithiumbattery or equivalent.

CAUTION

Special care should be taken thatsmall children do not swallow the re-moved transmitter battery or compo-nents.

NOTICE

� When replacing the transmitter bat-tery, be careful not to lose the com-ponents.

� Replace only with the same orequivalent type recommended by aToyota dealer.

� Dispose of used batteries accordingto the local laws.

Replace the transmitter battery by the fol-lowing procedures:

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

26 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Using a coin or equivalent, open thetransmitter case.

2. Push the edge of the discharged trans-mitter battery and lift it out as shownin the above illustration.

3. Put a new transmitter battery with posi-tive (+) side up.

Close the transmitter case securely.

NOTICE

� Make sure the positive side andnegative side of the transmitter bat-tery should be faced correctly.

� Do not replace the battery with wethands. Water may cause unexpectedrust.

� Do not touch or move any compo-nents inside of the transmitter, orit may interfere with proper opera-tion.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

272003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Be careful not to bend the electrodeof the transmitter battery insertionand that dust or oils do not adhereto the transmitter case.

� Close the transmitter case securely.

After replacing battery, check that thetransmitter operates properly. If the trans-mitter still does not operate properly, con-tact your Toyota dealer.

The windows can be operated with theswitch on each door.

The power windows work when the ignitionswitch is in the “ON” position.

Key off operation: All windows work forabout 43 seconds even after the ignitionswitch is turned off. They stop workingwhen either front door is opened.

OPERATING THE DRIVER’S WINDOW

Use the switch on the driver’s door.

Normal operation: The window moves aslong as you hold the switch.

To open: Lightly push down the switch.To close: Lightly pull up the switch.

Automatic operation: Push the switchcompletely down or pull it completely up,and then release it. The window will fullyopen or close. To stop the window part-way, lightly move the switch in the oppo-site direction and then release it.

Power windows

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

28 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Jam protection function: During automat-ic closing operation or key off closing op-eration, the window stops and opens halfway if something gets caught between thewindow and window frame.

If the window receives a strong impact,this function may work even if nothing iscaught.

CAUTION

� Never try jamming any part of yourbody to make the jam protectionfunction work intentionally.

� The jam protection function maynot work if something gets caughtjust before the window is fullyclosed.

Windowlock switch

OPERATING THE PASSENGERS’WINDOWS

Use the switches on the passengers’doors. The driver’s door also hasswitches that control the passengers’windows.

The window moves as long as you holdthe switch.

To open: Push down the switch.To close: Pull up the switch.

If you push in the window lock switch onthe driver’s door, the passengers’ windowscannot be operated.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

292003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

To avoid serious personal injury, youmust do the following.

� Always make sure the heads, handsand other parts of the bodies of alloccupants are kept completely in-side the vehicle before you closethe power windows. If someone’sneck, head or hands get caught ina closing window, it could result ina serious injury. When anyonecloses the power windows, makesure that he/she operates the win-dows safely.

� When small children are in the ve-hicle, never let them use the powerwindow switches without supervi-sion. Use the window lock switch toprevent them from making unex-pected use of the switches.

� Never leave small children alone inthe vehicle, especially with the igni-tion key still inserted. They coulduse the power window switches andget trapped in a window. Unat-tended children can be involved inserious accidents.

To open the trunk lid from the outside,insert the master key and turn it clock-wise.

See “Luggage stowage precautions” inSection 2 for precautions in loading lug-gage.

To close the trunk lid, lower it and pressdown on it. After closing the trunk lid, trypulling it up to make sure it is securelyclosed.

Vehicles with wireless remote control sys-tem—The trunk lid can be opened with thewireless remote control transmitter, see“—Wireless remote control” in this section.

CAUTION

Keep the trunk lid closed while driv-ing. This not only keeps the luggagefrom being thrown out but also pre-vents exhaust gases from enteringthe vehicle.

Trunk lid (lock release lever type)—

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

30 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To open the trunk lid from the driver’sseat, pull up on the lock release lever.

To deactivate this lock release lever fromopening the trunk lid, see “—Luggage se-curity system” described below.

This system deactivates the lock re-lease lever so that things locked in thetrunk can be protected.

1. After closing the armrest door, insertthe master key and turn it clockwiseto lock the armrest door.

2. After closing the trunk lid, insert themaster key and turn it counterclock-wise to deactivate the lock releaselever.

After closing the trunk lid, try pulling it upto make sure it is securely locked.

—Lock release lever —Luggage security system

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

312003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If a person is locked in the trunk, heor she can pull down the phosphores-cent handle lever on the inside of trunklid in case of emergency to open thetrunk lid.

The phosphorescent (glow−in−the−dark)handle will continue to glow for a timeafter the trunk lid is closed. Exposing thehandle to stronger light will cause it toglow longer.

CAUTION

� Always lock the trunk lid and alldoors, and keep away the vehiclekeys out of children’s reaches.

� Never leave children unattended inthe vehicle. Unsupervised childrenmay lock themselves in the vehicleor trunk and suffer serious injuriesor death.

To open the trunk lid from the outside,insert the master key and turn it clock-wise.

See “Luggage stowage precautions” inSection 2 for precautions in loading lug-gage.

To close the trunk lid, lower it and pressdown on it. After closing the trunk lid, trypulling it up to make sure it is securelyclosed.

Vehicles with wireless remote control sys-tem—The trunk lid can be opened with thewireless remote control transmitter, see“—Wireless remote control” in this section.

—Internal trunk release handleTrunk lid (lock release switch type)—

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

32 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

Keep the trunk lid closed while driv-ing. This not only keeps the luggagefrom being thrown out but also pre-vents exhaust gases from enteringthe vehicle.

To open the trunk lid from the driver’sseat, push the lock release switch.

To deactivate this lock release switch fromopening the trunk lid, see “—Trunk openermain switch” described below.

On Off

If you do not want to activate the trunklid opener system, turn off the trunkopener main switch in the glove box.To turn it on, push in the trunk openermain switch.

—Lock release switch —Trunk opener main switch

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

332003 AVALON (OM41401U)

This system helps protect things lockedin the trunk by safeguarding the trunkopener main switch from unwanted ac-cess.

1. To cancel the lock release switch,turn off the trunk opener mainswitch in the glove box.

2. After closing the glove box lid, in-sert the master key into the glovebox lock and turn it clockwise tosafeguard the lock release switch.

3. After closing the armrest door, insertthe master key and turn it clockwiseto lock the armrest door.

After closing the trunk lid, try pulling it upto make sure it is securely locked.

—Luggage security system

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

34 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If a person is locked in the trunk, heor she can pull down the phosphores-cent handle lever on the inside of trunklid in case of emergency to open thetrunk lid.

The phosphorescent (glow−in−the−dark)handle will continue to glow for a timeafter the trunk lid is closed. Exposing thehandle to stronger light will cause it toglow longer.

CAUTION

� Always lock the trunk lid and alldoors, and keep away the vehiclekeys out of children’s reaches.

� Never leave children unattended inthe vehicle. Unsupervised childrenmay lock themselves in the vehicleor trunk and suffer serious injuriesor death.

To open the hood:

1. Pull the hood lock release lever. Thehood will spring up slightly.

CAUTION

Before driving, be sure that the hoodis closed and securely locked. Other-wise, the hood may open unexpected-ly while driving and an accident mayoccur.

—Internal trunk release handle Hood

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

352003 AVALON (OM41401U)

2. In front of the vehicle, pull up theauxiliary catch lever and lift thehood.

Before closing the hood, check to see thatyou have not forgotten any tools, rags,etc. Then lower the hood and make sureit locks into place. If necessary, pressdown gently on the front edge to lock it.

To deter the vehicle theft, the systemis designed to sound an alarm if any ofthe doors, trunk or hood is forcibly un-locked or the battery terminal is discon-nected and then reconnected when thevehicle is locked.

The alarm blows the horn intermittentlyand flashes the headlights, tail lights andinterior light.

SETTING THE SYSTEM

1. Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK”position and remove it.

The indicator light will start flashing whenthe key is removed from the ignitionswitch. (See “Engine immobiliser system”for details.)

2. Have all passengers get out of thevehicle.

3. Close and lock all the doors, trunk andhood.

The indicator light will remain on when allthe doors, trunk and hood are closed andlocked.

Theft deterrent system

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

36 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The system will automatically be set after30 seconds. When the system is set, theindicator light will start flashing again.

4. After making sure the indicator lightstarts flashing, you may leave the ve-hicle.

Never leave anyone in the vehicle whenyou set the system, because unlockingfrom the inside will activate the system.

WHEN THE SYSTEM IS SET

Activating the system

The system will give the alarm under thefollowing conditions:

� If any of the doors is unlocked or ifthe trunk or hood is forcibly openedwithout the key or wireless remote con-trol transmitter.

� If the battery terminal is disconnectedand then reconnected.

� If the ignition is hotwired.

The indicator light will come on when thesystem is activating.

If any of the doors is unlocked without thekey or wireless remote control transmitterand the key is not in the ignition switch,all the doors will be automatically lockedagain.

After one minute, the alarm will automati-cally stop and the indicator light will startflashing again.

Reactivating the alarm

Once set, the system automatically resetsthe alarm after the alarm stops.

The alarm will activate again under thesame circumstances described in“Activating the system”.

Stopping the alarm

The alarm will be stopped by the followingthree ways:

� Turn the ignition key from the “LOCK”to “ON” position.

� Unlock any of the doors with the keyor wireless remote control transmitter.

� Open the trunk with the key or wirelessremote control transmitter.

CANCELLING THE SYSTEM

The system will be cancelled by theabove mentioned 3 ways.

If the tail lights come on for 2 seconds,the theft deterrent system has beenalarmed. Check to see if there is anyabnormality on your vehicle.

TESTING THE SYSTEM

1. Open all the windows.

2. Set the system as described above.The doors should be locked with thekey or wireless remote control transmit-ter. Be sure to wait until the indicatorlight starts flashing.

3. Unlock any door from the inside. Thesystem should activate the alarm.

4. Stopping the alarm as described above.

5. Repeat this operation for the otherdoors, trunk and hood. When testing onthe hood, also check that the systemis activated when the battery terminalis disconnected and then reconnected.

If the system does not work properly,have it checked by your Toyota dealer.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

372003 AVALON (OM41401U)

This indicates that the fuel filler dooris on the left side of your vehicle.

1. To open the fuel filler door, pull thelever up.

When refueling, turn off the engine.

CAUTION

� Do not smoke, cause sparks or al-low open flames when refueling.The fumes are flammable.

� When opening the cap, do not re-move the cap quickly. In hot weath-er, fuel under pressure could causeinjury by spraying out of the fillerneck if the cap is suddenly re-moved.

2. To remove the fuel tank cap, turnthe cap slowly counterclockwise,then pause slightly before removingit. After removing the cap, hang iton the cap hanger.

It is not unusual to hear a slight swooshwhen the cap is opened. When installing,turn the cap clockwise till you hear aclick.

If the cap is not tightened securely, themalfunction indicator lamp comes on.Make sure the cap is tightened securely.

The indicator lamp goes off after drivingseveral times. If the indicator lamp doesnot go off, contact your Toyota dealer assoon as possible.

Fuel tank cap

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

38 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

� Make sure the cap is tightened se-curely to prevent fuel spillage incase of an accident.

� Use only a genuine Toyota fuel tankcap for replacement. It is designedto regulate fuel tank pressure.

Sliding operation

Tilting operation

To operate the moon roof, use theswitch beside the front personal lights.

The moon roof works when the ignitionswitch is in the “ON” position. However,if both front doors are closed, it works forabout 43 seconds even after the ignitionswitch is turned off. It stops working wheneither of the front doors is opened.

Sun shade operation—

The sun shade can be opened or closedby hand.

Sliding operation—

To open: Push the switch on the “SLIDEOPEN” side.

The roof will open and stop partway 10mm (0.4 in.) from the fully opened posi-tion. When you push “SLIDE OPEN” sideagain, the moon roof will open fully. Tostop the roof partway, push the switch oneither the “SLIDE OPEN” or “TILT UP”side briefly while the roof is moving.

As driving with the moon roof opened fullywill cause wind throbs, we recommendyou to drive with the moon roof partway10 mm (0.4 in.) from the fully openedposition.

The sun shade will be opened togetherwith the roof.

Electric moon roof

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

392003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To close: Push the switch on the “TILTUP” side.

The roof will fully close. To stop the roofpartway, push the switch on either the“SLIDE OPEN” or “TILT UP” side briefly.

Tilting operation—

To tilt up: Push the switch on the “TILTUP” side.To tilt down: Push the switch on the“SLIDE OPEN” side.

You may stop the moon roof at any de-sired position. The roof will move whilethe switch is being pushed and stop whenreleased.

Jam protection function (closing opera-tion only): During closing operation, themoon roof stops and opens half way ifsomething gets caught between the moonroof and frame.

If the moon roof receives a strong impact,this function may work even if nothing iscaught.

CAUTION

To avoid serious personal injury, youmust do the following.

� While the vehicle is moving, alwayskeep the heads, hands and otherparts of the bodies of all occupantsaway from the roof opening. Other-wise, they could be seriously in-jured if the vehicle stops suddenlyor if the vehicle is involved in anaccident.

� Always make sure nobody placeshis/her head, hands and other partsof the body in the roof opening be-fore you close the roof. If some-one’s neck, head or hands getcaught in the closing roof, it couldresult in a serious injury. Whenanyone closes the roof, first makesure it is safe to do so.

� Never leave small children alone inthe vehicle, especially with the igni-tion key still inserted. They coulduse the moon roof switches and gettrapped in the roof opening. Unat-tended children can be involved inserious accidents.

� Never sit on top of the vehiclearound the roof opening.

� Never try jamming any part of yourbody to make the jam protectionfunction work intentionally.

� The jam protection function maynot work if something gets caughtjust before the moon roof is fullyclosed.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

40 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

412003 AVALON (OM41401U)

OPERATION OF INSTRUMENTS ANDCONTROLSSeats, Seat belts, Steering wheel and MirrorsSeats 42. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front seats 42. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Driving position memory system 45. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Trunk storage extension 47. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Head restraints 48. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Armrest 49. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seat heaters 49. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seat belts 50. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SRS driver airbag and front passenger airbag 60. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SRS side airbags 68. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Child restraint 73. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tilt steering wheel 92. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Outside rear view mirrors 93. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Anti−glare inside rear view mirror 94. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Auto anti−glare inside rear view mirror 95. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vanity mirrors 96. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 1− 3

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

42 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

While the vehicle is being driven, all ve-hicle occupants should have the seatbackupright, sit well back in the seat and prop-erly wear the seat belts provided.

CAUTION

� Do not drive the vehicle unless theoccupants are properly seated. Donot allow sitting on top of afolded−down seatback, or in theluggage compartment or cargo area.Persons not properly seated and/orproperly restrained by seat beltscan be severely injured in the eventof emergency braking or a collision.

� During driving, do not allow pas-sengers to stand up or movearound between seats. Severe inju-ries can occur in the event of emer-gency braking or a collision.

CAUTION

The SRS side airbags are installed inthe driver and front passenger seats.Observe the following precautions.

� Do not lean against the front doorwhen the vehicle is in use, sincethe side airbag inflates with consid-erable speed and force. Otherwise,you may be killed or seriously in-jured. Special care should be takenespecially when you have a smallchild in the vehicle.

� Do not use seat accessories whichcover the parts where the side air-bags inflate. Such accessories mayprevent the side airbags from acti-vating correctly, causing death orserious injury.

� Do not modify or replace the seatsor upholstery of the front seatswith the side airbags. Such changesmay disable the system or causethe side airbags to inflate acciden-tally resulting in death or seriousinjury. Consult your Toyota dealer ifyou insist on modifications of thiskind.

Adjust the driver’s seat so that the footpedals, steering wheel and instrumentpanel controls are within easy reach ofthe driver.

CAUTION

� Adjustments should not be madewhile the vehicle is moving, as theseat may unexpectedly move andcause the driver to lose control ofthe vehicle.

� When adjusting the seat, be carefulthat the seat does not hit a passen-ger or luggage.

� After adjusting the seat position,try sliding it forward and backwardto make sure it is locked in posi-tion.

� After adjusting the seatback, pushback your body to make sure it islocked in position.

SeatsFront seats——Front seat precautions —Seat adjustment precautions

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

432003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Do not put objects under the seats.Otherwise, the objects may interferewith the seat−lock mechanism orunexpectedly push up the seat posi-tion adjusting lever and the seatmay suddenly move, causing thedriver to lose control of the vehicle.

� While adjusting the seat, do not putyour hands under the seat or nearthe moving parts. Otherwise, youmay catch and injure your hands orfingers.

1. SEAT POSITION ADJUSTING LEVER

Hold the center of the lever and pull itup. Then slide the seat to the desiredposition with slight body pressure andrelease the lever.

2. SEAT CUSHION ANGLE ADJUSTINGKNOB

Turn the knob either way.

3. SEATBACK ANGLE ADJUSTINGLEVER

Lean forward and pull the lever up.Then lean back to the desired angleand release the lever.

—Adjusting front seats(manual seat)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

44 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

To reduce the risk of sliding underthe lap belt during a collision, avoidreclining the seatback any more thanneeded. The seat belts provide maxi-mum protection in a frontal or rearcollision when the driver and the pas-senger are sitting up straight andwell back in the seats. If you arereclined, the lap belt may slide pastyour hips and apply restraint forcesdirectly to the abdomen. In the eventof a frontal collision, the more theseat is reclined, the greater the riskof personal injury.

1. SEAT POSITION AND SEAT CUSHIONANGLE ADJUSTING SWITCH

Move the control switch in the desireddirection.

Releasing the switch will stop the seat atthat position.

Do not place anything under the frontseats, as this might interfere with the seatmovement.

2. SEATBACK ANGLE ADJUSTINGSWITCH

Move the control switch in the desireddirection.

Releasing the switch will stop the seat-back at that position.

—Adjusting front seats (powerseat)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

452003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

To reduce the risk of sliding underthe lap belt during a collision, avoidreclining the seatback any more thanneeded. The seat belts provide maxi-mum protection in a frontal or rearcollision when the driver and the pas-senger are sitting up straight andwell back in the seats. If you arereclined, the lap belt may slide pastyour hips and apply restraint forcesdirectly to the abdomen. In the eventof a frontal collision, the more theseat is reclined, the greater the riskof personal injury.

3. SEAT LUMBAR SUPPORTADJUSTING SWITCH

Push the switch on either side.

The amount of lumbar support will changewhile the switch is pushed.

The micro computer can memorize theposition of the driver’s seat and outsiderear view mirror. Two different drivingposition profiles can be entered intocomputer’s memory.

Recording a driving position in thecomputer’s memory can only be donewhen the ignition key is in the “ON”position and the automatic transmissionselector lever is in the “P” position.

SETTING THE DRIVING POSITION

1. Adjust the driver’s seat and outsiderear view mirror to the desired posi-tion.

2. While pushing the “SET” button,push button “1” or “2” until the sig-nal beeps.

The beep sound means that the positionsare recorded in the computer’s memory.

By repeating these two steps and pressingthe remaining button, the driving positionfor another driver can be recorded.

To set a new memorized position, selectthe desired position and perform step 2.The previous memory will be erased anda new position will be set.

Driving position memorysystem

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

46 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To make only slight changes to an alreadymemorized position, the easiest way is tofirst activate the memorized position, thenmake the desired changes and performstep 2 above.

RECALLING THE MEMORIZED POSITION

When you push button “1” or “2”, thedriving position will be automaticallyadjusted to the position recorded forthat button.

CONDITIONS FOR MEMORIZEDPOSITION ACTIVATION

� Ignition key “ON” and shift lever in “P”positionAll parts of the memorized positionscan be activated. However, if the brakepedal is being depressed, the seatposition will not change.

� Key not in ignition switch and within 30seconds of opening driver’s doorThe memorized position can be acti-vated.

If any driving position memory switch ispushed while one of the memorized driv-ing position profiles is being activated, theoperation will stop.

To reactivate the system, push the desiredbutton (“1” or “2”) again.

The driving position memory control sys-tem cannot be operated while the vehicleis moving.

If the vehicle’s battery is disconnected,the computer’s memory will be erased andthe memorized position will have to be setagain.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

472003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

� Do not start the vehicle while theadjustment are being made.

� Take care not to select the wrongbutton, or the seat could strike therear passenger or hit your bodyagainst the steering wheel. If thishappens, you can stop the move-ment by pressing another drivingposition memory switch, or de-pressing the brake pedal.

1. Pull down the armrest in the rearseat.

2. Push down the handle of the armrestdoor and open the armrest door.

Access to the trunk can be prevented bylocking the armrest door with the masterkey.

To lock: Turn the key clockwise.

See “Luggage stowage precautions” inSection 2 for precautions in loading lug-gage.

Trunk storage extension

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

48 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

Be sure to close the door when thetrunk storage extension is not in use.Luggage or cargo in the trunk may bethrown into the passenger compart-ment in a sudden stop or crash re-sulting in injury.

Front

Rear

For your safety and comfort, adjust thehead restraint before driving.

To raise: Pull it up.To lower: Push it down while pressing thelock release button.

Rear center head restraint—When an oc-cupant sits on the rear center seat, al-ways pull up the rear center head re-straint to the lock position.

The head restraint is most effective whenit is close to your head. Therefore, usinga cushion on the seatback is not recom-mended.

CAUTION

� Adjust the center of the head re-straint so that it is closest to thetop of your ears.

� After adjusting the head restraint,make sure it is locked in position.

� Do not drive with the head re-straints removed.

Head restraints

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

492003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Front (bench type front seat only)

Rear

Front—To use the armrest, pull up thestrap and pull down the armrest asshown above.

Rear—To use the armrest, pull it downas shown above.

For driver

For front outside passenger

Armrest Seat heaters

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

50 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To turn on the seat heater, push theswitch.

At this time, the indicator light will illu-minate to indicate the seat heater isoperating.

The key must be in the “ON” position.

Pushing the switch again will turn it off.

CAUTION

Occupants must use caution when op-erating the seat heater because itmay make them feel too hot or causeburns at low temperatures (erythema,varicella). Use extra caution for;

� Babies, small children, elderly per-sons, sick persons or handicappedpersons

� Persons who have delicate skin

� Persons who are exhausted

� Persons who have taken alcohol ordrugs which induce sleep (sleepingdrug, cold remedy, etc.)

To prevent the seat overheating, donot use the seat heater with a blan-ket, cushion, or other insulating ob-jects which cover the seat.

NOTICE

� Do not put unevenly weighed ob-jects on the seat and do not sticksharp objects (needles, nails, etc.)into the seat.

� When cleaning the seats, do notuse organic substances (paint thin-ner, benzine, alcohol, gasoline,etc.). They may damage the heaterand seat surface.

� To prevent the battery from beingdischarge, turn the switch off whenthe engine is not running.

Toyota strongly urges that the driver andpassengers in the vehicle be properly re-strained at all times with the seat beltsprovided. Failure to do so could increasethe chance of injury and/or the severity ofinjury in accidents.

Child. Use a child restraint system ap-propriate for the child until the child be-comes large enough to properly wear thevehicle’s seat belts. See “Child restraint”for details.

If a child is too large for a child restraintsystem, the child should sit in the rearseat and must be restrained using thevehicle’s seat belt. According to accidentstatistics, the child is safer when properlyrestrained in the rear seat than in thefront seat.

If a child must sit in the front seat, theseat belts should be worn properly. If anaccident occurs and the seat belts are notworn properly, the force of the rapid infla-tion of the airbag may cause death orserious injury to the child.

Seat belts——Seat belt precautions

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

512003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Do not allow the child to stand up orkneel on either rear or front seats. Anunrestrained child could suffer serious in-jury or death during emergency braking ora collision. Also, do not let the child siton your lap. It does not provide sufficientrestraint.

Pregnant woman. Toyota recommends theuse of a seat belt. Ask your doctor forspecific recommendations. The lap beltshould be worn securely and as low aspossible over the hips and not on thewaist.

Injured person. Toyota recommends theuse of a seat belt. Depending on the inju-ry, first check with your doctor for specificrecommendations.

CAUTION

Persons should ride in their seatsproperly wearing their seat beltswhenever the vehicle is moving.Otherwise, they are much more likelyto suffer serious bodily injury ordeath in the event of sudden brakingor a collision.

When using the seat belts, observethe following:

� Use the belt for only one person ata time. Do not use a single belt fortwo or more people—even children.

� Avoid reclining the seatbacks toomuch. The seat belts provide maxi-mum protection when the seatbacksare in the upright position. (Referto the seat adjustment instructions.)

� Be careful not to damage the beltwebbing or hardware. Take care thatthey do not get caught or pinchedin the seat or doors.

� Inspect the belt system periodically.Check for cuts, fraying, and looseparts. Damaged parts should be re-placed. Do not disassemble ormodify the system.

� Keep the belts clean and dry. Ifthey need cleaning, use a mild soapsolution or lukewarm water. Neveruse bleach, dye, or abrasive clean-ers—they may severely weaken thebelts. (See “Cleaning the interior”in Section 5.)

� Replace the belt assembly (includ-ing bolts) if it has been used in asevere impact. The entire assemblyshould be replaced even if damageis not obvious.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

52 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Adjust the seat as needed (front seatsonly) and sit up straight and well backin the seat. To fasten your belt, pull itout of the retractor and insert the tabinto the buckle.

You will hear a click when the tab locksinto the buckle.

The seat belt length automatically adjuststo your size and the seat position.

The retractor will lock the belt during asudden stop or on impact. It also maylock if you lean forward too quickly. Aslow, easy motion will allow the belt toextend, and you can move around freely.

If the seat belt cannot be pulled out of theretractor, firmly pull the belt and releaseit. You will then be able to smoothly pullthe belt out of the retractor.

When a passenger’s shoulder belt is com-pletely extended and is then retractedeven slightly, the belt is locked in thatposition and cannot be extended. This fea-ture is used to hold the child restraintsystem securely. (For details, see “Childrestraint” in this section.) To free the beltagain, fully retract the belt and then pullthe belt out once more.

CAUTION

� After inserting the tab, make surethe tab and buckle are locked andthat the belt is not twisted.

� Do not insert coins, clips, etc. inthe buckle as this may prevent youfrom properly latching the tab andbuckle.

� If the seat belt does not functionnormally, immediately contact yourToyota dealer. Do not use the seatuntil the seat belt is fixed. It cannotprotect an adult occupant or yourchild from injury.

Seat belts with an adjustable shoulderanchor—

Adjust the shoulder anchor position toyour size.

To raise: Slide the anchor up.To lower: Push in the lock release buttonand slide the anchor down.

After adjustment, make sure the anchor islocked in position.

—Front outside and rear seatbelts (3−point type)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

532003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

Always make sure the shoulder beltis positioned across the center ofyour shoulder. The belt should bekept away from your neck, but notfalling off your shoulder. Failure todo so could reduce the amount ofprotection in an accident and causeserious injuries in a collision.

Take upslack

Too high

Keep as low onhips as possible

Adjust the position of the lap andshoulder belts.

Position the lap belt as low as possibleon your hips—not on your waist, then ad-just it to a snug fit by pulling the shoulderportion upward through the latch plate.

CAUTION

� Both high−positioned lap belts andloose−fitting belts could cause seri-ous injuries due to sliding underthe lap belt during a collision orother unintended result. Keep thelap belt positioned as low on hipsas possible.

� For your safety, do not place theshoulder belt under your arm.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

54 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To release the belt, press the buckle−re-lease button and allow the belt to re-tract.

If the belt does not retract smoothly, pullit out and check for kinks or twists. Thenmake sure it remains untwisted as it re-tracts.

Lengthen

Sit up straight and well back in theseat. To fasten your belt, insert the tabinto the buckle.

You will hear a click when the tab locksinto the buckle.

If the belt is not long enough for you, holdthe tab at a right angle to the belt andpull on the tab.

CAUTION

� After inserting the tab, make surethe tab and buckle are locked andthat the belt is not twisted.

� Do not insert coins, clips, etc. inthe buckle as this may prevent youfrom properly latching the tab andbuckle.

� If the seat belt does not functionnormally, immediately contact yourToyota dealer. Do not use the seatuntil the seat belt is fixed. It cannotprotect an adult occupant or yourchild from injury.

—Front center seat belt(2−point type)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

552003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Too high

Adjust to a snug fit

Keep as low on hips as possible

Remove excess length of the belt andadjust the belt position.

To shorten the belt, pull the free end ofthe belt.

Position the lap belt as low as possibleon your hips—not on your waist, then ad-just it to a snug fit.

CAUTION

Both high−positioned and loose−fit-ting lap belts could cause serious in-juries due to sliding under the lapbelt during a collision or other unin-tended result. Keep the lap belt posi-tioned as low on hips as possible.

To release the belt, press the buckle−re-lease button.

The front center seat belt can bestowed when not in use.

—Stowing the front centerseat belt

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

56 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If your seat belts cannot be fastened se-curely because they are not long enough,a personalized seat belt extender is avail-able from your Toyota dealer free ofcharge.

Please contact your local Toyota dealer sothat the dealer can order the proper re-quired length for the extender. Bring theheaviest coat you expect to wear for prop-er measurement and selection of length.Additional ordering information is availableat your Toyota dealer.

CAUTION

When using the seat belt extender,observe the following precautions.Failure to follow these instructionscould reduce the effectiveness of theseat belt restraint system in case ofvehicle accident, increasing thechance of personal injury.

� Never use the seat belt extender ifyou can fasten the seat belt withoutit.

� Remember that the extender pro-vided for you may not be safe whenused on a different vehicle, foranother person or at a differentseating position, than the one origi-nally intended.

To connect the extender to the seatbelt, insert the tab into the seat beltbuckle so that the “PRESS” signs onthe buckle−release buttons of the ex-tender and the seat belt are both facingoutward as shown.

You will hear a click when the tab locksinto the buckle.

When releasing the seat belt, press onthe buckle−release button on the extender,not on the seat belt. This helps preventdamage to the vehicle interior and extend-er itself.

When not in use, remove the extenderand store in the vehicle for future use.

—Seat belt extender

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

572003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

� After inserting the tab, make surethe tab and buckle are locked andthat the seat belt extender is nottwisted.

� Do not insert coins, clips, etc. inthe buckle as this may prevent youfrom properly latching the tab andbuckle.

� If the seat belt does not functionnormally, immediately contact yourToyota dealer. Do not use the seatuntil the seat belt is fixed. It cannotprotect an adult occupant or yourchild from injury.

The driver and front outside passen-ger’s seat belt pretensioners are de-signed to be activated in response toa severe frontal impact.

When the airbag sensor detects the shockof a severe frontal impact, the front out-side seat belts are quickly drawn back inby the retractors so that the belts snuglyrestrain the front outside seat occupants.

The front outside seat belt pretensionersare activated even with no passenger inthe front outside seat.

This indicator comes on when the igni-tion key is turned to the “ON” position.It goes off after about 6 seconds. Thismeans the front outside seat belt pre-tensioners are operating properly.

This warning light system monitors theairbag sensor assembly, front airbag sen-sors, side airbag sensors, driver’s seatposition sensor, driver’s seat belt buckleswitch, front seat belt pretensioner assem-blies, inflators, warning light, interconnect-ing wiring and power sources. (For details,see “Service reminder indicators andwarning buzzers” in Section 1−5.)

—Front seat beltpretensioners

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

58 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The front outside seat belt pretensionersystem mainly consists of the followingcomponents and their locations are shownin the illustration.

1. Front airbag sensors

2. SRS warning light

3. Front seat belt pretensioner assemblies

4. Airbag sensor assembly

The front outside seat belt pretensionersare controlled by the airbag sensor as-sembly. The airbag sensor assembly con-sists of a safing sensor and airbag sen-sor.

When the front outside seat belt preten-sioners are activated, an operating noisemay be heard and a small amount ofsmoke−like gas may be released. This gasis harmless and does not indicate that afire is occurring.

Once the front outside seat belt preten-sioners have been activated, the seat beltretractors remain locked.

CAUTION

Do not modify, remove, strike or openthe front seat belt pretensioner as-semblies, airbag sensor or surround-ing area or wiring. Doing so maycause sudden operation of the frontoutside seat belt pretensioners or dis-able the system, which could result indeath or serious injury.

Failure to follow these instructionscan result in death or serious inju-ries. Consult your Toyota dealerabout any repairs and modifications.

NOTICE

Do not perform any of the followingchanges without consulting yourToyota dealer. Such changes caninterfere with proper operation of thefront outside seat belt pretensionersin some cases.

� Installation of electronic devicessuch as a mobile two−way radio,cassette tape player or compactdisc player

� Repairs on or near the front seatbelt retractor assemblies

� Modification of the suspension sys-tem

� Modification of the front end struc-ture

� Attachment of a grille guard (bullbar, kangaroo bar, etc.), snowplow,winches or any other equipment tothe front end

� Repairs made on or near the frontfenders, front end structure or con-sole

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

592003 AVALON (OM41401U)

This front outside seat belt pretensionersystem has a service reminder indicator toinform the driver of operating problems. Ifany of the following conditions occurs, thisindicates a malfunction of the airbags orpretensioners. Contact your Toyota dealeras soon as possible to service thevehicle.

� The light does not come on when theignition key is turned to the “ON” posi-tion, or remains on.

� The light comes on or flashes whiledriving.

� If either front outside seat belt doesnot retract or cannot be pulled out dueto a malfunction or activation of therelevant front outside seat belt preten-sioner.

In the following cases, contact your Toyotadealer as soon as possible:

� The front of the vehicle (shaded in theillustration) was involved in an accidentthat was not severe enough to causethe front outside seat belt pretension-ers to operate.

� Either front outside seat belt preten-sioner assembly or surrounding area isscratched, cracked, or otherwise dam-aged.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

60 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The SRS (Supplemental Restraint Sys-tem) front airbags are designed to pro-vide further protection for occupants inthe following seats in addition to theprimary safety protection provided bythe seat belts.

� Vehicles with bucket front seats—TheSRS front airbags are designed to pro-tect the driver and front passenger.

� Vehicles with bench type front seats—The SRS front airbags are designed toprotect the driver and front outsidepassenger. They are not designed toprotect occupant in the center position.

In response to a severe frontal impact,the SRS front airbags work together withthe seat belts to help reduce injury byinflating. The SRS front airbags help toreduce injuries mainly to the driver’s orfront passenger’s head or chest caused bydirectly hitting the steering wheel or dash-board. The front passenger airbag is acti-vated even with no passenger in the frontseat.

Be sure to wear your seat belt properly.

CAUTION

The driver or front passenger who istoo close to the steering wheel ordashboard during airbag deploymentcan be killed or seriously injured.Toyota strongly recommends that:

� The driver sit as far back as pos-sible from the steering wheel whilestill maintaining control of the ve-hicle.

� The front passenger sit as far backas possible from the dashboard.

� All vehicle occupants be properlyrestrained using the available seatbelts.

SRS driver airbag and frontpassenger airbag

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

612003 AVALON (OM41401U)

This indicator comes on when the igni-tion key is turned to the “ON” position.It goes off after about 6 seconds. Thismeans the SRS front airbags are oper-ating properly.

This warning light system monitors theairbag sensor assembly, front airbag sen-sors, side airbag sensors, driver’s seatposition sensor, driver’s seat belt buckleswitch, front seat belt pretensioner assem-blies, inflators, warning light, interconnect-ing wiring and power sources. (For details,see “Service remainder indicators andwarning buzzers” in Section 1−5.)

The SRS front airbag system is de-signed to activate in response to a se-vere frontal impact within the shadedarea between the arrows in the illustra-tion.

The SRS front airbags will deploy if theseverity of the impact is above the de-signed threshold level, comparable to anapproximate 25 km/h (15 mph) collision inthe U.S.A. and 30 km/h (18 mph) collisionin Canada when impacting straight into afixed barrier that does not move or de-form.

If the severity of the impact is below theabove threshold level, the SRS front air-bags may not deploy.

However, this threshold velocity will beconsiderably higher if the vehicle strikesan object, such as a parked vehicle orsign pole, which can move or deform onimpact, or if it is involved in an underridecollision (e.g. a collision in which the noseof the vehicle “underrides”, or goes under,the bed of a truck, etc.).

For the safety of all occupants, alwayswear your seat belts properly.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

62 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Collision from the side

Collision from the rear

Vehicle rollover

The SRS front airbags are not designedto inflate if the vehicle is involved in aside or rear collision, if it rolls over, orif it is involved in a low−speed frontalcollision.

Hitting a curb,edge of pavementor hard material

Falling into orjumping over adeep hole

Landing hard or vehicle falling

The SRS front airbags may deploy if aserious impact occurs to the undersideof your vehicle. Some examples areshown in the illustration.

The SRS airbag system consists mainly ofthe following components, and their loca-tions are shown in the illustration.

1. Front airbag sensors

2. Airbag module for driver (airbag and inflator)

3. Airbag module for front passenger (airbag and inflator)

4. Driver’s seat belt buckle switch

5. Driver’s seat position sensor

6. Airbag sensor assembly

7. SRS warning light

The airbag sensor assembly consists of asafing sensor and airbag sensor.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

632003 AVALON (OM41401U)

In a severe frontal impact, the sensor de-tects deceleration and the system triggersthe airbag inflators. At this time a chemi-cal reaction in the inflators quickly fills theairbags with non−toxic gas to help restrainthe forward motion of the occupants.

When the airbags inflate, they produce afairly loud noise and release some smokeand residue along with non−toxic gas. Thisdoes not indicate a fire. This gas is nor-mally harmless; however, for those whohave delicate skin, it may cause a minorskin irritation. Be sure to wash off anyresidue as soon as possible to preventany potential skin irritation.

Deployment of the airbags happens in afraction of a second, so the airbags mustinflate with considerable force. While thesystem is designed to reduce serious inju-ries, it may also cause minor burns orabrasions and swelling.

Parts of the airbag module (steering wheelhub, dashboard) may be hot for severalminutes, but the airbags themselves willnot be hot. The airbags are designed toinflate only once.

A crash severe enough to inflate the air-bags may break the windshield as thevehicle buckles. In vehicles with a pas-senger airbag the windshield may also bedamaged by absorbing some of the forceof the inflating airbag.

CAUTION

� The SRS airbag system is designedonly as a supplement to the prima-ry protection of the driver side andfront passenger side seat belt sys-tems. The front seat occupants canbe killed or seriously injured by theinflating airbags if they do not wearthe available seat belts properly.During sudden braking just beforea collision, an unrestrained driveror front passenger can move for-ward into direct contact with orclose proximity to the airbag whichmay then deploy during the colli-sion. To ensure maximum protectionin an accident, the driver and allpassengers in the vehicle mustwear their seat belts properly. Wear-ing a seat belt properly during anaccident reduces the chances ofdeath or serious injury or beingthrown out of the vehicle. Forinstructions and precautions con-cerning the seat belt system, see“Seat belts” in this section.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

64 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Improperly seated and/or restrainedinfants and children can be killedor seriously injured by the deploy-ing front airbags. An infant or childwho is too small to use a seat beltshould be properly secured using achild restraint system. Toyotastrongly recommends that all in-fants and children be placed in therear seat of the vehicle and proper-ly restrained. The rear seat is thesafest for infants and children. Forinstructions concerning the installa-tion of a child restraint system, see“Child restraint” in this section. � Never install a rear−facing child re-

straint system on the front passen-ger seat because the force of therapid inflation of the front passen-ger airbag can cause death or seri-ous injury to the child.

Move seatfully back

� A forward−facing child restraint sys-tem should be allowed to beinstalled on the front passengerseat only when it is unavoidable.Always move the seat as far backas possible, because the force ofthe deploying front passenger air-bag could cause death or seriousinjury to the child.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

652003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Do not allow the child to leanagainst the front door or aroundthe front door even if the child isseated in the child restraint system.It is dangerous if the side airbagsinflate, because the impact couldcause death or serious injury to thechild.

� For instructions concerning theinstallation of a child restraint sys-tem, see “Child restraint” in thissection.

� Do not sit on the edge of the seator lean over the dashboard whenthe vehicle is in use, since thefront airbags inflate with consider-able speed and force. Otherwise,you may be killed or seriously in-jured. Sit up straight and well backin the seat, and always use yourseat belt properly.

� Do not allow a child to stand up,or to kneel on the front passengerseat, since the front airbag inflateswith considerable speed and force.Otherwise, the child may be killedor seriously injured.

� Do not hold a child on your lap orin your arms. Use a child restraintsystem in the rear seat. For instruc-tions concerning the installation ofa child restraint system, see “Childrestraint” in this section.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

66 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Do not put objects or your pets onor in front of the dashboard orsteering wheel pad that houses thefront airbag system. They might re-strict inflation or cause death orserious injury as they are projectedrearward by the force of the deploy-ing airbags. Likewise, the driverand front passenger should nothold objects in their arms or ontheir knees.

� Do not modify or remove any wir-ing. Do not modify, remove, strikeor open any components such asthe steering wheel pad, steeringwheel, column cover, front passen-ger airbag cover, front passengerairbag or airbag sensor assembly.Doing so may cause sudden SRSfront airbag inflation or disable thesystem, which could result in deathor serious injury.

Failure to follow these instructionscan result in death or serious injury.Consult your Toyota dealer about anyrepairs and modifications.

NOTICE

Do not perform any of the followingchanges without consulting yourToyota dealer. Such changes caninterfere with proper operation of theSRS front airbag system in somecases.

� Installation of electronic devicessuch as a mobile two−way radio,cassette tape player or compactdisc player

� Modification of the suspension sys-tem

� Modification of the front end struc-ture

� Attachment of a grille guard (bullbar, kangaroo bar, etc.), snowplow,winches or any other equipment tothe front end

� Repairs made on or near the frontfenders, front end structure, con-sole, steering column, steeringwheel or dashboard near the frontpassenger airbag

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

672003 AVALON (OM41401U)

This SRS front airbag system has aservice reminder indicator to inform thedriver of operating problems. If either ofthe following conditions occurs, thisindicates a malfunction of the airbags.Contact your Toyota dealer as soon aspossible to service the vehicle.

� The light does not come on when theignition key is turned to the “ON” posi-tion, or the light remains on.

� The light comes on while driving.

In the following cases, contact your Toyotadealer as soon as possible:

� The SRS front airbags have been in-flated.

� The front of the vehicle (shaded in theillustration) was involved in an accidentthat was not severe enough to causethe SRS front airbags to inflate.

� The pad section of the steering wheelor front passenger airbag cover(shaded in the illustration) is scratched,cracked, or otherwise damaged.

NOTICE

Do not disconnect the battery cablesbefore contacting your Toyota dealer.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

68 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The SRS (Supplemental Restraint Sys-tem) side airbags are designed to pro-vide further protection for occupants inthe following seats in addition to theprimary safety protection provided bythe seat belts.

� Vehicles with bucket front seats—TheSRS side airbags are designed to pro-tect the driver and front passenger.

� Vehicles with bench type front seats—The SRS side airbags are designed toprotect the driver and right−front pas-senger. They are not designed to pro-tect occupant in the center position.

In response to a severe side impact, theSRS side airbags work together with theseat belts to help reduce injury by inflat-ing. The SRS side airbags help to reduceinjuries mainly to the driver’s or front pas-senger’s chest. The SRS side airbag onthe passenger seat is activated even withno passenger in the front seat.

Be sure to wear your seat belt properly.

CAUTION

SRS side airbags inflate with consid-erable force. To avoid potential deathor serious injury when they inflate,the driver and front passenger must:

� Wear their seat belts properly

� Remain properly seated with theirback upright and against the seat atall times.

This indicator comes on when the igni-tion key is turned to the “ON” position.It goes off after about 6 seconds. Thismeans the SRS side airbags are operat-ing properly.

This warning light system monitors theairbag sensor assembly, front airbag sen-sors, side airbag sensors, driver’s seatposition sensor, driver’s seat belt buckleswitch, front seat belt pretensioner assem-blies, inflators, warning light, interconnect-ing wiring and power sources. (For details,see “Service reminder indicators andwarning buzzers” in Section 1−5.)

SRS side airbags

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

692003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The SRS side airbag system may notactivate if the vehicle is subjected to acollision from the side at certainangles, or a collision to the side of thevehicle body other than the passengercompartment as shown in the illustra-tion.

The SRS side airbags are designed toinflate when the passenger compartmentarea suffers a severe impact from theside.

For the safety of all occupants, alwayswear your seat belts properly.

Collision from the front

Collision from the rear

Vehicle rollover

The SRS side airbags are not designedto inflate if the vehicle is involved in afront or rear collision, if it rolls over,or if it is involved in a low−speed sidecollision.

The SRS side airbag system consistsmainly of the following components, andtheir locations are shown in the illustra-tion.

1. SRS warning light

2. Airbag sensor assembly

3. Side airbag modules (airbag and inflator)

4. Side airbag sensors

The SRS side airbag system is controlledby the airbag sensor assembly. The airbagsensor assembly consists of a safing sen-sor and airbag sensor.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

70 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

In a severe side impact, the side airbagsensor triggers the side airbag inflators.At this time a chemical reaction in theinflators quickly fills the airbags with non−toxic gas to help restrain the lateral mo-tion of the occupants.

When the airbags inflate, they produce afairly loud noise and release some smokeand residue along with non−toxic gas. Thisdoes not indicate a fire. This gas is nor-mally harmless; however, for those whohave delicate skin, it may cause a minorskin irritation. Be sure to wash off anyresidue as soon as possible to preventany potential skin irritation.

Deployment of the airbags happens in afraction of a second, so the airbags mustinflate with considerable force. While thesystem is designed to reduce serious inju-ries, it may also cause minor burns orabrasions and swelling.

Front seats may be hot for several min-utes, but the airbags themselves will notbe hot. The airbags are designed to inflateonly once.

CAUTION

� The SRS side airbag system is de-signed only as a supplement to theprimary protection of the driverside and front passenger side seatbelt systems. To ensure maximumprotection in an accident, the driverand all passengers in the vehiclemust wear their seat belts properly.Wearing a seat belt properly duringan accident reduces the chances ofdeath or serious injury or beingthrown out of the vehicle. Forinstructions and precautions con-cerning the seat belt system, see“Seat belts” in this section.

� Improperly seated and/or restrainedinfants and children can be killedor seriously injured by the deploy-ing airbags. An infant or child whois too small to use a seat beltshould be properly secured using achild restraint system. Toyotastrongly recommends that all in-fants and children be placed in therear seat of the vehicle and proper-ly restrained. The rear seat is thesafest for infants and children. Forinstructions concerning the installa-tion of a child restraint system, see“Child restraint” in this section.

� Do not allow a child to lean his/herhead or any part of his/her bodyagainst the front door or the areaof the seat from which the side air-bag deploys even if he/she isseated in the child restraint system.It is dangerous if the side airbaginflates, and the impact could causedeath or serious injury to the child.For instructions concerning theinstallation of a child restraint sys-tem, see “Child restraint” in thissection.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

712003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Do not lean against the front doorwhen the vehicle is in use, sincethe side airbag inflates with consid-erable speed and force. Otherwise,you may be killed or seriously in-jured. Special care should be takenespecially when you have a smallchild in the vehicle.

� Sit up straight and well back in theseat, distributing your weight evenlyin the seat. Do not apply excessiveweight to the outer side of the frontseats on vehicles with side airbags.

� Do not attach a cup holder or anyother device or object on or aroundthe door. When the side airbag in-flates, the cup holder or any otherdevice or object will be thrown withgreat force or the side airbag maynot activate correctly, resulting indeath or serious injury. Likewise,the driver and front passengershould not hold objects in theirarms or on their knees.

� Do not use seat accessories whichcover the parts where the side air-bags inflate. Such accessories mayprevent the side airbags from acti-vating correctly, causing death orserious injury.

� Do not modify or replace the seatsor upholstery of the front seatswith the side airbags. Such changesmay disable the system or causethe side airbags to inflate acciden-tally resulting in death or seriousinjury. Consult your Toyota dealer ifyou insist on modifications of thiskind.

Failure to follow these instructionscan result in death or serious injury.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

72 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

NOTICE

Do not perform any of the followingchanges without consulting yourToyota dealer. Such changes caninterfere with proper operation of theSRS side airbag system in somecases.

� Installation of electronic devicessuch as a mobile two−way radio,cassette tape player or compactdisc player

� Modification of the suspension sys-tem

� Modification of the side structure ofthe passenger compartment

� Repairs made on or near the con-sole or front seat

This SRS side airbag system has aservice reminder indicator to inform thedriver of operating problems. If either ofthe following conditions occurs, thisindicates a malfunction of the airbags.Contact your Toyota dealer as soon aspossible to service the vehicle.

� The light does not come on when theignition key is turned to the “ON” posi-tion, or the light remains on.

� The light comes on or flashes whiledriving.

In the following cases, contact your Toyotadealer as soon as possible:

� The SRS side airbags have been in-flated.

� The portion of the doors (shaded in theillustration) was involved in an accidentthat was not severe enough to causethe SRS side airbags to inflate.

� The surface of the seats with the sideairbag (shaded in the illustration) isscratched, cracked, or otherwise dam-aged.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

732003 AVALON (OM41401U)

NOTICE

Do not disconnect the battery cablesbefore contacting your Toyota dealer.

Toyota strongly urges the use of childrestraint systems for children smallenough to use them.

The laws of all 50 states in the U.S.A.and Canada now require the use of achild restraint system.

Your vehicle conforms to SAEJ1819.

If a child is too large for a child restraintsystem, the child should sit in the rearseat and must be restrained using thevehicle’s seat belt. See “Seat belts” fordetails.

CAUTION

� For effective protection in automo-bile accidents and sudden stops, achild must be properly restrained,using a seat belt or child restraintsystem depending on the age andsize of the child. Holding a child inyour arms is not a substitute for achild restraint system. In an acci-dent, the child can be crushedagainst the windshield, or betweenyou and the vehicle’s interior.

� Toyota strongly urges use of aproper child restraint system whichconforms to the size of the child,installed on the rear seat. Accord-ing to accident statistics, the childis safer when properly restrained inthe rear seat than in the front seat.

� Never install a rear−facing child re-straint system on the front seat. Inthe event of an accident, the forceof the rapid inflation of the airbagcan cause death or serious injury ifa rear−facing child restraint systemis installed on the front seat.

� Unless it is unavoidable, do notinstall a child restraint system onthe front seat.

Child restraint——Child restraint precautions

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

74 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� A forward−facing child restraint sys-tem should be allowed to beinstalled on the front passengerseat only when it is unavoidable.Always move the seat as far backas possible, because the force ofthe deploying front passenger air-bag could cause death or seriousinjury to the child.

� Do not allow the child to leanagainst the front door or aroundthe front door even if the child isseated in the child restraint system.It is dangerous if the side airbagsinflate, because the impact couldcause death or serious injury to thechild.

� Make sure that you have compliedwith all installation instructions pro-vided by the child restraintmanufacturer and that the system isproperly secured.

A child restraint system for a smallchild or baby must itself be properlyrestrained on the seat with either thelap belt or the lap portion of the lap/shoulder belt. You must carefully con-sult the manufacturer’s instructionswhich accompany the child restraintsystem.

To provide proper restraint, use a childrestraint system following the manufactur-er’s instructions about the appropriate ageand size of the child for the child restraintsystem.

Install the child restraint system correctlyfollowing the instructions provided by itsmanufacturer. General directions are alsoprovided under the following instructions.

The child restraint system should beinstalled on the rear seat. According toaccident statistics, the child is safer whenproperly restrained in the rear seat thanin the front seat.

CAUTION

� Never install a rear−facing child re-straint system on the front seat. Inthe event of an accident, the forceof the rapid inflation of the airbagcan cause death or serious injury ifa rear−facing child restraint systemis installed on the front seat.

� Unless it is unavoidable, do not puta child restraint system on thefront seat.

� A forward−facing child restraint sys-tem should be allowed to beinstalled on the front passengerseat only when it is unavoidable.Always move the seat as far backas possible, because the force ofthe deploying front passenger air-bag could cause death or seriousinjury to the child.

� Do not allow the child to leanagainst the front door or aroundthe front door even if the child isseated in the child restraint system.It is dangerous if the side airbagsinflate, because the impact couldcause death or serious injury to thechild.

—Child restraint system

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

752003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� After installing the child restraintsystem, make sure it is secured inplace following the manufacturer’sinstructions. If it is not restrainedsecurely, it may cause death or se-rious injury to the child in theevent of a sudden stop or accident.

When not using the child restraint system,keep it secured with the seat belt or placeit in the trunk or somewhere other thanthe passenger compartment. This will pre-vent it from injuring passengers in theevent of a sudden stop or accident.

Child restraint systems are classified intothe following 3 types depending on thechild’s age and size.

(A) Infant seat(B) Convertible seat(C) Booster seat

Install the child restraint system followingthe instructions provided by its manufac-turer.

Your vehicle has anchor brackets for se-curing the top strap of a child restraintsystem.

For instructions about how to use the an-chor bracket, see “—Using a top strap” inthis section.

The child restraint lower anchorages ap-proved for your vehicle may also be used.See “—Installation with the child restraintlower anchorages” in this section.

(A) Infant seat

(B) Convertible seat

—Types of child restraintsystem

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

76 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

(C) Booster seat(A) INFANT SEAT INSTALLATION

An infant seat is used in rear−facingposition only.

CAUTION

� Never install a rear−facing child re-straint system on the front passen-ger seat because the force of therapid inflation of the front passen-ger airbag can cause death or seri-ous injury to the child.

—Installation with 3−pointtype seat belt

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

772003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Do not install a child restraint sys-tem on the rear seat if it interfereswith the lock mechanism of thefront seats. This can cause death orserious injury to the child and frontpassenger in case of sudden brak-ing or a collision.

� If the driver’s seat position doesnot allow sufficient space for safeinstallation, install the child re-straint system on the rear rightseat.

1. Run the lap and shoulder belt throughor around the infant seat following theinstructions provided by its manufactur-er and insert the tab into the buckletaking care not to twist the belt. Keepthe lap portion of the belt tight.

CAUTION

� After inserting the tab, make surethe tab and buckle are locked andthat the lap and shoulder portionsof the belt are not twisted.

� Do not insert coins, clips, etc. inthe buckle as this may prevent youfrom properly latching the tab andbuckle.

� If the seat belt does not functionnormally, it cannot protect yourchild from injury. Contact yourToyota dealer immediately. Do notuse the child restraint system untilthe seat belt is fixed.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

78 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

2. Fully extend the shoulder belt to put itin the lock mode. When the belt isthen retracted even slightly, it cannotbe extended.

To hold the infant seat securely, makesure the belt is in the lock mode beforeletting the belt retract.

3. While pressing the infant seat firmlyagainst the seat cushion and seatback,let the shoulder belt retract as far asit will go to hold the infant seat secure-ly.

CAUTION

Push and pull the child restraint sys-tem in different directions to be sureit is secure. Follow all the installationinstructions provided by its manufac-turer.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

792003 AVALON (OM41401U)

4. To remove the infant seat, press thebuckle−release button and allow thebelt to retract completely. The belt willmove freely again and be ready towork for an adult or older child passen-ger.

(B) CONVERTIBLE SEAT INSTALLATION

A convertible seat is used in forward−facing or rear−facing position depend-ing on the child’s age and size. Wheninstalling, follow the manufacturer’sinstruction about the applicable child’sage and size as well as directions forinstalling the child restraint system.

CAUTION

� Never install a rear−facing child re-straint system on the front passen-ger seat because the force of therapid inflation of the front passen-ger airbag can cause death or seri-ous injury to the child.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

80 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Move seatfully back

� A forward−facing child restraint sys-tem should be allowed to beinstalled on the front passengerseat only when it is unavoidable.Always move the seat as far backas possible, because the force ofthe deploying front passenger air-bag could cause death or seriousinjury to the child.

� Do not allow the child to leanagainst the front door or aroundthe front door even if the child isseated in the child restraint system.It is dangerous if the side airbagsinflate, because the impact couldcause death or serious injury to thechild.

� Do not install a child restraint sys-tem on the rear seat if it interfereswith the lock mechanism of thefront seats. This can cause death orserious injury to the child and frontpassenger in case of sudden brak-ing or a collision.

� If the driver’s seat position doesnot allow sufficient space for safeinstallation, install the child re-straint system on the rear rightseat.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

812003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Run the lap and shoulder belt throughor around the convertible seat followingthe instructions provided by itsmanufacturer and insert the tab intothe buckle taking care not to twist thebelt. Keep the lap portion of the belttight.

CAUTION

� After inserting the tab, make surethe tab and buckle are locked andthat the lap and shoulder portionsof the belt are not twisted.

� Do not insert coins, clips, etc. inthe buckle as this may prevent youfrom properly latching the tab andbuckle.

� If the seat belt does not functionnormally, it cannot protect yourchild from injury. Contact yourToyota dealer immediately. Do notuse the child restraint system untilthe seat belt is fixed.

2. Fully extend the shoulder belt to put itin the lock mode. When the belt isthen retracted even slightly, it cannotbe extended.

To hold the convertible seat securely,make sure the belt is in the lock modebefore letting the belt retract.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

82 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

3. While pressing the convertible seatfirmly against the seat cushion andseatback, let the shoulder belt retractas far as it will go to hold the convert-ible seat securely.

CAUTION

Push and pull the child restraint sys-tem in different directions to be sureit is secure. Follow all the installationinstructions provided by its manufac-turer.

4. To remove the convertible seat, pressthe buckle−release button and allow thebelt to retract completely. The belt willmove freely again and be ready towork for an adult or older child passen-ger.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

832003 AVALON (OM41401U)

(C) BOOSTER SEAT INSTALLATION

A booster seat is used in forward−fac-ing position only.

Move seatfully back

CAUTION

� A forward−facing child restraint sys-tem should be allowed to beinstalled on the front seat onlywhen it is unavoidable. Alwaysmove the seat as far back as pos-sible, because the force of the de-ploying airbag could cause death orserious injury to the child.

� Do not allow the child to leanagainst the front door or aroundthe front door even if the child isseated in the child restraint system.It is dangerous if the side airbaginflates, and the impact could causedeath or serious injury to the child.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

84 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Sit the child on a booster seat. Runthe lap and shoulder belt through oraround the booster seat and child fol-lowing the instructions provided by itsmanufacturer and insert the tab intothe buckle taking care not to twist thebelt.

Make sure the shoulder belt is correctlyacross the child’s shoulder and that thelap belt is positioned as low as possibleon child’s hips. See “Seat belts” for de-tails.

CAUTION

� Always make sure the shoulder beltis positioned across the center ofchild’s shoulder. The belt should bekept away from child’s neck, butnot falling off child’s shoulder. Fail-ure to do so could reduce theamount of protection in an accidentand cause serious injuries in a col-lision.

� Both high−positioned lap belts andloose−fitting belts could cause seri-ous injuries due to sliding underthe lap belt during a collision orother unintended result. Keep thelap belt position as low on a child’ships as possible.

� For child’s safety, do not place theshoulder belt under child’s arm.

� After inserting the tab, make surethe tab and buckle are locked andthat the lap and shoulder portionsof the belt are not twisted.

� Do not insert coins, clips, etc. inthe buckle as this may prevent yourchild from properly latching the taband buckle.

� If the seat belt does not functionnormally, it cannot protect yourchild from injury. Contact yourToyota dealer immediately. Do notuse the child restraint system untilthe seat belt is fixed.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

852003 AVALON (OM41401U)

2. To remove the child restraint system,press the buckle−release button and al-low the belt to retract.

CONVERTIBLE SEAT INSTALLATION

A convertible seat is used in forward−facing or rear−facing position depend-ing on the child’s age and size. Wheninstalling, follow the manufacturer’sinstruction about the applicable child’sage and size as well as directions forinstalling the child restraint system.

CAUTION

� Never install a rear−facing child re-straint system on the front passen-ger seat because the force of therapid inflation of the front passen-ger airbag can cause death or seri-ous injury to the child.

—Installation with 2−pointtype seat belt

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

86 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Same angle

Sameheight

Move seatfully back

Move seatfully back

� A forward−facing child restraint sys-tem should be allowed to beinstalled on the front passengerseat only when it is unavoidable.Always move the seat as far backas possible, because the force ofthe deploying front passenger air-bag could cause death or seriousinjury to the child.

When installing a child restraint system inthe front seat center position, move thedriver and passenger seats as far back aspossible, set both seatbacks to the sameangle as the back of the child restraintsystem, and set both seat cushions at thesame height so that the child restraintsystem is securely restrained.

With the child restraint system installed,check that your driving position is satis-factory and that the child restraint systemdoes not interfere with your driving.

If your driving position is not satisfactory,or the child restraint system interfereswith your driving, install it at another posi-tion.

CAUTION

� When using a forward−facing childrestraint system, move the driverand passenger seats as far back aspossible, set both seatbacks to thesame angle as the back of the childrestraint system, set both seatcushions at the same height andmake sure your driving position issatisfactory.

� Ignoring the above instructions mayresult in a serious injury in case ofon accident.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

872003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Run the center lap belt through oraround the convertible seat followingthe instructions provided by itsmanufacturer and insert the tab intothe buckle taking care not to twist thebelt. Keep the lap portion of the belttight.

CAUTION

� After inserting the tab, make surethe tab and buckle are locked andthat the lap and shoulder portionsof the belt is not twisted.

� Do not insert coins, clips, etc. inthe buckle as this may prevent youfrom properly latching the tab andbuckle.

� If the seat belt does not functionnormally, it cannot protect yourchild from injury. Contact yourToyota dealer immediately. Do notuse the child restraint system untilthe seat belt is fixed.

2. While pressing the convertible seatfirmly against the seat cushion andseatback, tighten the lap belt by pullingits free end to hold the convertible seatsecurely.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

88 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

Push and pull the child restraint sys-tem in different directions to be sureit is secure. Follow all the installationinstructions provided by its manufac-turer.

3. To remove the convertible seat, pressthe buckle−release button and allow thebelt to retract completely. The belt willmove freely again and be ready towork for an adult or older child passen-ger.

Follow the procedure below for a childrestraint system that requires the useof a top strap.

—Using a top strap

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

892003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Symbol

Anchor brackets

Use the anchor bracket on the packagetray behind the rear seat to attach the topstrap.

Anchor brackets are installed for eachrear seating position.

This symbol indicates the location of userready anchor brackets.

TO USE THE ANCHOR BRACKET:

1. Remove the head restraint.

2. Remove the anchor bracket coverwith the symbol shown in the il-lustration.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

90 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

3. Securely fasten the child restraintsystem with the seat belt.

Latch the hook onto the anchorbracket and tighten the top strap.

For instructions to install the child re-straint system, see ”Child restraint” in thissection.

CAUTION

Make sure the top strap is securelylatched, and check that the child re-straint system is secure by pushingand pulling it in different directions.Follow all the installation instructionsprovided by its manufacturer.

4. Replace the head restraint.

Store any removed covers in a safe placesuch as the glove box.

Be sure to replace all covers when theanchor bracket is not in use.

Lower anchorages for the child restraintsystems complying with the FMVSS225specifications are installed in the rearseat.

The anchorages are installed in the clear-ance between the seat cushion and seat-back of both outside rear seats.

Child restraint systems complying with theFMVSS225 specification can be fixed tothese anchorages. In this case, it is notnecessary to fix the child restraint systemwith a seat belt on the vehicle.

—Installation with childrestraint lower anchorages

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

912003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Type A Type B

CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEMINSTALLATION

Type A—

1. Widen the clearance between theseat cushion and seatback a littleand confirm the position of the low-er anchorages near the tag on theseatback.

2. Latch the hooks of lower straps ontothe anchorages and tighten the lowerstraps.

Type B—

1. Widen the clearance between theseat cushion and seatback a littleand confirm the position of the low-er anchorages near the tag on theseatback.

2. Latch the buckles onto the anchor-ages.

If your child restraint system has a topstrap, it should be anchored. (For theinstallation of the top strap, see “—Usinga top strap” in this section.)

For the installation details, refer to theinstruction manual equipped with eachproduct.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

92 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

� When using the lower anchoragesfor the child restraint system, besure that there are no irregular ob-jects around the anchorages andthat the seat belt is not caught.

� Push and pull the child restraintsystem in different directions tomake sure it is secure. Follow allthe installation instructions pro-vided by its manufacturer.

� Do not install a child restraint sys-tem on the rear seat if it interfereswith the lock mechanism of thefront seats. This can cause death orserious injury to a child and frontpassenger in case of a suddenbraking or a collision.

To change the steering wheel angle,hold the steering wheel, pull the lockrelease lever toward you, tilt the steer-ing wheel to the desired angle and re-lease the lever.

When the steering wheel is in a low posi-tion, it will spring up as you release thelock release lever.

CAUTION

� Do not adjust the steering wheelwhile the vehicle is moving. Doingso may cause the driver to mishan-dle the vehicle and an accident mayoccur resulting in death or seriousinjuries.

� After adjusting the steering wheel,try moving it up and down to makesure it is locked in position.

Tilt steering wheel

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

932003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Adjust the mirror so that you can justsee the side of your vehicle in the mir-ror.

Be careful when judging the size or dis-tance of any object seen in the outsiderear view mirror on the passenger’s side.It is a convex mirror with a curved sur-face. Any object seen in a convex mirrorwill look smaller and farther away thanwhen seen in a flat mirror.

Vehicles with the auto anti−glare insiderear view mirror—When the inside rearview mirror surface darkens in “AUTO”mode, the driver’s side outside rear viewmirror surface also darkens to reduce thereflection of the headlights of the vehiclebehind you. (For details, see “Auto anti−glare inside rear view mirror” in this sec-tion.)

On some models, when you push the rearwindow defogger switch, the heater panelsin the outside rear view mirrors will quick-ly clear the surface. (See “Rear windowand outside rear view mirror defoggers” inSection 1−4.)

CAUTION

� Do not adjust the mirror while thevehicle is moving. Doing so maycause the driver to mishandle thevehicle and an accident may occurresulting in death or serious inju-ries.

� On some models, since the mirrorsurfaces can get hot, do not touchthem when the defogger switch ison.

NOTICE

The outside rear view mirrors arefixed in place. Do not try to fold themirrors. It may damage the mirrors.

Outside rear view mirrors—

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

94 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To adjust a mirror, use the switches.

1. Master switch—To select the mirror tobe adjustedPlace the switch at “L” (left) or “R”(right).

2. Control switch—To move the mirrorPush the switch in the desired direc-tion.

Mirrors can be adjusted when the key isin the “ACC” or “ON” position.

NOTICE

If ice should jam the mirror, do notoperate the control or scrape the mir-ror face. Use a spray de−icer to freethe mirror.

Adjust the mirror so that you can justsee the rear of your vehicle in the mir-ror.

To reduce glare from the headlights ofthe vehicle behind you during nightdriving, operate the lever on the loweredge of the mirror.

Daylight driving—Lever at position 1

The reflection in the mirror has greaterclarity at this position.

Night driving—Lever at position 2

Remember that by reducing glare you alsolose some rear view clarity.

—Power rear view mirrorcontrol

Anti−glare inside rear viewmirror

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

952003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

Do not adjust the mirror while thevehicle is moving. Doing so maycause the driver to mishandle the ve-hicle and an accident may occur re-sulting in death or serious injuries.

Adjust the mirror so that you can justsee the rear of your vehicle in the mir-ror.

This mirror is equipped with auto anti−glare function. The function is designedto reduce glare from the headlights ofthe vehicle behind you during nightdriving.

When the ignition key is inserted andturned on, the inside rear view mirror al-ways turns on in the “AUTO” mode.

The “AUTO” indicator illuminates to showyou that the function is on.

In “AUTO” mode, if the mirror detects lightfrom the headlights of the vehicle behindyou, the mirror surface darkens slightly toreduce the reflected light.

When the inside rear view mirror surfacedarkens the driver’s side outside rear viewmirror surface also darkens.

To turn off the automatic function, pressthe switch on the “OFF” side.

To turn on the automatic function again,press the switch on the “AUTO” side.

Adjust it before driving so that the rearview is optimized.

When the outside air temperature is low,it may take little longer for the mirror todarken in response to the detection ofheadlights.

CAUTION

Do not adjust the mirror while thevehicle is moving. It may cause thedriver to mishandle the vehicle andan accident may occur resulting indeath or serious injuries.

Auto anti−glare inside rearview mirror

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

96 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To ensure correct functioning of ananti−glare mirror sensor located on theback side of the mirror, do not touchor cover the sensor with your finger ora piece of cloth, etc.

To use the vanity mirrors, swing downthe sun visor and open the cover.

The vanity lights come on when you openthe cover.

Vanity mirrors

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

972003 AVALON (OM41401U)

OPERATION OF INSTRUMENTS ANDCONTROLSLights, Wipers and DefoggerHeadlights and turn signals 98. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Emergency flashers 103. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Instrument panel light control 103. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front fog lights 104. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Interior light 104. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front personal and interior lights 105. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear personal lights 106. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ignition switch light 106. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Windshield wipers and washer 107. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Shifting the windshield wiper position 109. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear window and outside rear view mirror defoggers 110. . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 1− 4

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

98 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

HEADLIGHTS

Manual operation—

To turn on the following lights: Twistthe headlight/turn signal lever knob.

Position 1—Parking, tail, license plate,side marker and instrument panel lights

Position 2—Headlights and all of theabove

Automatic operation—

To turn on or off the lights automatical-ly, twist the headlight/turn signal leverknob to the “AUTO” position when theignition key is in the “ON” position.

The headlights and/or all of the lights inposition 1 automatically turn on or off de-pending on the darkness of the surround-ings.

Manually twist the knob to the position 2to turn on the headlights if they are need-ed immediately when entering a dark tun-nel, parking structure, etc.

The automatic light control sensor is onthe top of the driver’s side instrumentpanel.

Do not place anything on the instrumentpanel, and/or do not affix anything on thewindshield to block this sensor.

Headlights and turn signals(for U.S.A.)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

992003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Automatic light cut off system

Position 1 or “AUTO” position with thetail lights on—

The lights automatically turn off when thedriver’s door is opened with the ignitionkey in the “ACC” or “LOCK” position.

Position 2 or “AUTO” position with theheadlights on—

The lights automatically turn off after 30seconds when any of the door or trunk lidis opened and closed with the ignition keyin the “ACC” or “LOCK” position.

Vehicles with wireless remote control sys-tem—The lights can be turned off immedi-ately by pushing the “LOCK” switch on thewireless remote control transmitter with allthe doors locked and the trunk lid closed.

If any of the door or trunk lid is keptopened, the lights automatically turn offafter 20 minutes.

To turn on the lights again, turn the igni-tion key to the “ON” position or actuatethe headlight switch. If you are going topark for over one week, make sure theknob is in the “AUTO” position.

NOTICE

To prevent the battery from being dis-charged, do not leave the lights onfor a long period when the engine isnot running.

Daytime running light (DRL) system

Daytime Running Light (DRL) System canmake it easier for others to see the frontof your vehicle during the day. The DRLsystem can be helpful in many differentdriving conditions, but they can be espe-cially helpful in the short periods afterdawn and before sunset.

The DRL system will make your headlightscome on at a reduced brightness when:

� The ignition is on with the engine run-ning.

� The light switch is in the “AUTO” posi-tion.

� The parking brake is released.

To turn on the other exterior lights andinstrument panel lights, twist the knob tothe position 1.

Twist the knob to the position 2 to turnthe headlights to full intensity for nightdriving.

To turn off the DRL system, twist the knobto the position 3 (“DRL OFF”) or turn theignition switch off.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

100 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

High−Low beams—For high beams, turnthe headlights on and push the lever awayfrom you (position 1). Pull the lever to-ward you (position 2) for low beams.

The headlight high beam indicator light(blue light) on the instrument panel willtell you that the high beams are on.

Flashing the high beam headlights(position 3)—Pull the lever all the wayback. The high beam headlights turn offwhen you release the lever.

You can flash the high beam headlightseven when the headlight switch is off.

TURN SIGNALS

To signal a turn, push the headlight/turn signal lever up or down to position1.

The key must be in the “ON” position.

The lever automatically returns after youmake a turn, but you may have to returnit by hand after you change lanes.

To signal a lane change, move the leverup or down to the pressure point (position2) and hold it.

If the turn signal indicator lights (greenlights) on the instrument panel flash fasterthan normal, a front or rear turn signalbulb is burned out. See “Replacing lightbulbs” in Section 7−3.

HEADLIGHTS

Manual operation—

To turn on the following lights: Twistthe headlight/turn signal lever knob.

Position 1—Parking, tail, license plate,side marker and instrument panel lights

Position 2—Headlights and all of theabove

Headlights and turn signals(for Canada)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1012003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Automatic operation—

To turn on or off the lights automatical-ly, twist the headlight/turn signal leverknob to the position 3 (“AUTO”) whenthe ignition key is in the “ON” position.

The headlights and/or all of the lights inposition 1 automatically turn on or off de-pending on the darkness of the surround-ings.

Manually twist the knob to the position 2to turn on the headlights if they are need-ed immediately when entering a dark tun-nel, parking structure, etc.

The automatic light control sensor is onthe top of the driver’s side instrumentpanel.

Do not place anything on the instrumentpanel, and/or do not affix anything on thewindshield to block this sensor.

Automatic light cut off system

Position 1 or position 3 with the taillights on—

The lights automatically turn off when thedriver’s door is opened with the ignitionkey in the “ACC” or “LOCK” position.

Position 2 or position 3 with the head-lights on—

The lights automatically turn off after 30seconds when any of the door or trunk lidis opened and closed with the ignition keyin the “ACC” or “LOCK” position.

Vehicles with wireless remote control sys-tem—The lights can be turned off immedi-ately by pushing the “LOCK” switch on thewireless remote control transmitter with allthe doors locked and the trunk lid closed.

If any of the door or trunk lid is keptopened, the lights automatically turn offafter 20 minutes.

To turn on the lights again, turn the igni-tion key to the “ON” position or actuatethe headlight switch. If you are going topark for over one week, make sure theheadlight switch is off.

NOTICE

To prevent the battery from being dis-charged, do not leave the lights onfor a long period when the engine isnot running.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

102 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Daytime running light (DRL) system

Daytime Running Light System (DRL) canmake it easier for others to see the frontof your vehicle during the day. The DRLsystem can be helpful in many differentdriving conditions, but they can be espe-cially helpful in the short periods afterdawn and before sunset.

The DRL system will make your headlightscome on at a reduced brightness when:

� The ignition is on with the engine run-ning.

� The headlight switch is off.

� The parking brake is released.

To turn on the other exterior lights andinstrument panel lights, twist the knob tothe position 1.

Twist the knob to the position 2 to turnthe headlights to full intensity for nightdriving.

High−Low beams—For high beams, turnthe headlights on and push the lever awayfrom you (position 1). Pull the lever to-ward you (position 2) for low beams.

The headlight high beam indicator light(blue light) on the instrument panel willtell you that the high beams are on.

Flashing the high beam headlights(position 3)—Pull the lever all the wayback. The high beam headlights turn offwhen you release the lever.

You can flash the high beam headlightseven when the headlight switch is off.

TURN SIGNALS

To signal a turn, push the headlight/turn signal lever up or down to position1.

The key must be in the “ON” position.

The lever automatically returns after youmake a turn, but you may have to returnit by hand after you change lanes.

To signal a lane change, move the leverup or down to the pressure point (position2) and hold it.

If the turn signal indicator lights (greenlights) on the instrument panel flash fasterthan normal, a front or rear turn signalbulb is burned out. See “Replacing lightbulbs” in Section 7−3.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1032003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To turn on the emergency flashers,push the switch.

All the turn signal lights will flash. To turnthem off, push the switch once again.

Turn on the emergency flashers to warnother drivers if your vehicle must bestopped where it might be a traffic hazard.

Always pull as far off the road as pos-sible.

The turn signal light switch will not workwhen the emergency flashers are operat-ing.

NOTICE

To prevent the battery from being dis-charged, do not leave the switch onlonger than necessary when the en-gine is not running.

To adjust the brightness of the instru-ment panel lights, turn the knob.

Emergency flashers Instrument panel light control

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

104 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To turn on the front fog lights, twistthe band of the headlight and turn sig-nal switch lever. They will come ononly when the headlights are on lowbeam.

To turn on the interior light, slide theswitch.

The interior light switch has the followingpositions:

“ON”—Keeps the light on all the time.

“OFF”—Turns the light off.

“DOOR”—Turns the light on when any ofthe doors is opened. The light goes offwhen all the doors are closed.

ILLUMINATED ENTRY SYSTEM

With the switch in the “DOOR” position,the light comes on when any door isopened. After all the doors are closed, thelight remains on for about 15 seconds andthen goes out.

However, in the following cases, the lightgoes off immediately.

� All the doors are closed when the igni-tion key is in the “ACC” or “ON” posi-tion.

� The ignition key is turned to the “ACC”or “ON” after all the doors are closed.

� All the doors are closed and locked.

When all the doors are unlocked with thekey or wireless remote control transmittersimultaneously, the light comes on forabout 15 seconds and then fades out,even if the door is not opened.

INTERIOR LIGHT CUT OFF OPERATION

To prevent the battery from being dis-charged, the light will automatically turnoff when the key is removed and the dooris left opened with the switch at “DOOR”position for 20 minutes or more.

Front fog lights Interior light

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1052003 AVALON (OM41401U)

With moon roof

Without moon roof

Front personal lights—

To turn on the front personal lights,push the switch. To turn the lights off,push the switch once again.

Interior lights—

The interior lights turn on when any ofthe door is opened. The lights go offwhen all of the doors are closed.

You cannot turn off the lights when any ofthe doors is opened.

ILLUMINATED ENTRY SYSTEM

The lights come on when any door isopened. After all the doors are closed, thelights remain on for about 15 seconds andthen go out.

However, in the following cases, the lightsgo off immediately.

� All the doors are closed when the igni-tion key is in the “ACC” or “ON” posi-tion.

� The ignition key is turned to the “ACC”or “ON” after all the doors are closed.

� All the doors are closed and locked.

When all the doors are unlocked with thekey or wireless remote control transmittersimultaneously, the lights come on forabout 15 seconds and then fade out, evenif the door is not opened.

INTERIOR LIGHT CUT OFF OPERATION

To prevent the battery from being dis-charged, the lights will automatically turnoff when the key is removed and the dooris left opened for 20 minutes or more.

Front personal and interiorlights

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

106 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To turn on the rear personal light, pushthe switch. To turn the light off, pushthe switch once again.

For easy access to the ignition switch,the ignition switch light comes on whenany of the doors are opened.

The light remains on for about 15 secondsafter all the doors are closed.

However, in the following cases, the lightgo off immediately.

� All the doors are closed when the igni-tion key is in the “ACC” or “ON” posi-tion.

� The ignition key is turned to the “ACC”or “ON” after all the doors are closed.

� All the doors are closed and locked.

When all the doors are unlocked with thekey or wireless remote control transmittersimultaneously, the light comes on forabout 15 seconds and then fades out,even if the door is not opened.

To prevent the battery from being dis-charged, the light will automatically turnoff when the key is removed and the dooris left opened for 20 minutes or more.

Rear personal lights Ignition switch light

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1072003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To turn on the windshield wipers, movethe lever to the desired setting.

The key must be in the “ON” position.

Lever position Operation

Position 1 Intermittentoperation

Position 2 Low speedoperation

Position 3 High speedoperation

Position 4 Washer on

The “INT TIME” band lets you adjust thewiping time interval when the wiper leveris in the intermittent position (position 1).Twist the band upward to increase thetime between sweeps, and downward todecrease it.

To squirt washer fluid, pull the levertoward you (position 4).

If the windshield wipers are off, they willoperate a couple of times after the washersquirts.

For instructions on adding washer fluid,see “Adding washer fluid” in Section 7−3.

In freezing weather, warm the windshieldwith the defroster before using the washer.This will help prevent the washer fluidfrom freezing on your windshield, whichcan block your vision.

NOTICE

Do not operate the wipers if the wind-shield is dry. It may scratch the glassor may damage wiper blades.

Automatic control adjuster

To turn on the windshield wipers, movethe lever to the desired setting.

The key must be in the “ON” position.

Lever position Operation

Position 1 Automaticoperation

Position 2 Low speedoperation

Position 3 High speedoperation

Position 4 Washer on

Windshield wipers and washer

(intermittent operation type)

Windshield wipers and washer

(raindrop detection type)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

108 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Automatic operation (position 1)

The wiper speed is determined by theamount of raindrops and sunlight detectedby the automatic wiper control sensor.

The automatic wiper control sensor is onthe inside of the windshield as shownabove.

If you feel that the operation of the auto-matic wiper control is too fast or too slow,twist the automatic control adjuster in the“−” direction to lower sensitivity, and “+”direction to boost the sensitivity.

Even if the wiper lever is in the position1, the system will switch to intermittentoperations in the following conditions:

� When the windshield gets extremelycold (at less than −10�C or 14�F)

� When the system malfunctions

However, when the windshield gets ex-tremely hot (at more than 90�C or 194�F),the wipers do not operate even if thewiper lever is in the position 1.

When the ignition switch is turned off withthe wiper lever in the position 1, and thenthe ignition switch is turned on again, theautomatic operation may not work even ifraindrops are on the windshield.

In this case, move the lever to anotherposition and return it to the position 1again.

CAUTION

Be careful not to get your fingerscaught between the wipers and wind-shield.

When the wiper lever is in the posi-tion 1 with the ignition switch on, thewipers could operate automatically inthe following cases:

� If you touch the upper center of thewindshield adjacent to the sensor.

� If you wipe the upper center of thewindshield (adjacent to which thesensor is located) with a towel orother object.

� If the windshield vibrates.

� If you touch the sensor.

NOTICE

Do not apply detergent to or wet theautomatic wiper control sensor whencleaning the inside of the windshield.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1092003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To squirt washer fluid, pull the levertoward you (position 4).

If the windshield wipers are off, they willoperate a couple of times after the washersquirts.

For instructions on adding washer fluid,see “Adding washer fluid” in Section 7−3.

In freezing weather, warm the windshieldwith the defroster before using the washer.This will help prevent the washer fluidfrom freezing on your windshield, whichcan block your vision.

NOTICE

Do not operate the wipers if the wind-shield is dry. It may scratch the glassor may damage wiper blades.

The wiper blades retract under the hoodwhen the wipers are turned off.

In the following cases, the wipers shouldbe shifted from the retracted position(position 2) to the rest position (position1) above the hood level.

� When cleaning the windshield

� When inspecting or replacing the wip-ers

� When the retraction may be obstructedby snow, etc., at the bottom of thewindshield

Other than the above cases, keep thewipers in the retracted position.

SHIFTING TO THE REST POSITION

Hold the connection of the wiper armand wiper blade and pull it upward formore than 10 cm (3.9 in.) along thewindshield glass with the force ofabout 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf).

NOTICE

To prevent the wiper blades from be-ing deformed, be sure to hold theconnection of the wiper arm and wip-er blade securely.

Shifting the windshield wiperposition

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

110 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

RETURNING TO THE RETRACTEDPOSITION

Push the connection of the wiper armand wiper blade downward.

NOTICE

To prevent the wiper blades from be-ing deformed, be sure to hold theconnection of the wiper arm and wip-er blade securely.

Type A

Type B

Type C

To defog or defrost the rear window,push the switch.

The key must be in the “ON” position.

The thin heater wires on the inside of therear window will quickly clear the surface.An indicator light will illuminate to indicatethe defogger is operating.

Type C—The heater panels in the outsiderear view mirrors will also quickly clearthe surfaces. Keep your hands off themirror faces when the switch is on.

Push the switch once again to turn thedefoggers off.

Rear window and outside rearview mirror defoggers

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1112003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The system will automatically shut off af-ter the defogger has operated about 15minutes.

CAUTION

Type C—Since the mirror surfacescan get hot, do not touch them whenthe defogger switch is on.

Make sure you turn the defoggers offwhen the surfaces are clear. Leaving thedefoggers on for a long time could causethe battery to discharge, especially duringstop−and−go driving. The defoggers arenot designed for drying rain water or formelting snow.

On some models, if the outside rear viewmirrors are heavily coated with ice, use aspray de−icer before operating the switch.

NOTICE

When cleaning the inside of the rearwindow, be careful not to scratch ordamage the heater wires or connec-tors.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

112 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1132003 AVALON (OM41401U)

OPERATION OF INSTRUMENTS ANDCONTROLSGauges, Meters and Service reminder indicators

Fuel gauge 114. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Engine coolant temperature gauge 114. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Tachometer 115. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Odometer and two trip meters 115. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Service reminder indicators and warning buzzers 116. . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 1− 5

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

114 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The gauge indicates the approximatequantity of the fuel remaining in thetank when the ignition switch is on.

Nearly full—Needle at “F”Nearly empty—Needle at “E”

It is a good idea to keep the tank over1/4 full.

If the fuel level approaches “E” or the lowfuel level warning light comes on, fill thefuel tank as soon as possible.

On inclines or curves, due to the move-ment of fuel in the tank, the fuel gaugeneedle may fluctuate or the low fuel levelwarning light may come on earlier thanusual.

If the fuel tank is completely empty, themalfunction indicator lamp comes on. Fillthe fuel tank immediately.

The indicator lamp goes off after drivingseveral times. If the indicator lamp doesnot go off, contact your Toyota dealer assoon as possible.

The gauge indicates the engine coolanttemperature when the ignition switch ison. The engine operating temperaturewill vary with changes in weather andengine load.

If the needle moves into the red zone,your engine is too hot. If your vehicleoverheats, stop your vehicle and allow theengine to cool.

Your vehicle may overheat during severeoperating conditions, such as:

� Driving up a long hill on a hot day.

� Reducing speed or stopping after highspeed driving.

Fuel gaugeEngine coolant temperaturegauge

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1152003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Idling for a long period with the airconditioning on in stop−and−go traffic.

� Towing a trailer.

NOTICE

� Do not remove the thermostat inthe engine cooling system as thismay cause the engine to overheat.The thermostat is designed to con-trol the flow of coolant to keep thetemperature of the engine withinthe specified operating range.

� Do not continue driving with anoverheated engine. See “If your ve-hicle overheats” in Section 4.

The tachometer indicates engine speedin thousands of rpm (revolutions perminute). Use it while driving to selectcorrect shift points and to prevent en-gine lugging and over−revving.

Driving with the engine running too fastcauses excessive engine wear and poorfuel economy. Remember, in most casesthe slower the engine speed, the greaterthe fuel economy.

NOTICE

Do not let the indicator needle getinto the red zone. This may causesevere engine damage.

Type A

Type B

Tachometer Odometer and two trip meters

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

116 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Type C

This meter displays the odometer andtwo trip meters when the ignitionswitch is on.

1. Odometer—Shows the total distancethe vehicle has been driven.

2. Two trip meters—Show two differentdistances independently driven sincethe last time each trip meter was setto zero.

You can use one trip meter to calculatethe fuel economy and the other tomeasure the distance on each trip. Alltrip meter data is cancelled if the elec-trical power source is disconnected.

3. “ODO/TRIP” button—Resets the twotrip meters to zero, and also changethe meter display.

To change the meter display, quicklypush and release the button. The meterdisplay changes in the order from theodometer to trip meter A to trip meterB, then back to the odometer eachtime you push.

To reset the trip meter A to zero, dis-play the meter A reading, then pushand hold the button until the meter isset to zero. The same process can beapplied for resetting the trip meter B.

(a) If parking brakeis off, stop immediately and contact Toyota dealer.

(b) Fasten driver’s seat belt.

If the indicator orbuzzer comes on...

(d) Stop and check.

or

(indicator and buzzer)

(e) Stop and check.

Do this.

(c) Fasten front outside passenger’s seat belt.

Service reminder indicatorsand warning buzzers

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1172003 AVALON (OM41401U)

(h) Take vehicle to Toyota dealer.If brake system warning light is also on, stop immediately and contact Toyota dealer.

If the indicator orbuzzer comes on...

(i) Close all doors.

(j) Replace bulb.

or

(g) Fill up tank.

Do this.

(f) Take vehicle toToyota dealer.

If the indicator orbuzzer comes on...

(n) Remove key.Key reminderbuzzer

(m) Add washer fluid.

Do this.

(l) Take vehicle to Toyota dealer.

(k) Take vehicle to Toyota dealerimmediately.

(a) Brake System Warning Light

This light comes on in the following caseswhen the ignition key is in the “ON” posi-tion.

� When the parking brake is applied...

This light comes on for a few secondswhen the ignition key is turned to the“ON” position even after the parking brakeis released.

� When the brake fluid level is low...

CAUTION

It is dangerous to continue drivingnormally when the brake fluid level islow.

Have your vehicle checked at yourToyota dealer in the following cases:

� The light does not come on even if theparking brake is applied when the igni-tion key is in the “ON” position.

� The light does not come on even if theignition key is turned on with the park-ing brake released.

A warning light turning on briefly duringoperation does not indicate a problem.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

118 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

If either of the following conditionsoccurs, immediately stop your vehicleat a safe place and contact yourToyota dealer.

� The light does not turn off evenafter the parking brake is releasedwhile the engine is running.

In this case, the brakes may notwork properly and your stoppingdistance will become longer. De-press the brake pedal firmly andbring the vehicle to an immediatestop.

� The brake system warning light re-mains on together with the “ABS”warning light.

In this case, not only the anti−lockbrake system will fail but also thevehicle will become extremely un-stable during braking.

(b) Driver’s Seat Belt Reminder Lightand Buzzer

This light and buzzer remind you tobuckle up the driver’s seat belt.

Once the ignition key is turned to “ON” or“START”, the reminder light flashes andbuzzer sounds if the driver’s seat belt isnot fastened. Unless the driver fastens thebelt, the light keep flashing and the buzz-er sounds for about 4 to 8 seconds.

(c) Front Outside Passenger’s Seat BeltReminder Light

This light reminds you to buckle up thefront outside passenger’s seat belt.

Once the ignition key is turned to “ON” or“START”, the reminder light flashes if apassenger sits in the front outside passen-ger seat and does not fasten the seatbelt. Unless the front outside passengerfastens the belt, the light stays on. Thislight reminds you to buckle up the frontoutside passenger’s seat belt.

If luggage load is placed on the frontoutside passenger seat, depending on itsweight and how it is placed on the seat,built−in sensors in the seat cushion maydetect the pressure, causing the reminderlight to come on.

(d) Discharge Warning Light

This light warns that the battery is beingdischarged.

If it comes on while you are driving, thereis a problem somewhere in the chargingsystem.

The engine ignition will continue to oper-ate, however, until the battery is dis-charged. Turn off the air conditioning,blower, radio, etc., and drive directly tothe nearest Toyota dealer or repair shop.

NOTICE

Do not continue driving if the enginedrive belt is broken or loose.

(e) Low Engine Oil Pressure WarningLight

This light warns that the engine oil pres-sure is too low.

If it flickers or stays on while you aredriving, pull off the road to a safe placeand stop the engine immediately. Call aToyota dealer or qualified repair shop forassistance.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1192003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The light may occasionally flicker whenthe engine is idling or it may come onbriefly after a hard stop. There is nocause for concern if it then goes out whenthe engine is accelerated slightly.

The light may come on when the oil levelis extremely low. It is not designed toindicate low oil level, and the oil levelmust be checked using the level dipstick.

NOTICE

Do not drive the vehicle with thewarning light on—even for one block.It may ruin the engine.

(f) Malfunction Indicator Lamp

This lamp comes on when the ignitionkey is turned to the “ON” position andgoes off after the engine starts. Thismeans that the warning light system isoperating properly.

If the lamp remains on, or the lampcomes on while driving, first check thefollowings.

� Empty fuel tank

If the fuel tank is empty, refuel immedi-ately.

� Loose fuel tank cap

If the fuel tank cap is loose, securelytighten it.

These cases are temporary malfunctions.The malfunction indicator lamp will go offafter taking several driving trips.

If the lamp will not go off even after theseveral trips, contact your Toyota dealeras soon as possible.

If the fuel tank is not empty or the fueltank cap is not loose...

� There is a problem somewhere in theengine, emission control system, auto-matic transmission electrical system orwarning light system itself.

Contact your Toyota dealer as soon aspossible to service the vehicle.

Emissions Inspection and Maintenance(I/M) programs

Your vehicle may not pass a stateemission inspection if the malfunctionindicator lamp remains on. Contact yourToyota dealer to check your vehicle’semission control system and OBD(On−Board Diagnostics) system beforetaking your vehicle for the inspection.

For details, see “Emissions Inspection andMaintenance (I/M) programs” in Section 6.

(g) Low Fuel Level Warning Light

This light comes on when the fuel levelin the tank becomes nearly empty. Fill upthe tank as soon as possible.

On inclines or curves, due to the move-ment of fuel in the tank, the low fuel levelwarning light may come on earlier thanusual.

(h) “ABS” Warning Light

The light comes on when the ignition keyis turned to the “ON” position. If the anti−lock brake system and the brake assistsystem work properly, the light turns offafter a few seconds. Thereafter, if thesystem malfunctions, the light comes onagain.

When the “ABS” warning light is on (andthe brake system warning light is off), theanti−lock brake system, the brake assistsystem, the traction control system andthe vehicle skid control system do notoperate, but the brake system still oper-ates conventionally.

When the “ABS” warning light is on (andthe brake system warning light is off), theanti−lock brake system does not operateso that the wheels could lock up duringa sudden braking or braking on slipperyroad surfaces.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

120 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If either of the following conditionsoccurs, this indicates a malfunctionsomewhere in the parts monitored bythe warning light. Contact your Toyotadealer as soon as possible to servicethe vehicle.

� The light does not come on when theignition key is turned to the “ON” posi-tion, or remains on.

� The light comes on while you are driv-ing.

A warning light turning on briefly duringoperation does not indicate a problem.

CAUTION

If the “ABS” warning light remains ontogether with the brake system warn-ing light, immediately stop your ve-hicle at a safe place and contact yourToyota dealer.

In this case, not only the anti−lockbrake system will fail but also thevehicle will become extremely unsta-ble during braking.

(i) Open Door Warning Light

This light remains on until all the doorsare completely closed.

(j) Rear Light Failure Warning Light

If this light comes on when the headlightswitch is turned on, it indicates that oneor more of the tail lights are burned out.

If it comes on when the brake pedal isdepressed, one or more stop lights areburned out.

Have defective bulbs replaced as soon aspossible.

(k) SRS Warning Light

This light will come on when the igni-tion key is turned to the “ON” position.After about 6 seconds, the light will gooff. This means the system of the air-bags and front seat belt pretensionersare operating properly.

This warning light system monitors theairbag sensor assembly, front airbag sen-sors, side airbag sensors, driver’s seatposition sensor, driver’s seat belt buckleswitch, front seat belt pretensioner assem-blies, inflators, warning light, interconnect-ing wiring and power sources.

If either of the following conditions occurs,this indicates a malfunction somewhere inthe parts monitored by the warning lightsystem. Contact your Toyota dealer assoon as possible to service the vehicle.

� The light does not come on when theignition key is turned to the “ON” posi-tion or remains on.

� The light comes on or flashes whiledriving.

(l) “VSC” Warning Light

The light warns that there is a problemsomewhere in the vehicle skid control sys-tem or traction control system.

The light will come on when the ignitionkey is turned to “ON”, and will go off afterabout a few seconds.

If the light comes on while driving, thevehicle skid control system and tractioncontrol system do not work. However, asconventional braking operates when ap-plied, there is no problem to continue yourdriving.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1212003 AVALON (OM41401U)

In the following cases, contact your Toyotadealer:

� The light does not come on after theignition is turned to on.

� The light is left on after the ignition isturned to on.

� The light comes on while driving.

The “TRAC OFF” indicator light will comeon when the “VSC” warning light comeson even if the “TRAC OFF” switch is notpushed.

(m) Low Windshield Washer Fluid LevelWarning Light

The light warns that the windshield washerfluid level is too low. Add washer fluid atyour earliest opportunity. (For instructions,see “Adding washer fluid” in Section 7−3.)

(n) Key Reminder Buzzer

This buzzer reminds you to remove thekey when you open the driver’s door withthe ignition key in the “ACC” or “LOCK”position.

CHECKING SERVICE REMINDERINDICATORS (except the low fuel levelwarning light and low windshieldwasher fluid level warning light)

1. Apply the parking brake.

2. Open one of the doors.The open door warning light shouldcome on.

3. Close the door.The open door warning light should gooff.

4. Turn the ignition key to “ON”, but donot start the engine.All the service reminder indicators ex-cept the open door warning light shouldcome on. The “ABS” and “VSC” warn-ing lights, “TRAC OFF” and slip indica-tor lights go off after a few seconds.The SRS warning light goes off afterabout 6 seconds.

If any service reminder indicator or warn-ing buzzer does not function as describedabove, have it checked by your Toyotadealer as soon as possible.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

122 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1232003 AVALON (OM41401U)

OPERATION OF INSTRUMENTS ANDCONTROLSIgnition switch, Transmission and Parking brakeIgnition switch with steering lock 124. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Automatic transmission 125. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Traction control system 132. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vehicle skid control system 135. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parking brake 136. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cruise control 137. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 1− 6

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

124 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

“START”—Starter motor on. The keywill return to the “ON” position whenreleased.

For starting tips, see Section 3.

“ON”—Engine on and all accessorieson.

This is the normal driving position.

“ACC”—Accessories such as the radiooperate, but the engine is off.

If you leave the key in the “ACC” or“LOCK” position and open the driver’sdoor, a buzzer will remind you to removethe key.

“LOCK”—Engine is off and the steeringwheel is locked. The key can be re-moved only at this position.

You must push in the key to turn the keyfrom “ACC” to the “LOCK” position. Theselector lever must be in the “P” positionbefore pushing the key.

Vehicles with engine immobiliser system—Once you remove the key, the engine im-mobiliser system is automatically set. (See“Engine immobiliser system” in Section1−2.)

When starting the engine, the key mayseem stuck at the “LOCK” position. Tofree it, first be sure the key is pushed allthe way in, and then rock the steeringwheel slightly while turning the key gently.

If the automatic unlocking operation linkedwith the ignition switch is set, all doorsare automatically unlocked when the igni-tion switch is turned from the “ON” posi-tion to the “ACC” or “LOCK” position. Fordetails, see “—Automatic door locking andunlocking functions” in Section 1−2.

NOTICE

Do not leave the key in the “ON”position if the engine is not running.The battery will discharge and theignition could be damaged.

Ignition switch with steeringlock

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1252003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Your automatic transmission has a shiftlock system to minimize the possibility ofincorrect operation. This means you canonly shift out of “P” position when thebrake pedal is depressed (with the ignitionswitch in “ON” position and the lock re-lease button depressed).

(a) Selector lever

The shift position is also displayed on theinstrument cluster.

P: Parking, engine starting andkey removal

R: Reverse

N: Neutral

D: Normal driving (with overdrive on)

2: Stronger engine braking

L: Maximum engine braking

Automatic transmission�Floor shift type

Overdrive switch

With the brake pedal depressed,shift while holding the lock release button in. (The ignitionswitch must be in “ON”position.)

Shift while holding the lockrelease button in.

Shift normally.

Lock release buttonTo prevent misshifting Selector lever

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

126 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

(b) Overdrive switch

You can select either third gear (withoverdrive off) or fourth gear (with over-drive on) by pushing this switch.

To turn the overdrive off, push the switch.The “O/D OFF” indicator light should comeon. To turn the overdrive on again, pushthe switch again. The “O/D OFF” indicatorlight should go off.

Always drive your vehicle with the over-drive on for better fuel economy andquieter driving.

If the engine is turned off when the over-drive is off and restarted, the overdrivewill automatically be on.

When the cruise control is being used,even if you downshift the transmission bypushing and releasing the overdriveswitch, engine braking will not be enabledbecause the cruise control is not can-celled.

For ways to decrease the vehicle speed,see “Cruise control” in this section.

(c) Normal driving

1. Start the engine as instructed in “Howto start the engine” in Section 3. Thetransmission must be in “P” or “N”.

2. With your foot holding down the brakepedal, shift the selector lever to “D”.

When the lever is in the “D” position, theautomatic transmission system will selectthe most suitable gear for running condi-tions such as normal cruising, hill climb-ing, hard towing, etc.

Always turn the overdrive on for betterfuel economy and quieter driving. If theengine coolant temperature is low, thetransmission will not shift into the over-drive gear even with the overdrive on.

CAUTION

Never put your foot on the accelera-tor pedal while shifting.

3. Release the parking brake and brakepedal. Depress the accelerator pedalslowly for smooth starting.

If the automatic locking operation linkedwith the shift position is set, all doors areautomatically locked when the selector le-ver is moved out of the “P” position afterthe ignition switch is turned to the “ON”position and all the doors are closed. Fordetails, see “—Automatic door locking andunlocking functions” in Section 1−2.

(d) Using engine braking

To use engine braking, you can downshiftthe transmission as follows:

� Push the overdrive switch. The “O/DOFF” indicator light will come on andthe transmission will downshift to thirdgear.

� Shift into the “2” position. The trans-mission will downshift to second gearwhen the vehicle speed drops down toor lower than 132 km/h (82 mph), andstronger engine braking will be en-abled.

� Shift into the “L” position. The trans-mission will downshift to first gearwhen the vehicle speed drops down toor lower than 59 km/h (36 mph), andmaximum engine braking will be en-abled.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1272003 AVALON (OM41401U)

When the cruise control is being used,even if you downshift the transmission bypushing and releasing the overdriveswitch, engine braking will not be enabledbecause the cruise control is not can-celled.

For ways to decrease the vehicle speed,see “Cruise control” in this section.

CAUTION

Be careful when downshifting on aslippery surface. Abrupt shiftingcould cause the vehicle to spin orskid.

(e) Using “2” and “L” positions

The “2” and “L” positions are used forstrong engine braking as described pre-viously.

With the selector lever in “2” or “L”, youcan start the vehicle in motion as with thelever in “D”.

With the selector lever in “2”, the vehiclewill start in first gear and automaticallyshift to second gear.

With the selector lever in “L”, the trans-mission is engaged in first gear.

NOTICE

� Be careful not to over−rev the en-gine. Watch the tachometer to keepengine rpm from going into the redzone. The approximate maximum al-lowable speed for each position isgiven below for your reference:

“2” 139 km/h (86 mph). . . . . . . . . . . “L” 76 km/h (47 mph). . . . . . . . . . . .

� Do not continue hill climbing orhard towing for a long time in the“2” or “L” position. This may causesevere automatic transmission dam-age from overheating. To preventsuch damage, “D” position shouldbe used in hill climbing or hardtowing.

(f) Backing up

1. Bring the vehicle to a complete stop.

2. With the brake pedal held down withyour foot, shift the selector lever to the“R” position.

NOTICE

Never shift into reverse while the ve-hicle is moving.

(g) Parking

1. Bring the vehicle to a complete stop.

2. With the brake pedal pressed down,fully depress the parking brake pedalto apply the parking brake securely.

3. With the brake pedal pressed down,shift the selector lever to the “P” posi-tion.

CAUTION

Never attempt to move the selectorlever into “P” position under any cir-cumstances while the vehicle is mov-ing. Serious mechanical damage andloss of vehicle control may result.

If the automatic unlocking operation linkedwith the shift position is set, all doors areautomatically unlocked when the selectorlever is moved to the “P” position afterthe ignition switch is turned to the “ON”position. For details, see “—Automaticdoor locking and unlocking functions” inSection 1−2.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

128 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

(h) Good driving practice

� If the transmission repeatedly shifts upand down between third gear and over-drive when climbing a gentle slope, theoverdrive should be turned off. Be sureto turn the switch on immediately after-ward.

� When towing a trailer, in order to main-tain engine braking efficiency, do notuse overdrive.

CAUTION

Always keep your foot on the brakepedal while stopped with the enginerunning. This prevents the vehiclefrom creeping.

NOTICE

Do not hold the vehicle on an up-grade with the accelerator pedal. Itcan cause the transmission to over-heat. Always use the brake pedal orparking brake.

(i) If you cannot shift the selector le-ver out of “P” position

If you cannot shift the selector lever fromthe “P” position even though the brakepedal is depressed, use the shift lockoverride button. For instructions, see “Ifyou cannot shift automatic transmissionselector lever” in Section 4.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1292003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Your automatic transmission has a shiftlock system to minimize the possibility ofincorrect operation. This means you canonly shift out of “P” position when thebrake pedal is depressed (with the ignitionswitch in “ON” position and the selectorlever pulled toward you).

(a) Selector lever

The shift position is displayed on the in-strument cluster.

P: Parking, engine starting andkey removal

R: Reverse

N: Neutral

D: Normal driving (with overdrive on)

2: Stronger engine braking

L: Maximum engine braking

�Column shift type

Overdrive switchSelector lever

With the brake pedal depressed,shift while pilling the selector lever toward you. (The ignitionswitch must be in “ON”position.)

Shift while pulling the selector lever toward you.

Shift normally.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

130 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

(b) Overdrive switch

You can select either third gear (withoverdrive off) or fourth gear (with over-drive on) by pushing this switch.

To turn the overdrive off, push the switch.The “O/D OFF” indicator light should comeon. To turn the overdrive on again, pushthe switch again. The “O/D OFF” indicatorlight should go off.

Always drive your vehicle with the over-drive on for better fuel economy andquieter driving.

If the engine is turned off when the over-drive is off and restarted, the overdrivewill automatically be on.

When the cruise control is being used,even if you downshift the transmission bypushing and releasing the overdriveswitch, engine braking will not be enabledbecause the cruise control is not can-celled.

For ways to decrease the vehicle speed,see “Cruise control” in this section.

(c) Normal driving

1. Start the engine as instructed in “Howto start the engine” in Section 3. Thetransmission must be in “P” or “N”.

2. With your foot holding down the brakepedal, shift the selector lever to “D”.

When the lever is in the “D” position, theautomatic transmission system will selectthe most suitable gear for running condi-tions such as normal cruising, hill climb-ing, hard towing, etc.

Always turn the overdrive on for betterfuel economy and quieter driving. If theengine coolant temperature is low, thetransmission will not shift into the over-drive gear even with the overdrive on.

CAUTION

Never put your foot on the accelera-tor pedal while shifting.

3. Release the parking brake and brakepedal. Depress the accelerator pedalslowly for smooth starting.

If the automatic locking operation linkedwith the shift position is set, all doors areautomatically locked when the selector le-ver is moved out of the “P” position afterthe ignition switch is turned to the “ON”position and all the doors are closed. Fordetails, see “—Automatic door locking andunlocking functions” in Section 1−2.

(d) Using engine braking

To use engine braking, you can downshiftthe transmission as follows:

� Push the overdrive switch. The “O/DOFF” indicator light will come on andthe transmission will downshift to thirdgear.

� Shift into the “2” position. The trans-mission will downshift to second gearwhen the vehicle speed drops down toor lower than 132 km/h (82 mph), andstronger engine braking will be en-abled.

� Shift into the “L” position. The trans-mission will downshift to first gearWhen the vehicle speed drops down toor lower than 59 km/h (36 mph), andmaximum engine braking will be en-abled.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1312003 AVALON (OM41401U)

When the cruise control is being used,even if you downshift the transmission bypushing and releasing the overdriveswitch, engine braking will not be enabledbecause the cruise control is not can-celled.

For ways to decrease the vehicle speed,see “Cruise control” in this section.

CAUTION

Be careful when downshifting on aslippery surface. Abrupt shiftingcould cause the vehicle to spin orskid.

(e) Using “2” and “L” positions

The “2” and “L” positions are used forstrong engine braking as described pre-viously.

With the selector lever in “2” or “L”, youcan start the vehicle in motion as with thelever in “D”.

With the selector lever in “2”, the vehiclewill start in first gear and automaticallyshift to second gear.

With the selector lever in “L”, the trans-mission is engaged in first gear.

NOTICE

� Be careful not to overrev the en-gine. Watch the tachometer to keepengine rpm from going into the redzone. The approximate maximum al-lowable speed for each position isgiven below for your reference:

“2” 139 km/h (86 mph). . . . . . . . . . . “L” 76 km/h (47 mph). . . . . . . . . . . .

� Do not continue hill climbing orhard towing for a long time in the“2” or “L” position. This may causesevere automatic transmission dam-age from overheating. To preventsuch damage, “D” position shouldbe used in hill climbing or hardtowing.

(f) Backing up

1. Bring the vehicle to a complete stop.

2. With the brake pedal held down withyour foot, shift the selector lever to the“R” position.

NOTICE

Never shift into reverse while the ve-hicle is moving.

(g) Parking

1. Bring the vehicle to a complete stop.

2. With the brake pedal pressed down,fully depress the parking brake pedalto apply the parking brake securely.

3. With the brake pedal pressed down,shift the selector lever to the “P” posi-tion.

CAUTION

Never attempt to move the selectorlever into “P” position under any cir-cumstances while the vehicle is mov-ing. Serious mechanical damage andloss of vehicle control may result.

If the automatic unlocking operation linkedwith the shift position is set, all doors areautomatically unlocked when the selectorlever is moved to the “P” position afterthe ignition switch is turned to the “ON”position. For details, see “—Automaticdoor locking and unlocking functions” inSection 1−2.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

132 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

(h) Good driving practice

� If the transmission repeatedly shifts upand down between third gear and over-drive when climbing a gentle slope, theoverdrive should be turned off. Be sureto turn the switch on immediately after-ward.

� When towing a trailer, in order to main-tain engine braking efficiency, do notuse overdrive.

CAUTION

Always keep your foot on the brakepedal while stopped with the enginerunning. This prevents the vehiclefrom creeping.

NOTICE

Do not hold the vehicle on an up-grade with the accelerator pedal. Itcan cause the transmission to over-heat. Always use the brake pedal orparking brake.

(i) If you cannot shift the selector le-ver out of “P” position

If you cannot shift the selector lever fromthe “P” position even though the brakepedal is depressed, use the shift lockoverride button. For instructions, see “Ifyou cannot shift automatic transmissionselector lever” in Section 4.

The traction control system automatical-ly helps prevent the spinning of frontwheels when the vehicle is started oraccelerated on slippery road surfaces.

When the ignition key is turned to “ON”,the system automatically turns on.

CAUTION

Under certain slippery road condi-tions, full traction of the vehicle andpower against front wheels cannot bemaintained, even though the tractioncontrol system is in operation. Do notdrive the vehicle under any speed ormaneuvering conditions which maycause the vehicle to lose tractioncontrol. In situations where the roadsurface is covered with ice or snow,your vehicle should be fitted withsnow tires or tire chains. Alwaysdrive at an appropriate and cautiousspeed for the present road condi-tions.

Traction control system

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1332003 AVALON (OM41401U)

NORMAL DRIVING MODE

Leave the system on during the ordi-nary driving so that it can operatewhen needed.

You may hear a sound in the enginecompartment for a few seconds when theengine is started or just after the vehicleis started. This means that the tractioncontrol system is in the self−check mode,but does not indicate a malfunction.

When the traction control system is oper-ating, the following conditions occur:

� The system controls the spinning of thefront wheels. At this time, the slip indi-cator light blinks.

� You may feel vibration or noise in yourvehicle, caused by operation of thebrakes. This indicates the system isfunctioning properly.

The slip indicator light comes on for a fewseconds when the ignition key is turnedto “ON”. If the indicator light does notcome on when the ignition is turned on,contact your Toyota dealer. TRACTION CONTROL OFF MODE

When getting the vehicle out of mud ornew fallen snow, etc., turn off the trac-tion control system. This system thatcontrols engine performance interfereswith the process of freeing frontwheels.

To turn off: Push “TRAC OFF” switch.

The “TRAC OFF” indicator light will comeon.

The vehicle skid control system is alwaysactivated, even if the traction control sys-tem is turned off.

To turn on: Push “TRAC OFF” switchonce again.

The “TRAC OFF” indicator light will go off.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

134 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

“TRAC OFF” indicator light comes on fora few seconds when the ignition key isturned to “ON”. It will come on againwhen you push the “TRAC OFF” switch toturn off the system.

In the following cases, contact your Toyotadealer:

� The indicator light does not come onwhen the ignition key is turned “ON”.

� The indicator light remains on after theignition is turned on.

� The indicator light comes on with thenormal driving mode while driving.

“VSC” warning light

This light warns that there is a problemsomewhere in the traction control systemor the vehicle skid control system.

The light will come on when the ignitionkey is turned to “ON” and will go off aftera few seconds.

If the light comes on while driving, thesystem does not work. However, as con-ventional braking operates when applied,there is no problem to continue your driv-ing.

In the following cases, contact your Toyotadealer:

� The warning light does not come onafter the ignition key is turned to “ON”.

� The warning light remains on after theignition key is turned to “ON”.

� The warning light comes on while driv-ing.

The “TRAC OFF” indicator light will comeon when the “VSC” warning light comeson even if the “TRAC OFF” switch is notpushed.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1352003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The vehicle skid control system helpsprovide integrated control of the sys-tems such as anti−lock brake system,traction control, engine control, etc.This system automatically controls thebrakes and engine to help prevent thevehicle from skidding when corneringon a slippery road surface or operatingsteering wheel abruptly.

This system will activate when your ve-hicle speed reaches or exceeds 15 km/h(9 mph), and will deactivate when the ve-hicle speed reduced to below 15 km/h (9mph).

You may hear a sound in the enginecompartment for a few seconds when theengine is started or just after the vehicleis started. This means that the system isin the self−check mode but does not indi-cate a malfunction.

CAUTION

� Do not rely excessively on the ve-hicle skid control system. Even ifthe vehicle skid control system isoperating, you must always drivecarefully and attentively to avoidserious injury. Reckless driving willresult in an unexpected accident. Ifthe slip indicator light flashes andan alarm sounds, special careshould be taken while driving.

� Only use tires of specified size. Thesize, manufacture, brand and treadpattern for all 4 tires should be thesame. If you use the tires otherthan specified, different type orsize, the vehicle skid control sys-tem may not function correctly.When replacing the tires or wheels,contact your Toyota dealer. (See“Checking and replacing tires” inSection 7−2.)

� In situations where the road surfaceis covered with ice or snow, yourvehicle should be fitted with snowtires or tire chains.

If the vehicle is going to skid during driv-ing, the slip indicator light blinks and analarm sounds intermittently. Special careshould be taken while driving.

The slip indicator light comes on for a fewseconds when the ignition key is turnedto “ON”. If the indicator light does notcome on when the ignition is turned on,contact your Toyota dealer.

Vehicle skid control system

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

136 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

“VSC” warning light

This light warns that there is a problemsomewhere in the vehicle skid control sys-tem or the traction control system.

The light will come on when the ignitionkey is turned to “ON” and will go off aftera few seconds.

If the light comes on while driving, thesystem does not work. However, as con-ventional braking operates when applied,there is no problem to continue your driv-ing.

In the following cases, contact your Toyotadealer:

� The warning light does not come onafter the ignition key is turned to “ON”.

� The warning light remains on after theignition key is turned to “ON”.

� The warning light comes on while driv-ing.

The “TRAC OFF” indicator light will comeon when the “VSC” warning light comeson even if the “TRAC OFF” switch is notpushed.

Type A

Type B

Parking brake

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1372003 AVALON (OM41401U)

When parking, firmly apply the parkingbrake to avoid inadvertent creeping.

To set: Fully depress the parking brakepedal. For better holding power, first de-press the brake pedal and hold it whilesetting the parking brake.To release: Depress the parking brakepedal while depressing the brake pedal.

To remind you that the parking brake isset, the parking brake reminder light inthe instrument panel remains on until yourelease the parking brake.

CAUTION

Before driving, be sure the parkingbrake is fully released and the park-ing brake reminder light is off.

The cruise control allows you to cruisethe vehicle at a desired speed over 40km/h (25 mph) with your foot off theaccelerator pedal.

Your cruising speed can be maintainedalthough a slight speed change may occurwhen driving up or down gradient, withinthe limits of engine performance. Onsteeper hills, a greater speed change willoccur so it is better to drive without thecruise control.

When the cruise control is on, the drivingpattern of the automatic transmission isfixed in the normal position, regardless ofthe position of the selector switch.

CAUTION

� To help maintain maximum controlof your vehicle, do not use thecruise control when driving inheavy or varying traffic, or on slip-pery (rainy, icy or snow−covered) orwinding roads.

� Avoid vehicle speed increases whendriving downhill. If the vehiclespeed is too fast in relation to thecruise control set speed, cancel thecruise control then downshift thetransmission to use engine brakingto slow down.

Cruise control

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

138 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

TURNING ON THE SYSTEM

To operate the cruise control, push “ON/OFF” button. This turns the system on.The indicator light in the instrument clus-ter shows that you can now set your de-sired cruising speed. Another push willturn the system completely off.

When the ignition key is turned off, thesystem automatically turned off. To usethe cruise control again, push “ON/OFF”button again to turn it on.

CAUTION

To avoid accidental cruise control en-gagement, keep the cruise controlsystem off when not using the cruisecontrol.

SETTING AT A DESIRED SPEED

The transmission must be in “D” beforeyou set the cruise control speed.

Bring your vehicle to the desired speed,push “COAST SET” button and release it.This sets the vehicle at that speed. If thespeed is not satisfactory, push “RES ACC”button for a faster speed, or push “SETCOAST” button for a slower speed. Eachpush changes the set speed by 1.6 km/h(1.0 mph). You can now take your foot offthe accelerator pedal.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1392003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If you need acceleration—for example,when passing—depress the acceleratorpedal enough for the vehicle to exceedthe set speed. When you release it, thevehicle will return to the speed set priorto the acceleration.

CANCELLING THE PRESET SPEED

You can cancel the preset speed by:

a. Depressing the brake pedal.

b. Pushing “CANCEL” button and releas-ing it.

c. Pushing “ON/OFF” button.

If the vehicle speed falls below about 40km/h (25 mph), the preset speed will beautomatically cancelled.

If the vehicle speed drops 16 km/h (10mph) below the preset speed, the presetspeed will be also automatically cancelled.

If the preset speed automatically cancelsout for any other reasons, have your ve-hicle checked by your Toyota dealer at theearliest opportunity.

RESETTING TO A FASTER SPEED

Push “RES ACC” button and hold it. Re-lease the button the desired speed is at-tained. While the button is pushed, thevehicle will gradually gain speed.

When the difference between the actualvehicle speed and the set speed is lessthan 5 km/h (3 mph), the set speed canbe increased 1.6 km/h (1 mph) each timeby pushing “RES ACC” button quicklywithin 0.6 seconds.

However, a faster way to reset is to ac-celerate the vehicle and then push“COAST SET” button.

RESETTING TO A SLOWER SPEED

Push “COAST SET” button and hold it.Release the button when the desiredspeed is attained. While the button ispushed, the vehicle speed will graduallydecrease.

When the difference is 5 km/h (3 mph) ormore, the vehicle will cruise with its actu-al speed. When the difference between theactual vehicle speed and the set speed isless than 5 km/h (3 mph), the set speedcan be lowered 1.6 km/h (1 mph) eachtime by pushing “COAST SET” buttonquickly within 0.6 seconds.

However, a faster way to reset is to de-press the brake pedal and then push“COAST SET” button.

Even if you turn off the overdrive switchwith the cruise control on, engine brakingwill not be applied because the cruisecontrol is not cancelled. To decrease thevehicle speed, reset to a slower speedwith the cruise control button or depressthe brake pedal. If you use the brakepedal, cruise control is cancelled.

RESUMING THE PRESET SPEED

If the preset speed is cancelled by push-ing “CANCEL” button or by depressing thebrake pedal, pushing “RES ACC” buttonwill restore the speed set prior to can-cellation. However, once the vehicle speedfalls below about 40 km/h (25 mph), thepreset speed will not be resumed.

CRUISE CONTROL FAILURE WARNING

If “CRUISE” indicator light in the instru-ment cluster flashes when using thecruise control, push “ON/OFF” button toturn the system off and then push it againto turn it on.

If any of the following conditions then oc-curs, there is some trouble in the cruisecontrol system.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

140 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� The indicator light does not come on.

� The indicator light flashes again.

� The indicator light goes out after itcomes on.

If this is the case, contact your Toyotadealer and have your vehicle inspected.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1412003 AVALON (OM41401U)

OPERATION OF INSTRUMENTS ANDCONTROLSCar audio systemReference 142. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using your audio system 142. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Car audio system operating hints 162. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 1− 7

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

142 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Type 1: AM·FM ETR radio/cassette player/compact disc player (with compact disc auto changer controller)

Type 2: AM·FM ETR radio/cassette player/compact disc auto changer

This section describes some of the basicfeatures on Toyota audio systems. Someinformation may not pertain to your sys-tem.

Your audio system works when the ignitionkey is in the “ACC” or “ON” position.

TURNING THE SYSTEM ON AND OFF

Push “PWR·VOL” to turn the audio systemon and off.

Push “AM”, “FM”, “TAPE” or “CD” to turnon that function without pushing“PWR·VOL”.

You can turn on each player by insertinga cassette tape or compact disc.

You can turn off each player by ejectingthe cassette tape or compact disc. If theaudio system was previously off, then theentire audio system will be turned offwhen you eject the cassette tape or com-pact disc. If the another function was pre-viously playing, it will come on again.

SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNCTIONS

Push “AM”, “FM”, “TAPE” or “CD” if thesystem is already on but you want toswitch from one function to another.

ReferenceUsing your audio system——Some basics

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1432003 AVALON (OM41401U)

TONE AND BALANCE

For details about your system’s tone andbalance controls, see the description ofyour own system.

Tone

How good an audio program sounds toyou is largely determined by the mix ofthe treble, midrange, and bass levels. Infact, different kinds of music and vocalprograms usually sound better with differ-ent mixes of treble, midrange and bass.

Balance

A good balance of the left and right stereochannels and of the front and rear soundlevels is also important.

Keep in mind that if you are listening toa stereo recording or broadcast, changingthe right/left balance will increase the vol-ume of one group of sounds while de-creasing the volume of another.

YOUR RADIO ANTENNA

Your vehicle has an antenna printed onthe inside of the rear window.

NOTICE

Attaching the film (especially conduc-tive or metallic type) on the rear win-dow will noticeably reduce the sensi-tivity of the radio.

YOUR CASSETTE PLAYER

When you insert a cassette, the exposedtape should face to the right.

NOTICE

Do not oil any part of the player anddo not insert anything other than cas-sette tapes into the slot, or the tapeplayer may be damaged.

YOUR COMPACT DISC PLAYER (type 1)

When you insert a disc, gently push it inwith the label side up. (The player willautomatically eject a disc if the label sideis down.) The compact disc player willplay from track 1 through the end of thedisc. Then it will play from track 1 again.

NOTICE

Never try to disassemble or oil anypart of the compact disc player. Donot insert anything except a compactdisc into the slot.

The player is intended for use with 12 cm(4.7 in.) discs only.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

144 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

YOUR COMPACT DISC AUTO CHANGER(type 2)

When you insert a disc, push the “LOAD”button and gently push the disc in withthe label side up. (The player will auto-matically eject a disc if the label side isdown.) The compact disc auto changer willplay from track 1 through the end of thedisc. Then it will play from track 1 of thenext disc.

The changer is intended for use with 12cm (4.7 in.) discs only.

NOTICE

� Do not stack up two discs for in-sertion, or it will cause damage tothe compact disc auto changer. In-sert only one compact disc into slotat a time.

� Never try to disassemble or oil anypart of the compact disc player. Donot insert anything except a com-pact disc into the slot.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1452003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Details of specific buttons, controls, andfeatures are described in the alphabeticallisting that follows.

—Controls and features�Type 1

Preset buttons

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

146 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Preset buttons

These buttons are used to preset andtune in radio stations.

To preset a station to a button: Tune inthe desired station. (See “TUNE” or“SEEK” button.) Push and hold down thebutton until you hear a beep—this will setthe station to the button. The button num-ber will appear on the display.

To tune in to a preset station: Push thebutton for the station you want. The but-ton number and station frequency will ap-pear on the display.

These systems can store one AM and twoFM stations for each button. (The displaywill show “AM”, “FM1” or “FM2” when youpush “AM” “FM”.)

(Eject button)

Push the cassette tape eject button toeject a cassette. Push the compact disceject button to eject a compact disc.

After you turn the ignition to “LOCK”, youwill be able to eject a cassette or disc,but you will not be able to reinsert it.

(Reverse/Fast forward button)

Cassette Player

Push the fast forward button to fast for-ward a cassette tape. “ ” will appearon the display. Push the reverse button torewind a tape. “ ” will appear on thedisplay.

To stop the tape while it is fast forward-ing, push the fast forward button or“TAPE”; to stop the tape while it is re-winding, push the reverse button or“TAPE”.

If a tape side rewinds completely, the cas-sette player will stop and then play thatsame side. If a tape fast forwards com-pletely, the cassette player will play theother side of the tape, using the auto−re-verse feature.

Compact Disc Player

If you want to fast forward or reversethrough a compact disc track, push andhold in the fast forward or reverse button.When you release the button, the compactdisc player will resume playing.

AM

Push “AM” to turn on the radio and selectthe AM band. “AM” will appear on thedisplay.

If the audio system is off, you can turnon the radio by pushing “AM”. Also, push“AM” to switch from cassette or compactdisc operation to radio operation.

AUDIO CTRL / MODE (Audio controland mode adjustment)

Manual tone adjustment function—

This knob is used to adjust the tonemanually.

For low−pitch tone adjustment, push“AUDIO CTRL / MODE” repeatedly until“BASS” appears on the display. Then turnthe knob to suit your preference.

The display will show the range from“BASS −5” to “BASS 5”.

For middle−pitch tone adjustment, push“AUDIO CTRL / MODE” repeatedly until“MID” appears on the display. Then turnthe knob to suit your preference.

The display will show the range from “MID−5” to “MID 5”.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1472003 AVALON (OM41401U)

For high−pitch tone adjustment, push“AUDIO CTRL / MODE” repeatedly until“TREB” appears on the display. Then turnthe knob to suit your preference.

The display will show the range from“TREB −5” to “TREB 5”.

Sound balance adjustment function—

This knob is also used to adjust thesound balance between the front and rear,and the right and left speakers.

For front/rear adjustment, push “AUDIOCTRL / MODE” repeatedly until “FADE”appears on the display. Then turn theknob to adjust the front/rear balance.

The display will show the range from“FADE FRONT 7” to “FADE REAR 7”.

For left/right adjustment, push “AUDIOCTRL / MODE” repeatedly until “BAL” ap-pears on the display. Then turn the knobto adjust the left/right balance.

The display will show the range from “BALLEFT 7” to “BAL RIGHT 7”.

CD (Compact Disc)

Push “CD” to switch from radio or cas-sette operation to compact disc operation.If the audio system is off, you can turnon the compact disc player by pushing“CD”. In both cases, a disc must alreadybe loaded in the player.

When the audio is set into compact discoperation, the display shows the track or,track and disc number currently beingplayed. Each time you push “CD”, thesystem changes to the automatic changer.

If the player malfunctions, your audio sys-tem will display one of the six followingerror messages.

If “WAIT” appears on the display, it indi-cates that the inside of the player unitmay be too hot due to the very high ambi-ent temperature. Remove the disc or mag-azine from the player and allow the playerto cool down.

If “Err 1” appears on the display, itindicates the disc is dirty, damaged, or itwas inserted up−side down. Clean thedisc or insert it correctly.

If “Err 2” appears on the display, itindicates no disc is loaded inside themagazine. Insert a disc.

If “Err 3” or “Err 4” appears on thedisplay, it indicates there is a trouble in-side the system. Eject the disc or maga-zine. Set the disc or magazine again.

If “OPEn” appears on the display, itindicates the compact disc auto changerlid is open. Close the compact disc autochanger lid.

If the malfunction is not rectified, takeyour vehicle to your Toyota dealer.

DISC

Compact disc auto changer only—

By using this button, you can select adisc you wish to listen to.

Push either side of the button until thenumber of the disc you want to listen toappears on the display.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

148 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Dolby� B NR∗

If you are listening to a tape that wasrecorded with Dolby� B Noise Reduction,push the button marked with the double−Dsymbol. The double−D symbol will appearon the display. Push the button again toturn off Dolby� B NR.

The Dolby NR mode reduces tape noiseby about 10 dB. For best sound reproduc-tion, play your tapes with this button onor off according to the mode used forrecording the tape.∗: Dolby noise reduction manufactured under license fromDolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation. “DOLBY” and thedouble D symbol are trademarks of Dolby LaboratoriesLicensing Corporation.

FM

Push “FM” to turn on the radio and selectthe FM band. “FM1” or “FM2” will appearon the display. This system allows you toset twelve FM stations, two for each but-ton.

If the audio system is off, you can turnon the radio by pushing “FM”. Also, push“FM” to switch from cassette or compactdisc operation to radio operation.

PROG (Program)

Push “ ” to select the other side of acassette tape. The display indicates whichside is currently selected (“ ” indicates

top side, “ ” indicates bottom side).

Auto−reverse feature: After the cassetteplayer reaches the end of a tape side, itautomatically reverses and begins to playthe other side. This is true whether thecassette was playing or fast forwarding.

PWR·VOL (Power and Volume)

Push “PWR·VOL” to turn the audio systemon and off. Turn “PWR·VOL” to adjust thevolume.

RND (Random)

There are two random features—you caneither listen to the tracks on all the com-pact discs in the magazine in random or-der, or only listen to the tracks on aspecific compact disc in random order.

To randomly play the tracks on a disc:Quickly push and release “ ”. “ ”will appear on the display. The disc youare listening to will play in random order.If you hear a beep, you held the buttontoo long, and the player will play all thetracks in the magazine in random order.To turn off the random feature, push thisbutton again.

Compact disc auto changer only—

To randomly play all the tracks in themagazine:Push and hold “ ” until you hear abeep. “ ” will appear on the displayand the player will perform all the trackson all the discs in the magazine in ran-dom order. To turn off the random feature,push this button again.

RPT (Repeat)

Cassette Player

Push “ ” while the track is playing.“ ” will appear on the display. Whenthe track ends, it will automatically berewound and replayed. This process willbe continued until you push the buttonagain to turn off the repeat feature.

There must be at least 3 seconds of blankspace between tracks in order for the re-peat feature to work correctly.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1492003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Compact Disc Player

There are two repeat features—You caneither replay a disc track or a whole com-pact disc.

Repeating a track:Quickly push and release “ ” while thetrack is playing. “ ” will appear on thedisplay. If you hear a beep, you held thebutton too long, and the player will repeatthe whole disc. When the track ends, itwill automatically be replayed. This pro-cess will be continued until you push thebutton again to turn off the repeat feature.

Compact disc auto changer only—

Repeating a disc:Push and hold “ ” until you hear abeep. “ ” will appear on the display.The player will repeat all the tracks on thedisc you are listening to. When the discends, the player will automatically go backto the top track of the disc and replay.This process will be continued until youpush the button again to turn off the re-peat feature.

SCAN

Radio

You can either scan all the frequencies ona band or scan only the preset stationsfor that band.

To scan the preset stations: Push and hold “SCAN” until you hear abeep. The radio will tune in the next pres-et station up the band, stay there for 5seconds, and then move to the next pre-set station. To select a station, push“SCAN” again.

To scan all the frequencies: Quickly push and release “SCAN”. If youhear a beep, you held the button too long,and the radio will scan the preset sta-tions. The radio will find the next stationup the station band, stay there for 5 se-conds, and then scan again. To select astation, push “SCAN” again.

Compact disc player

There are two scan features—you can ei-ther scan the tracks on a specific disc orscan the first tracks of all the discs in themagazine.

Scanning the tracks on a disc:Quickly push and release “SCAN”. “SCAN”will appear on the display and the playerwill scan all the tracks on the disc youare listening to. If you hear a beep, youheld the button too long, and the playerwill scan the first track of all the discs inthe magazine. To select a track, push“SCAN” again. If the player scanned allthe tracks on the disc, it will stop scan-ning.

Compact disc auto changer only—

Scanning the first track of all the discs inthe magazine:Push “SCAN” until you hear a beep.

“ ·SCAN” will appear on the display

and the player will perform the first trackof the next disc. To select a disc, pushthe “SCAN” again. If the player hasscanned all the discs, it will stop scan-ning.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

150 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

SEEK (Seeking)

Radio

In the seek mode, the radio finds andplays the next station up or down thestation band.

To seek the next station, quickly push andrelease the “�” or “�” side of “SEEK”.Do this again to find the station after that.

If you push and hold the “�” or “�” sideof “SEEK”, the radio will continue seekingup or down for stations and will stop atthe next station that it finds after the but-ton is released. on reception. Press thebutton again to resume the search.

Cassette Player

By using this button, you can skip up ordown to a different track.

You can skip up to nine tracks at a time.

Push the up or down side of the button.From “SEEK +9” to “SEEK −9” will appearon the display.

Next, push either side of the track buttonuntil the number on the display reachesthe number of tracks you want to skip. Ifyou push the button ten times, the skipfeature will be turned off.

When counting the number of tracks youwant to rewind, remember to count thecurrent track as well. For example, if youwant to rewind to a song that is two be-fore the song you are listening to, pushon the down side of the button until “REW3” appears on the display.

If you have pushed the track button morethan you wanted to, push the other sideof the button. The track number will bereduced.

The track number you select is not validif it is higher than the number of tracksremaining on the current cassette side.

� After the beginning of the tape isreached, the player will automaticallystart playing the same side.

� After the end of the tape is reached,the player will automatically reversesides and start playing the other side.

There must be at least 3 seconds of blankspace between tracks for the track buttonto work correctly. In addition, the featuremay not work well with some spokenword, live, or classical recordings.

ST (Stereo reception) display

Your radio automatically changes to stereoreception when a stereo broadcast is re-ceived. “ST” appears on the display. If thesignal becomes weak, the radio reducesthe amount of channel separation to prev-ent the weak signal from creating noise.If the signal becomes extremely weak, theradio switches from stereo to mono recep-tion.

TAPE

Push “TAPE” to switch from radio or com-pact disc operation to cassette operation.If the audio system is off, you can turnon the cassette player by pushing “TAPE”.In both cases, a cassette must already beloaded in the player.

TRACK (Track up/down button): Compact disc player

By using this button, you can skip up ordown to a different track.

Push either side of the track button untilthe number of the track you want to listento appears on the display. If you want toreturn to the beginning of the currenttrack, push the down side of the buttonone time, quickly.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1512003 AVALON (OM41401U)

TUNE (Tuning)

Your Toyota has an electronic tuning radio(ETR). Push and release the “�” or “�”side of “TUNE” to step up or down thestation band. Do this again to find anotherfrequency.

If you push and hold the “�” or “�” sideof “TUNE”, the radio will continue seekingup or down for frequencies and will stopat the next frequency that it finds after thebutton is released. Press the button againto resume the search.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

152 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Details of specific buttons, controls, andfeatures are described in the alphabeticallisting that follows.

�Type 2

Preset buttons

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1532003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Preset buttons

These buttons are used to preset andtune in radio stations. These preset but-tons are programmable only when RDS isnot selected.

To preset a station to a button: Tune inthe desired station. (See “TUNE” or“SEEK” button.) Push and hold down thebutton until you hear a beep—this will setthe station to the button. The preset but-ton number will appear on the display.

To tune in to a preset station: Push thebutton for the station you want. The pre-set button number and station frequencywill appear on the display.

This radio can store one AM and two FMstations for each button. (The display willshow “AM”, “FM1” or “FM2” when youpush “AM” “FM”.)

(Eject button)

Cassette tape

This button is used to eject a cassette.

While the ignition is in “LOCK”, you caneject a cassette but you cannot reinsertit.

Compact disc

This button is used to eject one or allcompact discs. To eject the current com-pact disc, push and release the compactdisc eject button. To eject all specificdiscs, push either side of the “DISC” but-ton until the number of the disc you wantto eject is displayed. Push and releasethe eject button. To eject all discs, pressand hold the eject button until you heara beep. The last compact disc played be-fore pushing the button will be ejectedfirst. If the ejected disc is not removed fora long time, the eject function will becancelled.

While the ignition is in “LOCK”, you caneject one or all discs but you cannot rein-sert them.

(Reverse/Fast−forward button)

Cassette Player

Push the fast−forward button to fast−for-ward a cassette tape. “ ” will appearon the display. Push the reverse button to

rewind a tape. “ ” will appear on thedisplay.

To stop the tape while it is fast−forward-ing, push the fast−forward button or“TAPE”; to stop the tape while it is re-winding, push the reverse button or“TAPE”.

If a tape rewinds completely, the cassetteplayer will stop and then play that sameside. If a tape fast−forwards completely,the cassette will play the other side of thetape using the auto−reverse feature.

Compact Disc Player

If you want to fast−forward or reverse acompact disc track, push and hold thefast−forward or reverse button. When yourelease the button, the compact disc play-er will resume playing.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

154 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

AM

Push “AM” to turn on the radio and selectthe AM band. “AM” will appear on thedisplay.

If the audio system is off, you can turnon the radio by pushing “AM”. Also, push“AM” to switch from cassette or compactdisc operation to AM.

AUDIO CTRL / MODE (Audio controland mode adjustment)

Each time you push the AUDIO CONTROLknob, the mode changes. To adjust thetone and balance, turn the knob.

BASS: Adjusts low−pitched tones. The dis-play ranges from −5 to 5.

MID: Adjusts mid−pitched tones. The dis-play ranges from −5 to 5.

TREBLE: Adjusts high−pitched tones. Thedisplay ranges from −5 to 5.

BALANCE: Adjusts the sound balance be-tween the right and left speakers. Thedisplay ranges from −7 to 7.

FADER: Adjusts the sound balance be-tween the front and rear speakers. Thedisplay ranges from −7 to 7.

CD (Compact Disc)

Push “CD” while in radio or cassettemode to switch to compact disc mode. Ifthe audio system is off, pressing “CD” willturn on the compact disc player. A discmust be loaded in the player.

When the audio is set into compact discoperation, the display shows the track or,track and disc number currently beingplayed.

If the player or another unit equipped withthe player malfunctions, your audio systemwill display one of the six following errormessages.

Error codes

“WAIT”: The compact disc player unitmay be too hot due to temperature. Allowthe player to cool down.

“ERR 1”: The disc may be dirty, damagedor inserted incorrectly (up−side down).Clean disc and re−insert.

“ERR 2”: The compact disc player isempty. Load disc and re−try.

“ERR 3” or “ERR 4”: This indicates in-ternal error. Re−load discs.

“OPEn”: The compact disc auto changerlid is open. Close the compact disc autochanger lid.

If the malfunction still exists, take yourvehicle to your Toyota dealer.

DISC

By using this button, you can select adisc you wish to listen to.

Push either side of the button until thenumber of the disc you want to listenappears on the display.

Dolby� B NR∗

If you are listening to a tape that wasrecorded with Dolby� B Noise Reduction,push the button marked with the double−Dsymbol. The double−D symbol will appearon the display. Push the button again toturn off Dolby� B NR.

The Dolby NR mode reduces tape noiseby about 10 dB. For best sound reproduc-tion, play your tapes with this button onor off according to the mode used forrecording the tape.∗: Dolby noise reduction manufactured under license fromDolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation. “DOLBY” and thedouble D symbol are trademarks of Dolby LaboratoriesLicensing Corporation.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1552003 AVALON (OM41401U)

FM

Push “FM” to turn on the radio to FMband. “FM1” or “FM2” will appear on thedisplay. This system allows you to settwelve FM stations, two for each of thesix preset button.

If the audio system is off, you can turnon the radio by pushing “FM”. Also, push“FM” to switch from cassette or compactdisc operation to FM.

LOAD

This button is used to load the compactdiscs in the compact disc auto changerwhich is integrated with the radio and cas-sette player. This compact disc autochanger can store up to 6 discs.

The key must be in the “ACC” or “ON”position for the load function.

Loading one compact disc only—

To load one compact disc only, quicklypush and release the button. If you holdthe button too long (if the audio systemis on at this time, you hear a beep.), themechanism will change to the mode forloading multiple compact discs. Afterpushing the button, insert a compact disc.After the disc is loaded, the shutter of theslot will close.

If no compact disc is inserted, the shutterwill close after 15 seconds.

Loading multiple compact discs—

To load multiple compact discs, push andhold the button (until you hear a beepwhen the audio system is on). After push-ing the button, insert the first compactdisc. After the disc is loaded, the shutterof the slot will close. After a few seconds,the shutter will automatically open againso the next disc can be inserted. Thesame process can be applied for loadingthe rest of the discs.

If no compact disc is inserted, the shutterwill close after 15 seconds.

MSG (Message)

This button is operational only in RDSmode.

When an RDS radio station transmits atext message, “MSG” will be displayed. Atthis time, push “MSG” button to view thetext message. The message display willbe canceled if any button that affects thedisplay is pushed. To view the messageagain, push the “MSG” button again. Afterthe entire message has been displayed,the message will disappear.

The RDS audio system has memory tostore three 64 character messages. Tostore a message in memory, push andhold the “MSG” button until you hear abeep.

If 3 messages are already stored inmemory, the oldest message will be over-written by the new message.

To recall a radio text message, push the“MSG” button momentarily. This will dis-play the most recent message. A secondpush of the “MSG” button while the moststored message(s) are displayed beginswith the newest one.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

156 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If no messages have been stored, or ifthere are no more messages to be re-called, “NO MSG STORED” will appear onthe display, and the message display willbe canceled. The display then returns toshow the program service name. Themessage display will be canceled if youactivate any function that affects the dis-play.Message display can be canceled bypressing any of the following buttons:“AM”, “FM”, “CD”, “TAPE”, “LOAD”,“SEEK”, “TUNE”, any preset, “SCAN”, anyaudio control, “RDS”, “SRCH”, or “<PROGTYPES>”. If the current station is not atraffic program and traffic announcementsis off, pushing “TRAF” will cancel the dis-play. The message will be canceled afterthe entire message has been displayed.

PROG (Program)

The “ ” button switches the side ofthe cassette being played. The display in-dicates which side is currently selected(“�” indicates top side, “�” indicates bot-tom side).

Auto−reverse feature: After the cassettereaches the end of a tape, it automaticallyreverses and begins to play the otherside. This feature works both in play andfast−forward mode.

<PROG TYPES> (Program Types)

This button is operational only in RDSmode.

This button is used for program type(PTY) search of RDS stations. 32 programtypes are available as listed here.

By pushing this button, RDS turns on inFM mode and “RDS” will be displayed. Ifthe program type search is not alreadyperformed, the radio will start a programtype search (see “SRCH” for details). If aprogram type search has already beenperformed, the last active program typewill be tuned.

If you are already in FM type mode anda program type is not already being dis-played, pushing this button will recall thedisplay for the current program type.

After a program type is being displayed,subsequent pushes of this button within 3seconds will toggle through the availableprogram types. Pushing the right or leftarrows repeatedly will increment or decre-ment the display through the available pro-gram types in alphabetical order.

Program Type List

The following program type names areavailable. After a program type search,the radio will display one of the followingprogram types for 3 seconds, then theprogram type name for 3 seconds (ifavailable). After that, it will display thefirst 8 characters of the program servicename of the current station.

Program types included are

� Adlt Hit (Adult Hits)

� Alert! (Emergency message)

� Classicl (Classical)

� Cls Rock (Classic Rock)

� College

� Country

� Inform (Information)

� Jazz

� Language

� News

� Nostalga (Nostalgia)

� Oldies

� Persnlty (Personality)

� Public

� R & B (Rhythm and Blues)

� Rel Musc (Religious Music)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1572003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Rel Talk (Religious Talk)

� Rock

� Soft

� Soft R&B (Soft Rhythm and Blues)

� Soft Rck (Soft Rock)

� Sports

� Talk

� Test (Emergency Test)

� Top 40

� Weather

PWR·VOL (Power and Volume)

Push “PWR·VOL” to turn the audio systemon and off. Turn “PWR·VOL” to adjust thevolume.

RDS (Radio Data System)

Your audio system is equipped with RadioData Systems (RDS). RDS mode providesyou to receive text messages from radiostations that utilize RDS transmitters.

If the FM radio, cassette player or com-pact disc player is on, pushing this buttonwill turn RDS on or off.

When RDS is on, the radio can—select only stations of a particular pro-gram type,—seek to stations with traffic announce-ments,—display messages from radio stations,—search for a stronger signal station,—receive announcements concerning localand national emergencies (even if RDSfunction is turned off)

RDS features are available for use onlyon FM stations which broadcast RDS in-formation.

ALERT: This type of announcement warnsof national or local emergencies. You willnot be able to turn off alert announce-ments. Alert announcements will come oneven if RDS mode is turned off. “Alert!”appears on the display when an alert an-nouncement plays. The radio uses TA vol-ume during these announcements. Whenan alert announcement comes on thetuned radio station or a related networkstation, you will hear it even if the volumeis muted or a cassette tape or compactdisc is playing. If the radio tunes to arelated network station for an alert an-nouncement, it will return to the originalstation when the announcement is fin-ished. If the cassette tape or compactdisc player is playing, play will stop forthe announcement and resume when theannouncement is finished.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

158 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

RND (Random)

There are two random features—you caneither listen to the tracks on all the com-pact discs in the magazine in random or-der, or only listen to the tracks on aspecific compact disc in random order.

To randomly play the tracks on a disc:Quickly push and release “ ”. “ ”will appear on the display. The disc youare listening to will play in random order.If you hear a beep, the player will play allthe tracks in the magazine in random or-der. To turn off the random feature, pushthis button again.

To randomly play all the tracks in themagazine:

Push and hold “ ” until you hear abeep. “ ” will appear on the displayand the player will perform all the trackson all the discs in the magazine in ran-dom order. To turn off the random feature,push this button again.

RPT (Repeat)

Cassette Player

Push “ ” while the track is playing.“ ” will appear on the display. Whenthe track ends, it will automatically rewindand replay. To turn off the repeat feature,push this button again.

There must be at least 3 seconds of blankspace between tracks in order for the re-peat feature to work correctly.

Compact Disc Player

There are two repeat features—You caneither replay a disc track or a whole com-pact disc.

Repeating a track:

Quickly push and release “ ” while thetrack is playing. “ ” will appear on thedisplay. If you hear a beep, the player willrepeat the whole disc. When the trackends, it will automatically replay. To turnoff the repeat feature, push this buttonagain.

Repeating a disc:

Push and hold “ ” until you hear abeep. “ ” will appear on the display.The player will repeat all the tracks on thedisc you are listening to. When the discends, the player will automatically go backto the top track of the disc and replay. Toturn off the repeat feature, push this but-ton again.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1592003 AVALON (OM41401U)

SCAN

Radio

You can either scan all the frequencies ona band or scan only the preset stationsfor that band.

To scan the preset stations: Push and hold “SCAN” until you hear abeep. The radio will tune in the next pres-et station up the band, stay there for 5seconds, and then move to the next pre-set station. To select a station, push“SCAN” again.

To scan all the frequencies: Quickly push and release “SCAN”. Theradio will find the next station up the sta-tion band, stay there for 5 seconds, andthen scan again to the next preset. Toselect a station, push “SCAN” again. Ifyou hear a beep, the radio will scan thepreset stations.

Compact disc player

There are two scan features—you can ei-ther scan the tracks on a specific disc orscan the first tracks of all the discs in themagazine.

Scanning the tracks on a disc:Quickly push and release “SCAN”. “SCAN”will appear on the display and the playerwill scan all the tracks on the disc youare listening to. If you hear a beep, theplayer will scan the first track of all thediscs in the magazine. To select a track,push “SCAN” again. If the player scannedall the tracks on the disc, it will stopscanning.

Scanning the first track of all the discs inthe magazine:Push “SCAN” until you hear a beep.“DSCAN” will appear on the display andthe player will scan the first track of thenext disc. To select a disc, push the“SCAN” again. If the player has scannedall the discs, it will stop scanning.

SEEK (Seeking)

Radio

In the seek mode, the radio finds andplays the next station up or down thestation band.

To seek the next station, quickly push andrelease the “�” or “�” side of “SEEK”.Do this again to find the station after that.

If you push and hold the “�” or “�” sideof “SEEK”, the radio will continue seekingup or down for stations and will stop atthe next station that it finds after the but-ton is released. Press the button again toresume the search.

Cassette Player

By using this button you can skip up ordown to locate a song or recording.

You can select up to 9 recordings (includ-ing current one).

A blank space of at least 3 seconds isconsidered to be a start of a recording.

When a beginning of a tape is reached,the player automatically resumes play.

When the end of the tape is reached, theplayer automatically reverses sides andresumes normal play.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

160 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

In addition, the feature may not work wellwith some spoken word, live, or classicalrecordings.

SRCH (Search)

This feature is available only in RDSmode.

This button allows you to search all avail-able RDS stations out of the entire FMband and sort them by program type (see“<PROG TYPES>” for details on programtypes).

By pushing this button, RDS is turned onif it was off (“RDS” will display). The radiois switched to FM type mode. During theprogram type search, “SEARCHING....” willshow on the display. Also at this time,“FM” and “TYPE” will appear on the dis-play to indicate that the preset buttons arefor program type.

After searching for all available RDS sta-tions, the radio will activate the previouslyused program type. If the previously usedprogram type is not available, or if theradio has not yet performed a programtype search, the radio will activate thefirst available program type, in alphabeti-cal order, that has stations in memory.The radio will preset the stations of thecurrent program type into the preset but-tons.

If more than 6 stations of a program typeare found, the radio will create a secondbank of presets, such as “Rock 1” and“Rock 2”. These are accessible throughthe “<PROG TYPES>” button. If more than12 stations are found, the radio will loadthe 12 strongest stations signal of theprogram type into the presets.

After the search is complete, the radio willdisplay the number of RDS stations foundfor 3 seconds: for example, “Found 19RDS.” The radio will then display the se-lected program type for 3 seconds: forexample, “ROCK.” After the program typehas been displayed for 3 seconds, theradio will display the program type namefor 3 seconds. After that, the radio willdisplay the program service name.

Day mode (headlights off): The radio willonly display the number of presets thathave a frequency for the selected programtype. For example, if program type Rockis selected, and there are three rock sta-tions, only preset numbers 1, 2 and 3 willbe displayed. The remaining preset num-bers will not be displayed and the remain-ing preset button(s) will have no function.

Night mode (headlights on): In addition tothe display described for day mode, theradio will illuminate the jewels of the pre-sets that have stations available. The re-maining preset button(s) will have no func-tion.

A type search in progress can be can-celed by pushing the following buttons:“SEEK”, “TUNE”, “SCAN”, “AM”, “FM”, anypreset button, “CD” (if CD mode is avail-able), “TAPE” (if tape mode is available),“RDS”, “SRCH”, “<PROG TYPES>”,“TRAF”, or “LOAD”. If any of these but-tons is pressed, the search will be can-celed and the appropriate function started.Inserting a tape will also cancel thesearch.

If no RDS stations are found, “FOUND 0RDS” will display and the radio will returnto the previous FM mode and frequency.

ST (Stereo reception) display

Your radio automatically changes to stereoreception when a stereo broadcast is re-ceived. “ST” appears on the display. If thesignal becomes weak, the radio reducesthe amount of channel separation to prev-ent the weak signal from creating noise.If the signal becomes extremely weak, theradio switches from stereo to mono recep-tion.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1612003 AVALON (OM41401U)

TAPE

Push “TAPE” to switch from radio or com-pact disc operation to cassette operation.If the audio system is off, you can turnon the cassette player by pushing “TAPE”.In both cases, a cassette must already beloaded in the player.

TRACK (Track up/down button): Compact disc player

By using this button, you can skip up ordown to a different track.

Push either side of the track button untilthe number of the track you want to listento appears on the display. If you want toreturn to the beginning of the currenttrack, quickly push the down side of thebutton one time.

TRAF (Traffic)

This feature is available only in RDSmode.

This button turns the traffic announcement(TA) feature on and off.

By pushing this button, RDS is turned onif it was off (“RDS” will display), and traf-fic announcement feature is on. “TRAF”appears on the display when the radio istuned to a traffic station. When the trafficannouncement feature is on, “< >” will bedisplayed (<TRAF>).

If the current station is not a traffic sta-tion, the radio will start a traffic programsearch in increasing frequency order. Dur-ing a traffic program search, “Seek Traffic”will display. If no traffic programs arefound, “No Traf Info” will display.

If the radio receives a traffic announce-ment, it will interrupt the cassette playeror compact disc mode (if either one wason), adjust the volume to Traffic An-nouncement level, and broadcast the traf-fic announcement. During a traffic an-nouncement, “TRAFFIC” will appear on thedisplay. After traffic announcement, it willreturn to the previous mode and volumelevel.

TA volume memory function—The volumelevel when receiving the traffic announce-ment is memorized.

When “TA” is received next time, the sys-tem compares the volume before “TA” isreceived and the memorized TA volumeand automatically selects the louder vol-ume. However, the range of volumememory is limited: if the volume receivedpreviously is less than the minimum, thisvolume will be used.

You can adjust the volume independentlyfrom the memorized TA volume rangewhile receiving a TA station.

Traffic announcement can be canceled byturning RDS off, or pressing the “TRAF”button again.

TUNE (Tuning)

Your Toyota has an electronic tuning radio(ETR). Push and release the “�” or “�”side of “TUNE” to step up or down thestation band. Do this again to find anotherfrequency.

If you push and hold the “�” or “�” sideof “TUNE”, the radio will continue seekingup or down for frequencies and will stopat the next frequency that it finds after thebutton is released. Press the button againto resume the search.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

162 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

NOTICE

To ensure correct audio system op-erations:

� Be careful not to spill beveragesover the audio system.

� Do not put anything other than acassette tape or Compact Disc intothe slot.

� The use of a cellular phone insideor near the vehicle may cause anoise from the speakers of the au-dio system which you are listeningto. However, this does not indicatea malfunction.

RADIO RECEPTION

Usually, a problem with radio receptiondoes not mean there is a problem withyour radio—it is just the normal result ofconditions outside the vehicle.

For example, nearby buildings and terraincan interfere with FM reception. Powerlines or telephone wires can interfere withAM signals. The farther you are from astation, the weaker its signal will be. Inaddition, reception conditions changeconstantly as your vehicle moves.

Here are some common reception prob-lems that you may experience.

FM

Fading and drifting stations—Generally, theeffective range of FM is about 40 km (25miles). Once outside this range, you maynotice fading and drifting, which increasewith the distance from the radio transmit-ter. They are often accompanied by distor-tion.

Multi−path—FM signals are reflective,making it possible for two signals to reachyour antenna at the same time. If thishappens, the signals will cancel each oth-er out, causing a momentary flutter orloss of reception.

Static and fluttering—These occur whensignals are blocked by buildings, trees, orother large objects. Increasing the basslevel may reduce static and fluttering.

Station swapping—If the FM signal youare listening to is interrupted or weak-ened, and there is another strong stationnearby on the FM band, your radio maytune in the second station until the origi-nal signal can be picked up again.

AM

Fading—AM broadcasts are reflected bythe upper atmosphere−especially at night.These reflected signals can interfere withthose received directly from the radio sta-tion, causing the radio station to soundalternately strong and weak.

Station interference—When a reflected sig-nal and a signal received directly from aradio station are very nearly the samefrequency, they can interfere with eachother, making it difficult to hear the broad-cast.

Static—AM is easily affected by externalsources of electrical noise, such as hightension power lines, lightening, or electri-cal motors. This results in static.

Car audio system operatinghints

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1632003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CARING FOR YOUR CASSETTE PLAYERAND TAPES

For the best performance for your cas-sette player and tapes:

Clean the tape head and other parts regu-larly.

� A dirty tape head or tape path candecrease sound quality and tangle yourcassette tapes. The easiest way toclean them is by using a cleaning tape.(A wet type is recommended.)

Use high−quality cassettes.

� Low−quality cassette tapes can causemany problems, including poor sound,inconsistent playing speed, andconstant auto−reversing. They can alsoget stuck or tangled in the cassetteplayer.

� Do not use a cassette if it has beendamaged or tangled or if its label ispeeling off.

� Do not leave a cassette in the playerif you are not listening to it, especiallyif it is hot outside.

� Store cassettes in their cases and outof direct sunlight.

� Avoid using cassettes with a total play-ing time longer than 100 minutes (50minutes per side). The tape used inthese cassettes is thin and could getstuck or tangled in the cassette player.

CARING FOR YOUR COMPACT DISCPLAYER AND DISCS

� Your compact disc player is intendedfor use with 12 cm (4.7 in.) discs only.

� Extremely high temperatures can keepyour compact disc player from working.On hot days, use the air conditioningto cool the vehicle interior before youlisten to a disc.

� Bumpy roads or other vibrations maymake your compact disc player skip.

� If moisture gets into your compact discplayer, you may not hear any soundeven though your compact disc playerappears to be working. Remove thedisc from the player and wait until itdries.

CAUTION

Compact disc players use an invisiblelaser beam which could cause hazard-ous radiation exposure if directedoutside the unit. Be sure to operatethe player correctly.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

164 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Use only compact discs marked asshown above. CD−R (CD−Recordable),CD−RW (CD−Re−writable) and personalcomputer use CD−ROMs may not beplayable on your compact disc player.

Special shaped discs

Low quality discs

Labeled discs

NOTICE

To prevent damage to the changer orplayer, do not use special shaped, lowquality or labeled discs such as thoseshown in the illustrations.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1652003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Correct Wrong

� Handle compact discs carefully, espe-cially when you are inserting them.Hold them on the edge and do notbend them. Avoid getting fingerprintson them, particularly on the shiny side.

� Dirt, scrapes, warping, pin holes, orother disc damage could cause theplayer to skip or to repeat a section ofa track. (To see a pin hole, hold thedisc up to the light.)

� Remove discs from the compact discplayer when you are not listening tothem. Store them in their plastic casesaway from moisture, heat, and directsunlight.

To clean a compact disc: Wipe it with asoft, lint−free cloth that has been damp-ened with water. Wipe in a straight linefrom the center to the edge of the disc(not in circles). Dry it with another soft,lint−free cloth. Do not use a conventionalrecord cleaner or anti−static device.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

166 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1672003 AVALON (OM41401U)

OPERATION OF INSTRUMENTS ANDCONTROLSAir conditioning systemManual air conditioning system

Controls 168. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Air flow selector settings 172. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Operating tips 172. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Automatic air conditioning systemControls 175. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Air flow selector settings 179. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Operating tips 179. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Side vents 182. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Air conditioning filter 182. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 1− 8

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

168 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Temperature selector (mainly for driver and secondarily forfront passenger)

2. Air intake selector

3. “A/C” button

4. Temperature selector (mainly for front passenger and secondarily for driver)

5. Air flow selector

6. Fan speed selector

Manual air conditioning system——Controls

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1692003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Fan speed selector

Turn the knob to adjust the fan speed—tothe right to increase, to the left to de-crease.

Temperature selector

Turn the knob to adjust the temperature—to the right to warm, to the left to cool.

Knowledge for the two−temperature se-lector operation

This air conditioning system has two inde-pendent temperature selectors: left andright (for the use of driver and front pas-senger respectively).

� There are cases where the temperatureof the airflow may not accurately corre-late on the driver and front passengerside according to circumstances, evenif the left and right temperature selec-tors are set at the same temperature.If this situation occurs, use the finetune operation to adjust the air temper-ature on one side.

Note: This manual dual temperature se-lectors should generally only be usedas independent temperature settings forthe left and right.

� There are cases where one or both ofthe airflow temperatures may not accu-rately correlate with the set tempera-ture according to circumstances, whenthe airflow temperature settings on theleft and right are substantially different.For example, if the left controller is setat central or neutral temperature whilethe right one is set at maximum heat-ing or maximum cooling, or vice versa.If this situation occurs, use the finetune operation to adjust the air temper-ature on each side.

Air flow selector

Turn the knob to select the vents used forair flow.

1. Panel—Air flows mainly from theinstrument panel vents.

2. Bi−level—Air flows from both the floorvents and the instrument panel vents.

When you set the temperature selectorsetting at about the center, warm airflows out of the floor vents and rela-tively low−temperature air flows out ofthe center and side vents.

3. Floor—Air flows mainly from the floorvents.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

170 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

4. Floor/Windshield—Air flows mainlyfrom the floor vents and windshieldvents.

Turning the air flow selector to thefloor/windshield position turns on thedefogging function with the purpose ofclearing the front view.

This position allows the air intake toselect FRESH automatically. This is toclean up the front view more quickly.

If you want to return the setting toRECIRCULATE mode, press the air in-take selector button once again.

Press the “A/C” button for dehumidifiedheating or cooling. This setting clearsthe front view more quickly.

5. Windshield—Air flows mainly from thewindshield vents.

Turning the air flow selector to thewindshield position turns on the defog-ging function with the purpose of clear-ing the front view.

This position allows the air intake toselect FRESH automatically. This is toclean up the front view more quickly.

If you want to return the setting toRECIRCULATE mode, press the air in-take selector button once again.

Press the “A/C” button for dehumidifiedheating or cooling. This setting clearsthe front view more quickly.

For details about air flow selector settings,see “—Air flow selector settings” de-scribed below.

Air intake selector

Press the button to select the air source.An indicator light will illuminate to showwhich air intake mode is being selected.

1. Recirculate—Recirculates the air insidethe vehicle.

2. Fresh—Draws outside air into the sys-tem.

To prevent fogging up of the windshield,the air intake mode may change automati-cally to FRESH depending on the condi-tion of the air conditioning system.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1712003 AVALON (OM41401U)

“A/C” button

To turn on the air conditioning, press the“A/C” button. The “A/C” button indicatorwill come on. To turn the air conditioningoff, press the button again.

If the “A/C” button indicator flashes, thereis a problem in the air conditioning systemand the air conditioning automaticallyshuts off. If this happens, take your ve-hicle to your Toyota dealer for service.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

172 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� To cool off your Toyota after it hasbeen parked in the hot sun, drive withthe windows open for a few minutes.This vents the hot air, allowing the airconditioning to cool the interior morequickly.

� Make sure the air intake grilles in frontof the windshield are not blocked (byleaves or snow, for example).

� On humid days, do not blow cold airon the windshield. The windshield couldfog up because of the difference in airtemperature on the inside and outsideof the windshield.

� Keep the area under the front seatsclear to allow air to circulate through-out the vehicle.

� On cold days, set the fan speed tohigh for a minute to help clear theintake ducts of snow or moisture. Thiscan reduce the amount of fogging onthe windows.

� When driving on dusty roads, close allwindows. If dust thrown up by the ve-hicle is still drawn into the vehicle afterclosing the windows, it is recommendedthat the air intake selector be set toFRESH and the fan speed selector toany setting except “OFF”.

—Air flow selector settings

On some models

—Operating tips

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1732003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� If following another vehicle on a dustyroad, or driving in windy and dustyconditions, it is recommended that theair intake selector be temporarily set toRECIRCULATE, which will close off theoutside passage and prevent outsideair and dust from entering the vehicleinterior.

Heating

For best results, set controls to:

Fan speed—Any setting except “OFF”Temperature—Towards WARM

(red zone) Air intake—FRESH (outside air) Air flow—FLOOR Air conditioning—OFF

� For quick heating, select recirculatedair for a few minutes. To keep thewindows from fogging, select fresh af-ter the vehicle interior has beenwarmed.

� Press the “A/C” button on for dehumidi-fied heating.

� Choose floor/windshield air flow to heatthe vehicle interior while defrosting ordefogging the windshield.

Air conditioning

For best results, set controls to:

Fan speed—Any setting except “OFF”Temperature—Towards COLD

(blue zone) Air intake—FRESH (outside air) Air flow—PANEL Air conditioning—ON

� For quick cooling, select recirculatedair for a few minutes.

Ventilation

For best results, set controls to:

Fan speed—Any setting except “OFF”Temperature—Towards COLD

(blue zone)Air intake—FRESH (outside air) Air flow—PANEL Air conditioning—OFF

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

174 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Defogging

The inside of the windshield

For best results, set controls to:

Fan speed—Any setting except “OFF”Temperature—Towards WARM

(red zone) to heat;COLD (blue zone) tocool

Air intake—FRESH (outside air) Air flow—WINDSHIELD

Turning the air flow selector to the wind-shield or floor/windshield position turns onthe defogging function with the purpose ofclearing the front view.

When turning the air flow selector to wind-shield or floor/windshield position, the airintake selects FRESH automatically. Thisis to clean up the front view more quickly.

If you want to return the setting toRECIRCULATE mode, press the air intakeselector button once again.

Press the “A/C” button for dehumidifiedheating or cooling. This setting clears thefront view more quickly.

� On humid days, do not blow cold airon the windshield—the difference be-tween the outside and inside tempera-tures could make the fogging worse.

Defrosting

The outside of the windshield

For best results, set controls to:

Fan speed—Any setting except “OFF”Temperature—Towards WARM

(red zone) Air intake—FRESH (outside air)Air flow—WINDSHIELD

Turning the air flow selector to the wind-shield or floor/windshield position turns onthe defrosting function with the purpose ofclearing the front view.

When turning the air flow selector to wind-shield or floor/windshield position, the airintake selects FRESH automatically. Thisis to clean up the front view more quickly.

If you want to return the setting toRECIRCULATE mode, press the air intakeselector button once again.

Press the “A/C” button for dehumidifiedheating or cooling. This setting clears thefront view more quickly.

� To heat the vehicle interior while de-frosting the windshield, choosefloor/windshield air flow.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1752003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. “AUTO” button

2. “OFF” button

3. Air intake selector

4. Windshield air flow button

5. “A/C” button

6. “DUAL” button

7. Temperature selector (Only for the independent mode thatdisplay shows “DUAL”; mainly for frontpassenger and secondarily for driver)

8. “MODE” button (air flow selector)

9. Fan speed selector

10. Temperature selector(At the independent mode that displayshows “DUAL”; mainly for driver andsecondarily for front passenger)(At the linked mode that display doesnot show “DUAL”; for driver)

Automatic air conditioning system——Controls

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

176 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

“AUTO” button

For automatic operation of the air condi-tioning, press the “AUTO” button. “AUTO”will appear on the display to show thatthe automatic operation mode has beenselected.

In the automatic operation mode, the airconditioning selects the most suitable fanspeed, air flow, air intake and on−off ofthe air conditioning according to the tem-perature.

When you press the “AUTO” button withthe air intake mode at FRESH, internalcirculation may be applied for maximumcooling.

You may use manual controls if you wantto select your own settings.

To turn off the automatic operation, pressthe “OFF” button.

Fan speed selector

Push the “>” (increase) or “<” (decrease)side of the button to adjust the fan speed.

In automatic operation, you do not haveto adjust the fan speed unless you desireanother fan speed mode.

Temperature selector

To increase the temperature, press the“�” side, to decrease it, press the “�”side.

“MAX. COLD” appears when you adjust tomaximum cooling, and “MAX. HOT” whenyou adjust to maximum warming.

The temperature display changes between“�C” and “�F” when the unit of the outsidetemperature display is changed.

“DUAL” button

This switch is used to set the tempera-tures independently for the driver’s seatand front passenger seat.

Pushing the button changes the modefrom independent and linked.

Independent mode: Temperatures can beset independently for the driver’s seat andfront passenger’s seat. “DUAL” will appearon the display to show that the indepen-dent mode has been selected.

Linked mode: The same temperature isset for the driver’s seat and front passen-ger’s seat.

When the temperature for the front pas-senger’s seat is changed in linked mode,the mode is changed automatically to in-dependent mode.

Knowledge for the two−temperature se-lector operation

This air conditioning system has two inde-pendent temperature selectors: left andright (for the use of driver and front pas-senger respectively).

� There are cases where the temperatureof the airflow may not accurately corre-late on the driver and front passengerside according to circumstances, evenif the left and right temperature selec-tors are set at the same temperature.If this situation occurs, use the finetune operation to adjust the air temper-ature on one side.

� There are cases where one or both ofthe airflow temperatures may not accu-rately correlate with the set tempera-ture according to circumstances, whenthe airflow temperature settings on theleft and right are substantially different.For example, if the left controller is setat central or neutral temperature whilethe right one is set at maximum heat-ing or maximum cooling, or vice versa.If this situation occurs, use the finetune operation to adjust the air temper-ature on each side.

“OFF” button

Push the “OFF” button to turn off the airconditioning system.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1772003 AVALON (OM41401U)

“MODE” button (air flow selector)

Push the “MODE” button to select thevents used for air flow.

In automatic operation, you do not haveto select the air flow unless you desireanother air flow mode.

1. Panel—Air flows mainly from theinstrument panel vents.

2. Bi−level—Air flows from both the floorvents and the instrument panel vents.

When you set the temperature selectorsetting at about the middle in automaticoperation, warm air flows out of thefloor vents and relatively low−tempera-ture air flows out of the center andside vents.

3. Floor—Air flows mainly from the floorvents.

4. Floor/Windshield—Air flows mainlyfrom the floor vents and windshieldvents.

Use with the air intake selector posi-tioned in FRESH.

For details about air flow selector settings,see “—Air flow selector settings” de-scribed below.

Windshield air flow button

When this button is pressed, air flowsmainly from the windshield vents andturns on the defogging function with thepurpose of clearing the front view.

Pressing this button once again returnsthe air flow mode to the last one used.

This button allows the air intake to selectFRESH automatically. This is to clean upthe front view more quickly. If you wantto return the setting to RECIRCULATEmode, press the air intake selector buttononce again.

Press the “A/C” button for dehumidifiedheating or cooling. This setting clears thefront view more quickly.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

178 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

For details about air flow selector settings,see “—Air flow selector settings” de-scribed below.

Air intake selector

Press the button to select the air source.The air intake mode which is being se-lected is shown on the display.

1. Recirculate—Recirculates the air insidethe vehicle.

2. Fresh—Draws outside air into the sys-tem.

To prevent fogging up of the windshield,the air intake mode may change automati-cally to FRESH depending on the condi-tion of the air conditioning system.

For example, when the ambient tempera-ture is low, the air intake mode maychange automatically to FRESH. This isnot a malfunction.

“A/C” button

To turn on the air conditioning, press the“A/C” button. The “A/C” button indicatorwill come on. To turn the air conditioningoff, press the button again.

If the “A/C” button indicator flashes, thereis a problem in the air conditioning systemand the air conditioning automaticallyshuts off. If this happens, take your ve-hicle to your Toyota dealer for service.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1792003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� To cool off your Toyota after it hasbeen parked in the hot sun, drive withthe windows open for a few minutes.This vents the hot air, allowing the airconditioning to cool the interior morequickly.

� Make sure the air intake grilles in frontof the windshield are not blocked (byleaves or snow, for example).

� On humid days, do not blow cold airon the windshield. The windshield couldfog up because of the difference in airtemperature on the inside and outsideof the windshield.

� Keep the area under the front seatsclear to allow air to circulate through-out the vehicle.

� On cold days, set the fan speed tohigh for a minute to help clear theintake ducts of snow or moisture. Thiscan reduce the amount of fogging onthe windows.

� When driving on dusty roads, close allwindows. If dust thrown up by the ve-hicle is still drawn into the vehicle afterclosing the windows, it is recommendedthat the air intake selector be set toFRESH and the fan speed selector toany setting except OFF.

On some models

—Air flow selector settings —Operating tips

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

180 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� If following another vehicle on a dustyroad, or driving in windy and dustyconditions, it is recommended that theair intake selector be temporarily set toRECIRCULATE, which will close off theoutside passage and prevent outsideair and dust from entering the vehicleinterior.

Heating

For best results, set controls to:

—For automatic operation

Press in the “AUTO” button.Temperature—To the desired

temperatureAir intake—FRESH (outside air)Air conditioning—OFF

—For manual operation

Fan speed—To the desired fan speedTemperature—Towards high temperatureAir intake—FRESH (outside air)Air flow—FLOORAir conditioning—OFF

� For quick heating, select recirculatedair for a few minutes. To keep thewindows from fogging, select fresh af-ter the vehicle interior has beenwarmed.

� Press the “A/C” button on for dehumidi-fied heating.

� Choose floor/windshield air flow to heatthe vehicle interior while defrosting ordefogging the windshield.

Air conditioning

For best results, set controls to:

—For automatic operation

Press in the “AUTO” button.Temperature—To the desired

temperatureAir intake—FRESH (outside air)Air conditioning—ON

—For manual operation

Fan speed—To the desired fan speedTemperature—Towards low temperatureAir intake—FRESH (outside air)Air flow—PANELAir conditioning—ON

� For quick cooling, select recirculatedair for a few minutes.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1812003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Ventilation

For best results, set controls to:

—For automatic operation

Press in the “AUTO” button.Temperature—Towards low temperatureAir intake—FRESH (outside air)Air conditioning—OFF

—For manual operation

Fan speed—To the desired fan speedTemperature—Towards low temperatureAir intake—FRESH (outside air)Air flow—PANELAir conditioning—OFF

Defogging and defrosting

—The inside of the windshield

For best results, set controls to:

—For automatic operation

Temperature—Towards high temperatureto heat; low temperatureto cool

Air intake—FRESH (outside air)Air flow—WINDSHIELD

—For manual operation

Fan speed—To the desired fan speedTemperature—Towards high temperature

to heat; low temperatureto cool

Air intake—FRESH (outside air)Air flow—WINDSHIELD

Pressing the windshield air flow buttonturns on the defogging function with thepurpose of clearing the front view.

When pressing the windshield air flow but-ton, the air intake selects FRESH auto-matically. This is to clean up the frontview more quickly.

If you want to return the setting toRECIRCULATE mode, press the air intakeselector button once again.

Press the “A/C” button for dehumidifiedheating or cooling. This setting clears thefront view more quickly.

� On humid days, do not blow cold airon the windshield—the difference be-tween the outside and inside tempera-tures could make the fogging worse.

—The outside of the windshield

For best results, set controls to:

—For automatic operation

Temperature—Towards high temperatureAir intake—FRESH (outside air)Air flow—WINDSHIELD

—For manual operation

Fan speed—To the desired fan speedTemperature—Towards high temperatureAir intake—FRESH (outside air)Air flow—WINDSHIELD

Pressing the windshield air flow buttonturns on the defrosting function with thepurpose of clearing the front view.

When pressing the windshield air flow but-ton, the air intake selects FRESH auto-matically. This is to clean up the frontview more quickly.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

182 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If you want to return the setting toRECIRCULATE mode, press the air intakeselector button once again.

Press the “A/C” button for dehumidifiedheating or cooling. This setting clears thefront view more quickly.

� To heat the vehicle interior while de-frosting the windshield, choosefloor/windshield air flow.

If air flow control is not satisfactory, checkthe side vents. The side vents may beopened or closed as shown.

This air conditioning system has a highefficient air refiner filter which helpseliminate dust and pollen, thereby in-creasing your driving comfort.

The air conditioning filter is set behind theglove box.

Side vents Air conditioning filter

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1832003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The filter information label is placed onthe inside of the glove box as shown.

CHECKING AND REPLACING AIRCONDITIONING FILTER

The air conditioning filter may clog afterlong use. The filter may need to be re-placed if the air flow of the air conditionerand heater experiences extreme reductionsin operating efficiency, or if the windowsbecome to fog up easily.

Perform filter replacement periodically.

Period of replacement (expected):For U.S.A.—Every 22500 milesFor Canada—Every 16000 km

Notes: This is the normal maintenance period. This may change depending on operating conditions.

If the symptoms of air conditioningefficiency problems occur, contact yourToyota dealer to have the filter checkedand replaced.

(Actual replacement time: Less than 10minutes approximately)

NOTICE

Do not try to replace the air condi-tioning filter by yourself. Doing somay damage the vehicle.

INFORMATION

The air filter should be installed prop-erly in position. The use of air condi-tioning with the air filter removedmay cause deteriorated dustproof per-formance and then affect air condi-tioning performance.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

184 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1852003 AVALON (OM41401U)

OPERATION OF INSTRUMENTS ANDCONTROLSOther equipmentMulti−information display 186. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clock 195. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Outside temperature display 195. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cigarette lighter and ashtray 195. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power outlet 196. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Glove box 199. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Garage door opener 199. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Auxiliary box 202. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front cup holder 204. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear cup holder 205. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Floor mat 207. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 1− 9

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

186 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Outside temperature display

2. Clock

3. Compass

4. Calendar

5. Cruise information display

6. “LIGHT” button

7. “MODE” button

8. “RESET/ADJ” button

9. “DISPLAY” button

Multi−information display—

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1872003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Operate the multi−information displaywith the ignition switch on.

When the ignition switch is turned to“ON”, the last previously used mode dis-played just before the ignition switch isturned off will appear.

If the electrical power source has beendisconnected from the multi−informationdisplay, the display will automatically beset to the initial mode.

When the instrument panel lights areturned on, the brightness of the displaywill be reduced.

“LIGHT” button

This button is used to select the illumi-nation pattern of the display.

Every time you push the “LIGHT” button,the display illuminates in the following or-der.

1. All the parts of the display are illumi-nated.

2. Clock, outside temperature display andcompass are illuminated.

3. Illumination is off.

“MODE” and “RESET/ADJ” buttons

These buttons are used to select theitem to be reset or adjusted.

Every time you push the “MODE” button,the display toggles in the following order.

1. Hour

2. Minute

3. Year

4. Month

5. Day

6. English or metric unit selection of theoutside temperature display and cruiseinformation display

7. Compass deviation calibration (zone)

8. Compass circling calibration

—Before using themulti−information display

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

188 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

When the item desired to be correctedappears, reset or adjust it by pushing the“RESET/ADJ” button.

“DISPLAY” button

This button is used to toggle the func-tions of the cruise information display.

Every time you push the “DISPLAY” but-ton, the display toggles.

For more details, see “—Cruiseinformation display”.

CAUTION

Do not adjust the display while thevehicle is moving. Be sure to adjustthe display only when the vehicle isstopped.

The digital clock indicates the time.

If the electrical power source has beendisconnected, the time display will auto-matically be set to 1:00 a.m.

To reset the hour: Push the “MODE” but-ton until the hour display appears andblinks. Then push the “RESET/ADJ” but-ton.To reset the minutes: Push the “MODE”button until the minute display appearsand blinks. Then push the “RESET/ADJ”button.

After resetting the clock, push the “MODE”button until the display returns to normalcalendar mode.

The digital calendar indicates the date.

If the electrical power source has beendisconnected, the calendar display will au-tomatically be set to “THU JAN 1”.

To reset the year: Push the “MODE” but-ton until the year display appears andblinks. Then push the “RESET/ADJ” but-ton. (After the year 2021 appears, thenumber returns to 2002.)To reset the month: Push the “MODE”button until the month display appears andblinks. Then push the “RESET/ADJ” but-ton.To reset the day: Push the “MODE” buttonuntil the day display appears and blinks.Then push the “RESET/ADJ” button.

—Clock —Calendar

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1892003 AVALON (OM41401U)

After resetting the calendar, push the“MODE” button until the display returns tonormal calendar mode.

The outside temperature display indi-cates outside air temperatures.

To set the unit, push the “MODE” buttonuntil the unit display appears and blinks.Then push the “RESET/ADJ” button to se-lect “�C” or “�F”. (At this time, cruiseinformation and air conditioning displaysalso change.)

After setting the unit, push the “MODE”button until the display returns to normalcalendar mode.

—Outside temperature display —Cruise information display

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

190 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The cruise information display indicatesthe following information.

1. Instantaneous fuel consumption

2. Average fuel consumption after refuel-ing

3. Average vehicle speed

4. Driving range

5. Driving time

Every time you push the “DISPLAY” but-ton, the display toggles through this infor-mation.

The displayed values in the cruise infor-mation display indicate general drivingconditions. Accuracy varies with drivinghabits and road conditions.

If the electrical power source has beendisconnected, the display will automaticallybe set to instantaneous fuel consumption.

To set the unit, push the “MODE” buttonuntil the unit display appears and blinks.Then push the “RESET/ADJ” button to se-lect km/liter or mile/gallon. (At this time,the outside temperature and air condition-ing displays also change.)

After setting the unit, push the “MODE”button until the display returns to normalcalendar mode.

1. Instantaneous fuel consumption(“INST ECON”)

The instantaneous fuel consumption iscalculated and displayed based on driv-ing distance and fuel consumption for2 seconds with the engine running.

The displayed value is updated every 2seconds.

Note that an accurate figure may not beshown in the following cases.

� When the vehicle is stopped with theengine running, the display will indicatethe extremely high fuel consumption.

� When the vehicle is driving down along slope, applying the engine brake,the display will indicate the extremelylow fuel consumption.

The calculation is reset when the ignitionswitch is turned off.

2. Average fuel consumption after re-fueling(“AVG ECON”)

Average fuel consumption after refuel-ing is calculated and displayed basedon total driving distance and total fuelconsumption with the engine running.

The displayed value is updated every 10seconds.

To reset the calculations, push the“RESET/ADJ” button.

The calculation is reset when the ignitionswitch is turned off.

3. Average vehicle speed(“AVG SPEED”)

Average vehicle speed is calculated anddisplayed based on total driving dis-tance and total driving time with theengine running.

The displayed value is updated every 10seconds.

To reset the calculations, push the“RESET/ADJ” button.

The calculation is reset when the ignitionswitch is turned off.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1912003 AVALON (OM41401U)

4. Driving range(“FUEL RANGE”)

The distance the vehicle can travel withthe remaining fuel is calculated anddisplayed based on the quantity of re-maining fuel and past fuel consumption.

The displayed value is updated every timewhen the fuel equivalent for 1 km is con-sumed.

Every time you refuel the vehicle, thedriving range calculation is automaticallyreset.

The actual driving range varies with driv-ing habits and road conditions. If fuel con-sumption is good, the driving range will belonger. If fuel consumption is poor, thedriving range will be shorter.

5. Driving time(“TRIP TIME”)

The elapsed time after the engine startsis displayed.

When the engine is started, driving timeis counted from 0:00. Up to 99:59 (99hours, 59 minutes) can be displayed.When the driving time exceeds 99:59, thecounter returns to 0:00.

To reset the calculations, push the“RESET/ADJ” button.

The calculation is reset when the ignitionswitch is turned off.

The compass indicates the directionthat the vehicle is heading. In theabove case, it shows that the vehicle isheading south.

Displays Directions

NNEE

SES

SWW

NW

NorthNortheast

EastSoutheast

SouthSouthwest

WestNorthwest

—Compass

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

192 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The compass may not show the correctdirection in the following conditions:

� The vehicle is stopped immediately af-ter turning.

The compass does not adjust while thevehicle is stopped.

� The ignition switch is turned off imme-diately after turning.

� The vehicle is on an inclined surface.

� The vehicle is in a place where theearth’s magnetic field is subject to in-terference by artificial magnetic fields(underground parking, under a steeltower, between buildings, roof parking,near a crossing, near a large vehicle,etc.).

� The vehicle is magnetized. (There is amagnet or a metal object on or nearthe roof.)

� The battery has been disconnected.

The compass works to calibrate the direc-tion automatically while the vehicle is inmotion, if deviation is small.

For additional precision or for completecalibrating, see “CALIBRATING THECOMPASS” below.

Compass sensor

NOTICE

Do not put magnets or a metal objecton or near the roof of the vehicle.Doing this may cause malfunction ofthe compass sensor.

CALIBRATING THE COMPASS (deviationcalibration)

The direction display on the compassdeviates from the true direction deter-mined by the earth’s magnetic field. Theangle of deviation varies according to thegeographic position of the vehicle.

To adjust for this deviation, stop the ve-hicle and push the “MODE” button severaltimes until “ZONE XX” appears on thecalendar display. Then push the “RESET/ADJ” button, referring to the following mapto select the number of the zone wherethe vehicle is.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1932003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Zone number

After calibration, push the “MODE” buttonseveral times until the calendar displayreturns to the normal mode.

CAUTION

Do not adjust the display while thevehicle is moving. Be sure to adjustthe display only when the vehicle isstopped.

Hawaii, Samoa: 5Guam, Saipan: 8

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

194 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CALIBRATING THE COMPASS (circlingcalibration)

Sometimes the direction display on thecompass may not change after a turn. Torectify this, stop the vehicle and push the“MODE” button several times until“COMPASS” appears and blinks on thedisplay. Then push the “RESET/ADJ” but-ton. “CALIBRATE” appears and blinks to-gether with the compass display.

Drive the vehicle in a circle until the blink-ing stops. If there is not enough space todrive in a circle, drive around the blockuntil the blinking stops.

When the compass and the calendar dis-play return to normal mode, calibration iscomplete.

If you want to cancel the calibration be-fore it is complete, push the “MODE” but-ton again.

Perform circling calibration just afteryou have purchased your Toyota. Andthen always perform circling calibrationafter the battery has been removed, re-placed or disconnected.

� Do not perform circling calibration ofthe compass in a place where theearth’s magnetic field is subject to in-terference by artificial magnetic fields(underground parking, under a steeltower, between buildings, roof parking,near a crossing, near a large vehicle,etc.).

� During calibration, do not operate elec-tric systems (moon roof, power win-dows, etc.) as they may interfere withthe calibration.

CAUTION

� When doing the circling calibration,be sure to secure a wide space,and watch out for people and ve-hicles in the neighborhood. Do notviolate any local traffic rules whileperforming circling calibration.

� Do not adjust the display while thevehicle is moving. Be sure to adjustthe display only when the vehicle isstopped.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1952003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The digital clock indicates the time.

The key must be in the “ON” position.

To reset the hour: Push the “MODE” but-ton until the hour display blinks. Thenpush the “ADJ” button.To reset the minutes: Push the “MODE”button until the minute display blinks.Then push the “ADJ” button.

If the electrical power source has beendisconnected from the clock, the time dis-play will automatically be set to 1:00 (oneo’clock).

When the instrument panel lights areturned on, the brightness of the time in-dication will be reduced.

The outside temperature display indi-cates the outside air temperatures withthe ignition key at the “ON” position.

When the instrument panel lights areturned on, the brightness of the displaywill be reduced.

To change the display between “�C” to“�F”, push the “MODE” button until thedisplay blinks. Then push the “ADJ” buttonto select “�C” or “�F”.

With bucket front seat

With bench type front seat

Clock Outside temperature display Cigarette lighter and ashtray

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

196 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CIGARETTE LIGHTER

To use the cigarette lighter, first openthe ashtray lid, then press in the light-er. After it finishes heating up, it auto-matically pops out ready for use.

If the engine is not running, the key mustbe in the “ACC” position.

Do not hold the cigarette lighter pressedin.

Use a Toyota genuine cigarette lighter orequivalent for replacement.

ASHTRAY

With bucket front seat—To use the ash-tray, push the lid to open.

With bench type front seat—To use theashtray, pull the lid to open.

When finished with your cigarette, thor-oughly extinguish it in the ashtray to pre-vent other cigarette butts from catchingfire. After using the ashtray, push it backin completely.

To remove the ashtray, open the ashtraylid and pull it out.

CAUTION

To reduce the chance of injury incase of an accident or sudden stopwhile driving, always completely closethe ashtray after use.

With bucket front seat

With bench type front seat

Power outlet (12 VDC)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1972003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The power outlet is designed for powersupply for car accessories.

The key must be in the “ACC” or “ON”position for the power outlet to be used.

NOTICE

� To prevent the fuse from beingblown, do not use the electricityover the total vehicle capacity of 12VDC/120W.

� To prevent the battery from beingdischarged, do not use the poweroutlet longer than necessary whenthe engine is not running.

� Close the power outlet lid when thepower outlet is not in use. Insertinga foreign object other than the ap-propriate plug that fits the outlet,or allowing any liquid into the out-let may cause electrical failure orshort circuits.

With bucket front seat

With bench type front seat

This power outlet is designed for useas a power supply for electric ap-pliances in the vehicle.

The key must be in the “ON” position forthe power outlet to be used.

The maximum capacity for this power out-let is 115 VAC/100W. If you attempt touse an appliance that requires more than115 VAC or 100W, the protection circuitwill activate and cut the power supply.The power supply will restart automaticallywhen you use an appliance that operateswithin the 115 VAC/100W limits.

Power outlet (115 VAC)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

198 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Main switch

To use the power outlet, push the mainswitch on the instrument panel.

An indicator light will illuminate to indicatethat the power outlet is ready for use.

Push the main switch once again to turnthe power outlet off. When the power out-let is not in use, make sure that the mainswitch is turned off.

NOTICE

� To prevent the battery from beingdischarged, do not use the poweroutlet longer than necessary whenthe engine is not running.

� Close the power outlet lid when thepower outlet is not in use. Insertinga foreign object other than the ap-propriate plug that fits the outletmay cause electrical failure or shortcircuits.

The power outlet is not designed forthe following electric appliances eventhough their power consumption is un-der 115 VAC/100W. These appliancesmay not operate properly.

� Appliances with high initial peak watt-age: cathode−ray tube type televisions,compressor−driven refrigerators, electricpumps, electric tools, etc.

� Measuring devices which process pre-cise data: medical equipment, measur-ing instruments, etc.

� Other appliances requiring an extremelystable power supply: microcomputer−controlled electric blankets, touch sen-sor lamps, etc.

Certain electrical appliances may causeradio noise.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

1992003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To use the glove box, do this.

To open: Pull the lever.

With the instrument panel lights on, theglove box light will come on when theglove box is open.

To lock: Insert the master key and turn itclockwise.

CAUTION

To reduce the chance of injury incase of an accident or a sudden stop,always keep the glove box doorclosed while driving.

The garage door opener (HomeLink�

Universal Transceiver) is manufacturedunder license from HomeLink� and canbe programmed to operate garagedoors, gates, entry doors, door locks,home lighting systems, and securitysystems, etc.

(a) Programming the HomeLink�

The HomeLink� in your vehicle has 3buttons and you can store one programfor each button.

To ensure correct programming into theHomeLink�, install a new battery in thehand−held transmitter prior to program-ming.

The battery side of the hand−held trans-mitter must be pointed away from theHomeLink� during the programming pro-cess.

For Canadian users, follow the procedurein “Programming an entrance gate/Pro-gramming all devices in the Canadianmarket”.

1. Decide which of 3 HomeLink� buttonsyou want to program.

2. Place your hand−held garage transmit-ter 25 to 75 mm (1 to 3 in.) away fromthe surface of the HomeLink�.

Keep the indicator light on the HomeLink�

in view while programming.

Glove box Garage door opener

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

200 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

3. Simultaneously press and hold thehand−held garage transmitter buttonalong with the selected HomeLink� but-ton.

4. When the indicator light on theHomeLink� changes from a slow to arapid flash after 20 seconds, you canrelease both buttons.

5. Test the operation of the HomeLink� bypressing the newly programmed button.If programming a garage door opener,check to see if the garage door opensand closes.

If the garage door does not operate, iden-tify if your garage transmitter is of the“Rolling Code” type. Press and hold theprogrammed HomeLink� button. The ga-rage door has the rolling code feature ifthe indicator light (on the HomeLink�)flashes rapidly and then remains lit after2 seconds. If your garage transmitter isthe “Rolling Code” type, proceed to theheading “Programming a rolling code sys-tem”.

6. Repeat steps 2 through 5 for each re-maining HomeLink� button to programanother device.

Programming a rolling code system

If your device is “Rolling Code”equipped, it is necessary to followsteps 1 through 4 under the heading“Programming the HomeLink�” beforeproceeding with the steps listed below.

1. Locate the “training” button on the ceil-ing mounted garage door opener motor.The exact location and color of thebutton may vary by brand of garagedoor opener. Refer to the owner’sguide supplied by the garage dooropener manufacturer for the location ofthis “training” button.

2. Press the “training” button on the ceil-ing mounted garage door opener motor.

Following this step, you have 30 secondsin which to initiate step 3 below.

3. Press and release the vehicle’s pro-grammed HomeLink� button twice. Thegarage door may open. If the doordoes open, the programming process iscomplete. If the door does not open,press and release the button a thirdtime. This third press and release willcomplete the programming process byopening the garage door.

The ceiling mounted garage door openermotor should now recognize theHomeLink� unit and be able activate thegarage door up/down.

4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 for each re-maining HomeLink� button to programanother rolling code system.

Programming an entrance gate/Program-ming all devices in the Canadian market

1. Decide which of the 3 HomeLink� but-tons you want to program.

2. Place your hand−held gate/devicetransmitter 25 to 75 mm (1 to 3 in.)away from the surface of theHomeLink�.

Keep the indicator light on the HomeLink�

in view while programming.

3. Press and hold the selectedHomeLink� button.

4. Continuously press and release (cycle)the hand−held gate/device transmitterbutton every two seconds until step 5is complete.

5. When the indicator light on theHomeLink� changes from a slow to arapid flash after 20 seconds, you canrelease both buttons.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2012003 AVALON (OM41401U)

6. Test the operation of the HomeLink� bypressing the newly programmed button.Check to see if the gate/device oper-ates correctly.

7. Repeat steps 1 through 6 for each re-maining HomeLink� button to programanother device.

Programming other devices

To program other devices such as homesecurity systems, home door locks orlighting, contact your authorized Toyotadealer for assistance.

Reprogramming a button

Individual HomeLink� buttons cannot beerased, however, to reprogram a singlebutton, follow the procedure “Programmingthe HomeLink�”.

(b) Operating the HomeLink�

To operate the HomeLink�, press theappropriate HomeLink� button to activatethe programmed device. The HomeLink�

indicator light should come on. TheHomeLink� continues to send the signalfor up to 20 seconds as long as thebutton is pressed.

(c) Erasing the entire HomeLink�

memory (all three programs)

To erase all previously programmed codesat one time, press and hold down the 2outside buttons for 20 seconds until theindicator light flashes.

If you sell your vehicle, be sure to erasethe programs stored in the HomeLink�

memory.

CAUTION

� When programming the HomeLink�

Universal Transceiver, you may beoperating a garage door or otherdevice. Make sure people and ob-jects are out of the way of the ga-rage door or other device to pre-vent potential harm or damage.

� Do not use this HomeLink� Univer-sal Transceiver with any garagedoor opener that lacks the safetystop and reverse feature as re-quired by federal safety standards.(This includes any garage dooropener model manufactured beforeApril 1, 1982.) A garage door open-er which cannot detect an object(signaling the door to stop and re-verse), does not meet current feder-al safety standards. Using a garagedoor opener without these featuresincreases risk of serious injury ordeath.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

202 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

FCC ID: CB2V94800CANADA: 1763 102 264

This device complies with FCC RulesPart 15. Operation is subject to the fol-lowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept any interfer-ence that may be received, includinginterference that may cause undersiredoperation.

WARNING: This transmitter has beentested and complies with FCC andDOC/MPAC rules. Changes or modifi-cations not expressly approved by thepartly responsible for compliancecould void the user’s authority to op-erate the device.

To use the box, push the lid to open.

CAUTION

To reduce the chance of injury incase of an accident or a sudden stop,always keep the auxiliary box closedwhile driving.

NOTICE

During hot weather, the interior of thevehicle becomes very hot. Do notleave anything flammable or deform-able such as a lighter, glasses, etc.inside.

Auxiliary box (type A)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2032003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To use the box, pull on the handle.

CAUTION

To reduce the chance of injury incase of an accident or a sudden stop,always keep the auxiliary box closedwhile driving.

To use the box, pull down the armrest,pull up the lock release lever and openthe lid.

CAUTION

To reduce the chance of injury incase of an accident or a sudden stop,always keep the auxiliary box closedwhile driving.

To use the box, pull up the lock releaselever and open the lid.

CAUTION

To reduce the chance of injury incase of an accident or a sudden stop,always keep the auxiliary box closedwhile driving.

Auxiliary box (type B) Auxiliary box (type C) Auxiliary box (type D)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

204 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To maximize the storage room, removethe cup holder by pushing the side fac-ing at its upright position.

The cup holder is designed for holdingcups or drink−cans securely.

To use the cup holder, push on the lid.

CAUTION

� Do not place anything else otherthan cups or drink−cans on the cupholder, as such items may bethrown about in the compartmentand possibly injure people in thevehicle during sudden braking or inan accident.

� To reduce the chance of injury incase of an accident or sudden stopwhile driving, keep the cup holderclosed when it is not in use.

Front cup holder (type A)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2052003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The cup holder is designed for holdingcups or drink−cans securely.

To use the cup holder, pull down the arm-rest, pull up the lock release lever andopen the lid.

CAUTION

� Do not place anything else otherthan cups or drink−cans in the cupholder, as such items may bethrown about in the compartmentand possibly injure people in thevehicle during sudden braking or inan accident.

� To reduce the chance of injury incase of an accident or sudden stopwhile driving, keep the cup holderclosed when it is not in use.

� Do not lift the armrest upright whenthe cup holder is pulled out.

The cup holder is designed for holdingcups or drink−cans securely.

To use the cup holder, pull down the arm-rest.

Front cup holder (type B) Rear cup holder (type A)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

206 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

� Do not place anything else otherthan cups or drink−cans in the cupholder, as such items may bethrown about in the compartmentand possibly injure people in thevehicle during sudden braking or inan accident.

� To reduce the chance of injury incase of an accident or sudden stopwhile driving, keep the cup holderclosed when it is not in use.

� Do not lift the armrest upright whenthe cup holder is pulled out.

The cup holder is designed for holdingcups or drink−cans securely.

To use the cup holder, open the armrestlid by pulling up the lock release leverand pull out the cup holder. Then closethe armrest lid.

CAUTION

� Do not leave the armrest lid open,especially when the cup holderholds a scalding hot drink. If the lidis forcibly pulled up, the drink mayspill over the seat occupants.

� When the cup holder is in use, thearmrest lid must be securely closedwith the lock engaged.

� Do not place anything else otherthan cups or drink−cans in the cupholder, as such items may bethrown about in the compartmentand possibly injure people in thevehicle during sudden braking or inan accident.

Rear cup holder (type B)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2072003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� To reduce the chance of injury incase of an accident or sudden stopwhile driving, keep the cup holderclosed when it is not in use.

� Do not lift the armrest upright whenthe cup holder is pulled out.

Use a floor mat of the correct size.

If the floor carpet and floor mat have ahole, then it is designed for use with alocking clip. Fix the floor mat with lockingclip into the hole in the floor carpet.

CAUTION

Make sure the floor mat is properlyplaced on the floor carpet. If the floormat slips and interferes with themovement of the pedals during driv-ing, it may cause an accident.

Floor mat

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

208 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2092003 AVALON (OM41401U)

INFORMATION BEFORE DRIVING YOURTOYOTABreak−in period 210. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel 210. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Operation in foreign countries 212. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Three−way catalytic converters 212. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine exhaust cautions 213. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Facts about engine oil consumption 214. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Iridium−tipped spark plugs 215. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Brake system 215. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Brake pad wear limit indicators 219. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Luggage stowage precautions 219. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Your Toyota’s identification 220. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Theft prevention labels 221. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Suspension and chassis 221. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Types of tires 221. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 2

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

210 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Drive gently and avoid high speeds.

Your vehicle does not need an elaboratebreak−in. But following a few simple tipsfor the first 1600 km (1000 miles) can addto the future economy and long life ofyour vehicle:

� Avoid full throttle acceleration whenstarting and driving.

� Avoid racing the engine.

� Try to avoid hard stops during the first300 km (200 miles).

� Do not drive for a long time at anysingle speed, either fast or slow.

� Do not tow a trailer during the first 800km (500 miles).

FUEL TYPE

Your new vehicle must use only un-leaded gasoline.

To help prevent gas station mix−ups, yourToyota has a smaller fuel tank opening.The special nozzle on pumps with un-leaded fuel will fit it, but the larger stan-dard nozzle on pumps with leaded gas willnot.

At a minimum, the gasoline you useshould meet specifications of ASTMD4814 in the U.S.A. and CGSB 3.5−M93in Canada.

NOTICE

Do not use leaded gasoline. Use ofleaded gasoline will cause the three−way catalytic converter to lose its ef-fectiveness and the emission controlsystem to function improperly. Also,this can increase maintenance costs.

OCTANE RATING

Select Octane Rating 87 (Research Oc-tane Number 91) or higher. For im-proved vehicle performance, the use ofpremium unleaded gasoline with an Oc-tane Rating of 91 (Research OctaneNumber 96) or higher is recommended.

Use of unleaded gasoline with an octanerating or research octane number lowerthan stated above will cause persistentheavy knocking. If it is severe, this willlead to engine damage.

If your engine knocks...

If you detect heavy knocking even whenusing the recommended fuel, or if youhear steady knocking while holding asteady speed on level roads, consult yourToyota dealer.

However, now and then, you may noticelight knocking for a short time while accel-erating or driving up hills. This is no needof concern.

Break−in period Fuel

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2112003 AVALON (OM41401U)

GASOLINE CONTAINING DETERGENTADDITIVES

Toyota recommends the use of gasolinethat contains detergent additives toavoid build−up of engine deposits.

However, all gasoline sold in the U.S.contains detergent additives to keep cleanand/or clean intake systems.

QUALITY GASOLINE

Automotive manufacturers in the U.S.,Europe and Japan have developed aspecification for quality fuel namedWorld−Wide Fuel Charter (WWFC) thatis expected to be applied world wide.The WWFC consists of three categoriesthat depend on required emission lev-els. In the U.S., category 3 has beenadopted. The WWFC improves air quali-ty by providing for better emissions invehicle fleets, and customer satisfactionthrough better vehicle performance.

CLEANER BURNING GASOLINE

Cleaner burning gasoline, including re-formulated gasoline that contains oxy-genates such as ethanol or MTBE isavailable in many areas.

Toyota recommends the use of cleanerburning gasoline and appropriately blendedreformulated gasoline. These types of gas-oline provide excellent vehicle perfor-mance, reduce vehicle emissions, and im-prove air quality.

OXYGENATES IN GASOLINE

Toyota allows the use of oxygenateblended gasoline where the oxygenatecontent is up to 10% ethanol or 15%MTBE. If you use gasohol in yourToyota, be sure that it has an octanerating no lower than 87.

Toyota does not recommend the use ofgasoline containing methanol.

GASOLINE CONTAINING MMT

Some gasoline contain an octane en-hancing additive called MMT (Methylcy-clopentadienyl Manganese Tricarbonyl).

Toyota does not recommend the use ofgasoline that contains MMT. If fuel con-taining MMT is used, your emission con-trol system may be adversely affected.The Malfunction Indicator Lamp on the in-strument cluster may come on. If this hap-pens, contact your Toyota dealer for ser-vice.

GASOLINE QUALITY

In a very few cases, you may experiencedriveability problems caused by the partic-ular gasoline that you are using. If youcontinue to have unacceptable driveability,try changing gasoline brands. If this doesnot rectify your problem, then consult yourToyota dealer.

NOTICE

� Do not use gasohol other thanstated above. It will cause fuel sys-tem damage or vehicle performanceproblems.

� If driveability problems occur (poorhot starting, vaporizing, engineknock, etc.), discontinue the use.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

212 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Take care not to spill gasohol dur-ing refueling. Gasohol may causepaint damage.

FUEL TANK CAPACITY

70 L (18.5 gal., 15.4 Imp. gal.)

If you plan to drive your Toyota inanother country...

First, comply with the vehicle registrationlaws.

Second, confirm the availability of the cor-rect fuel (unleaded and minimum octanenumber).

The three−way catalytic converter is anemission control device installed in theexhaust system.

The purpose is to reduce pollutants in theexhaust gas.

CAUTION

� Keep people and combustible mate-rials away from the exhaust pipewhile the engine is running. Theexhaust gas is very hot.

� Do not drive, idle or park your ve-hicle over anything that might burneasily such as grass, leaves, paperor rags.

Operation in foreign countries Three−way catalytic converters

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2132003 AVALON (OM41401U)

NOTICE

A large amount of unburned gasesflowing into the three−way catalyticconverter may cause it to overheatand create a fire hazard. To preventthis and other damage, observe thefollowing precautions:

� Use only unleaded gasoline.

� Do not drive with an extremely lowfuel level; running out of fuel couldcause the engine to misfire, creat-ing an excessive load on the three−way catalytic converter.

� Do not allow the engine to run atidle speed for more than 20 min-utes.

� Avoid racing the engine.

� Do not push−start or pull−start yourvehicle.

� Do not turn off the ignition whilethe vehicle is moving.

� Keep your engine in good runningorder. Malfunctions in the engineelectrical system, electronic ignitionsystem/distributor ignition systemor fuel system could cause an ex-tremely high three−way catalyticconverter temperature.

� If the engine becomes difficult tostart or stalls frequently, take yourvehicle in for a check−up as soonas possible. Remember, your Toyotadealer knows your vehicle and itsthree−way catalytic converter sys-tem best.

� To ensure that the three−way cata-lytic converter and the entire emis-sion control system operate proper-ly, your vehicle must receive theperiodic inspections required by theToyota Maintenance Schedule. Forscheduled maintenance information,refer to the “Scheduled MaintenanceGuide” or “Owner’s Manual Supple-ment”.

CAUTION

� Avoid inhaling the engine exhaust.It contains carbon monoxide, whichis a colorless and odorless gas. Itcan cause unconsciousness or evendeath.

� Make sure the exhaust system hasno holes or loose connections. Thesystem should be checked fromtime to time. If you hit something,or notice a change in the sound ofthe exhaust, have the systemchecked immediately.

� Do not run the engine in a garageor enclosed area except for thetime needed to drive the vehicle inor out. The exhaust gases cannotescape, making this a particularlydangerous situation.

� Do not remain for a long time in aparked vehicle with the engine run-ning. If it is unavoidable, however,do so only in an unconfined areaand adjust the heating or coolingsystem to force outside air into thevehicle.

Engine exhaust cautions

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

214 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Keep the trunk lid closed whiledriving. An open or unsealed trunklid may cause exhaust gases to bedrawn into the vehicle.

� To allow proper operation of yourvehicle’s ventilation system, keepthe inlet grilles in front of the wind-shield clear of snow, leaves, or oth-er obstructions.

� If you smell exhaust fumes in thevehicle, drive with the windowsopen and the trunk lid closed. Havethe cause immediately located andcorrected.

FUNCTIONS OF ENGINE OIL

Engine oil has the primary functions oflubricating and cooling the inside of theengine, and plays a major role in main-taining the engine in proper working order.

ENGINE OIL CONSUMPTION

It is normal that an engine should con-sume some engine oil during normalengine operation. The causes of oilconsumption in a normal engine are asfollows.

� Oil is used to lubricate pistons, pistonrings and cylinders. A thin film of oilis left on the cylinder wall when a pis-ton moves downwards in the cylinder.High negative pressure generated whenthe vehicle is decelerating sucks someof this oil into the combustion chamber.This oil as well as some part of the oilfilm left on the cylinder wall is burnedby the high temperature combustiongases during the combustion process.

� Oil is also used to lubricate the stemsof the intake valves. Some of this oilis sucked into the combustion chambertogether with the intake air and isburned along with the fuel. High tem-perature exhaust gases also burn theoil used to lubricate the exhaust valvestems.

The amount of engine oil consumed de-pends on the viscosity of the oil, thequality of the oil and the conditions thevehicle is driven under.

More oil is consumed by high−speed driv-ing and frequent acceleration and decel-eration.

A new engine consumes more oil, sinceits pistons, piston rings and cylinder wallshave not become conditioned.

When judging the amount of oil con-sumption, note the that oil may becomediluted and make it difficult to judgethe true level accurately.

As an example, if a vehicle is used forrepeated short trips, and consumes a nor-mal amount of oil, the dipstick may notshow any drop in the oil level at all, evenafter 1000 km (600 miles) or more. Thisis because the oil is gradually becomingdiluted with fuel or moisture, making itappear that the oil level has not changed.

Facts about engine oilconsumption

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2152003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The diluting ingredients evaporate outwhen the vehicle is then driven at highspeeds, as on an expressway, making itappear that oil is excessively consumedafter driving at high speeds.

IMPORTANCE OF ENGINE OIL LEVELCHECK

One of the most important points in prop-er vehicle maintenance is to keep the en-gine oil at the optimum level so that oilfunction will not be impaired. Therefore, itis essential that the oil level be checkedregularly. Toyota recommends that the oillevel be checked every time you refuelthe vehicle.

NOTICE

Failure to check the oil level regularlycould lead to serious engine troubledue to insufficient oil.

For detailed information on oil level check,see “Checking the engine oil level” in Sec-tion 7−2.

Your engine is fitted with iridium−tippedspark plugs.

NOTICE

Use only iridium−tipped spark plugsand do not adjust gaps for your en-gine performance and smooth drive-ability.

The tandem master cylinder brake systemis a hydraulic system with two separatesub−systems. If either sub−system shouldfail, the other will still work. However, thepedal will be harder to press, and yourstopping distance will be longer. Also, thebrake system warning light may come on.

CAUTION

Do not drive your vehicle with only asingle brake system. Have yourbrakes fixed immediately.

BRAKE BOOSTER

The brake booster uses engine vacuum topower−assist the brakes. If the engineshould quit while you are driving, you canbring the vehicle to a stop with normalpedal pressure. There is enough reservedvacuum for one or two stops—but nomore!

Iridium−tipped spark plugs Brake system

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

216 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

� Do not pump the brake pedal if theengine stalls. Each push on thepedal uses up your reserved vacu-um.

� Even if the power assist is com-pletely lost, the brakes will stillwork. But you will have to push thepedal hard, much harder than nor-mal. And your braking distance willbe longer.

ANTI−LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (with “ABS” warning light)

The anti−lock brake system is designedto help prevent lock−up of the wheelsduring a sudden braking or braking onslippery road surfaces. This assists inproviding directional stability and steer-ing performance of the vehicle underthese circumstances.

Effective way to press the ABS brakepedal: When the anti−lock brake systemfunction is in action, you may feel thebrake pedal pulsating and hear a noise.In this situation, to let the anti−lockbrake system work for you, just hold thebrake pedal down more firmly. Do notpump the brake in a panic stop. Thiswill result in reduced braking performan-ce.

The anti−lock brake system becomes op-erative after the vehicle has acceleratedto a speed in excess of approximately 10km/h (6 mph). It stops operating when thevehicle decelerates to a speed belowapproximately 5 km/h (3 mph).

Depressing the brake pedal on slipperyroad surfaces such as on the manholecover, the steel plate under the construc-tion, joints in the bridge, etc. on a rainyday tends to activate the anti−lock brakesystem.

You may hear a click or motor sound inthe engine compartment for a few secondswhen the engine is started or just afterthe vehicle is started. This means that theanti−lock brake system is in the selfcheck mode, and does not indicate a mal-function.

When the anti−lock brake system is ac-tivated, the following conditions mayoccur. They do not indicate a malfunc-tion of the system:

� You may hear the anti−lock brake sys-tem operating and feel the brake pedalpulsating and the vibrations of the ve-hicle body and steering wheel. Youmay also hear the motor sound in theengine compartment even after the ve-hicle is stopped.

� At the end of the anti−lock brake sys-tem activation, the brake pedal maymove a little forward.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2172003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

Do not overestimate the anti−lockbrake system: Although the anti−lockbrake system assists in providing ve-hicle control, it is still important todrive with all due care and maintaina moderate speed and safe distancefrom the vehicle in front of you, be-cause there are limits to the vehiclestability and effectiveness of steeringwheel operation even with the anti−lock brake system on.

If tires grip performance exceeds itscapability, or if hydroplaning occursduring high speed driving in the rain,the anti−lock brake system does notprovide vehicle control.

Anti−lock brake system is not de-signed to shorten the stopping dis-tance: Always drive at the moderatespeed and maintain a safe distancefrom the vehicle in front of you.Compared with vehicles without ananti−lock brake system, your vehiclemay require a longer stopping dis-tance in the following cases:

� Driving on rough, gravel or snow−covered roads.

� Driving with tire chains installed.

� Driving over the steps such as thejoints on the road.

� Driving on roads where the roadsurface is pitted or has other differ-ences in surface height.

Install all 4 tires of specified size atappropriate pressure: The anti−lockbrake system detects vehicle speedsusing the speed sensors for respec-tive wheels’ turning speeds. The useof tires other than specified may failto detect the accurate turning speedresulting in a longer stopping dis-tance.

Type A

Type B

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

218 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

“ABS” warning light

The light comes on when the ignition keyis turned to the “ON” position. If the anti−lock brake system and the brake assistsystem work properly, the light turns offafter a few seconds. Thereafter, if thesystem malfunctions, the light comes onagain.

When the “ABS” warning light is on (andthe brake system warning light is off), theanti−lock brake system, the brake assistsystem, the traction control system andthe vehicle skid control system do notoperate, but the brake system still oper-ates conventionally.

When the “ABS” warning light is on (andthe brake system warning light is off), theanti−lock brake system does not operateso that the wheels could lock up duringa sudden braking or braking on slipperyroad surfaces.

If either of the following conditionsoccurs, this indicates a malfunctionsomewhere in the parts monitored bythe warning light. Contact your Toyotadealer as soon as possible to servicethe vehicle.

� The light does not come on when theignition key is turned to the “ON” posi-tion, or remains on.

� The light comes on while you are driv-ing.

A warning light turning on briefly duringoperation does not indicate a problem.

CAUTION

If the “ABS” warning light remains ontogether with the brake system warn-ing light, immediately stop your ve-hicle at a safe place and contact yourToyota dealer.

In this case, not only the anti−lockbrake system will fail but also thevehicle will become extremely unsta-ble during braking.

DRUM−IN−DISC TYPE PARKING BRAKESYSTEM

Your vehicle has a drum−in−disc typeparking brake system. This type of brakesystem needs bedding−down of the brakeshoes periodically or whenever the parkingbrake shoes and/or drums are replaced.

Have your Toyota dealer perform the bed-ding−down.

BRAKE ASSIST SYSTEM

When you slam the brakes on, thebrake assist system judges as an emer-gency stop and provides more powerfulbraking for a driver who cannot holddown the brake pedal firmly.

When you slam the brakes on, more pow-erful braking will be applied. At this time,you may hear a sound in the enginecompartment and feel the vibration of thebrake pedal. This does not indicate a mal-function.

The brake assist system becomes opera-tive after the vehicle has accelerated toa speed in excess of approximately 10km/h (6 mph). It stops operating when thevehicle decelerates to a speed belowapproximately 5 km/h (3 mph).

For an explanation of this system’s warn-ing light, see “Service reminder indicatorsand warning buzzers” in Section 1−5.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2192003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The brake pad wear limit indicators onyour disc brakes give a warning noisewhen the brake pads are worn to wherereplacement is required.

If you hear a squealing or scraping noisewhile driving, have the brake padschecked and replaced by your Toyotadealer as soon as possible. Expensive ro-tor damage can result if the pads are notreplaced when necessary.

When stowing luggage or cargo in thevehicle, observe the following:

� Put luggage or cargo in the trunk whenat all possible. Be sure all items aresecured in place.

� Be careful to keep the vehicle bal-anced. Locating the weight as far for-ward as possible helps maintain bal-ance.

� For better fuel economy, do not carryunneeded weight.

CAUTION

� Never allow anyone to ride in theenlarged trunk. It is not designedfor passengers. They should ride intheir seats with their seat beltsproperly fastened. Otherwise, theyare much more likely to suffer seri-ous bodily injury, in the event ofsudden braking or a collision.

� Do not place anything on the pack-age tray behind the rear seatback.Such items may be thrown aboutand possibly injure people in thevehicle during sudden braking or anaccident.

� Do not drive with objects left ontop of the instrument panel. Theymay interfere with the driver’s fieldof view. Or they may move duringsharp vehicle acceleration or turn-ing, and impair the driver’s controlof the vehicle. In an accident theymay injure the vehicle occupants.

NOTICE

Do not load the vehicle beyond thevehicle capacity weight specified inSection 8.

Brake pad wear limitindicators Luggage stowage precautions

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

220 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The vehicle identification number (VIN)is the legal identifier for your vehicle.This number is on the left top of theinstrument panel, and can be seenthrough the windshield from outside.

This is the primary identification numberfor your Toyota. It is used in registeringthe ownership of your vehicle.

The vehicle identification number (VIN) isalso on the Certification Label.

The engine number is stamped on theengine block as shown.

Your Toyota’s identification——Vehicle identificationnumber —Engine number

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2212003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Your new vehicle carries theft preven-tion labels which are approximately 56mm (2.20 in.) by 16 mm (0.63 in.).

The purpose of these labels is to reducethe incidence of vehicle thefts by facilitat-ing the tracing and recovery of parts fromstolen vehicles. The label is designed sothat once it is applied to a surface, anyattempt to remove it will result in destroy-ing the integrity of the label. Transferringthese labels intact from one part to anoth-er, will be impossible.

NOTICE

You should not attempt to remove thetheft prevention labels as it may vio-late certain state or federal laws.

CAUTION

Do not modify the suspension/chassiswith lift kits, spacers, springs, etc. Itcan cause dangerous handling charac-teristics, resulting in loss of control.

Make sure what kind of tires your ve-hicle is originally equipped with.

1. Summer tires

Summer tires are high−speed capabilitytires best suited to highway driving underdry conditions.

Since summer tires do not have the sametraction performance as snow tires, sum-mer tires are inadequate for driving onsnow−covered or icy roads. For driving onsnow−covered or icy roads, we recom-mend using snow tires. If installing snowtires, be sure to replace all four tires.

2. All season tires

All season tires are designed to providebetter traction in snow and to be adequatefor driving in most winter conditions, aswell as for use all year round.

All season tires, however, do not haveadequate traction performance comparedwith snow tires in heavy or loose snow.Also, all season tires fall short in accel-eration and handling performancecompared with summer tires in highwaydriving.

Theft prevention labels(except for Canada) Suspension and chassis Types of tires

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

222 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

� Do not mix summer and all seasontires on your vehicle as this cancause dangerous handling charac-teristics, resulting in loss of con-trol.

� Do not use tires other than themanufacturer’s designated tires, andnever mix tires or wheels of thesizes different from the originals.

Check one: ■■ Same owner, name and/or address has changed ■■ New owner, purchased vehicle used

■■ Same owner, additional driver who should receive product/safety updates

■■ Mr. ■■ Mrs. ■■ Ms. ■■ Miss ■■ Dr.

Owner Information Change Form

EVV

First name M.I. Last name

Company name

Street address or P.O. Box Apt. or suite number

City State Zip code

Home phone number Work phone number Extension

Vehicle Identification Number (required to process change) Mo. Day Year

– – – –

– –

/ /

Check here if address belowis for company

■■

This information is obtained solely for the use of Toyota Motor Sales, U.S.A., Inc.Toyota occasionally sends special promotional offers to registered owners. Check here if you prefer not to receive these offers. ■■

/

Effective date ofthis information

Social Security Number(optional; for Toyota customer reference only) 20

0300452-02003-REV1 Printed in U.S.A. 11/02w

ww

.toy

ota.

com Owner’s

Warranty

Information

If your name

or address has

changed or you

purchased your

Toyota as a used

vehicle, please

complete and

mail the attached

card, even if your

warranty coverage

has expired. This

will enable Toyota

to contact you

with important

product or safety

updates concern-

ing your vehicle.

If the card is no

longer attached,

please call the

Toyota Customer

Assistance Center at

(800) 331-4331.

1

Table of Contents

Introduction

Satisfaction Down the Road 2

Transportation Assistance 3

If You Need Assistance 4

Warranty Coverages at a Glance 6

Your Warranties in Detail

General Warranty Provisions 7

New Vehicle Limited Warranty 9

Federal Emission Control Warranty 14

California Emission Control Warranty 20

Tire Limited Warranty 26

Your Responsibilities

Operation and Maintenance 27

Obtaining Warranty Service 29

t Toyota, our top priority is always our customers. We knowyour Toyota is an important part of your life and something youdepend on every day. That’s why we’re dedicated to building

products of the highest quality and reliability.

Our excellent warranty coverage is evidence that we stand behind thequality of our vehicles. We’re confident — as you should be — that yourToyota will provide you with many years of enjoyable driving.

To further demonstrate our commitment to our customers’ satisfaction,occasionally we may establish a special policy adjustment to pay for spe-cific repairs that are no longer covered by warranty. When we establishsuch a policy adjustment, we mail details to all applicable owners wehave on record. That’s why it’s important to send in the card at the backof this booklet if you change your address or if you’ve purchased thisvehicle from a previous owner.

To provide you with added protection against unexpected service costs,we offer Toyota Extra Care vehicle service agreements and Toyota AutoCare pre-paid maintenance programs. Both offer plans to meet a wide

variety of needs. Your dealership can help you select the plan that’s bestfor you.

Our goal is for every Toyota customer to enjoy outstanding quality,dependability and peace of mind throughout their ownership experi-ence. We want you to be a satisfied member of the Toyota family formany miles to come.

This booklet describes the terms of Toyota warranty coverage as well as general owner responsibilities. A separate publication found in your glove box, the Scheduled Maintenance Guide,describes your vehicle’s maintenance requirements. Be sure toreview this publication carefully, since proper maintenance isrequired to ensure that warranty coverage remains intact.

All information in this booklet is the latest available at the time of pub-lication and, with the exception of the emission control warranties, issubject to change without notice.

A

Introduction2

Satisfaction Down the Road

e realize that your confidence in the quality and reliability of our products was a key factor in your decision to buy aToyota. We also know how disruptive the loss of transportation

can be to your daily routine. That’s why we’re pleased to offer you thebenefits of our Transportation Assistance Policy.

Under this policy, you are eligible for transportation assistance if yourToyota must be kept overnight for warranty-covered repairs. The policyapplies when your vehicle must be kept overnight for any of the follow-ing reasons:

• The warranty repairs will take longer than one day to complete.

• The warrantable condition requires extensive diagnosis.

• The parts needed for the warranty repairs are not readily availableand your vehicle is inoperative or unsafe to drive.

The policy does not apply when warranty repairs can be completed in one day but the vehicle must be kept overnight due to dealer orowner scheduling conflicts.

The Transportation Assistance Policy applies for the duration of the NewVehicle Limited Warranty. The policy applies to all 2003 model-yearToyotas sold and serviced by authorized Toyota dealerships in the mainland United States and Alaska.

For further details, please consult your Toyota dealer.

W

Introduction 3

Transportation Assistance

Both Toyota and your Toyota dealer are dedicated to serving yourautomotive needs. Your complete satisfaction is our first priority. Shouldyou have a problem or concern — either during or after the warrantyperiod — please take the following steps to ensure the quickest possibleresponse:

Step 1Discuss the situation with a dealership manager, such as the servicemanager or customer relations manager. In most cases, a satisfactorysolution can be reached at this step.

Step 2If the dealership does not address your concern to your satisfaction, call the Toyota Customer Assistance Center at (800)331–4331. If you are hearing- or speech-impaired, call (800)443-4999 (TDD).

Please have the following information ready when you call:

• Your Toyota’s vehicle identification number (located on the driver’s side corner of the dashboard, under the window)

• Current mileage on your vehicle

• Name of your Toyota dealership

A Toyota customer relations representative will assist you in working with the dealership to find a satisfactory solution.

Step 3If your concern has still not been resolved to your satisfaction, Toyotaoffers additional assistance through the Dispute Settlement Program, a dispute resolution program administered by the National Center forDispute Settlement. The purpose of the Dispute Settlement Program is to resolve disputes through arbitration — a process by which two parties authorize an independent third party to hear and resolve a dis-pute. The program is informal and free of charge. To request that your

If You Need Assistance

Introduction4

case be reviewed through the program, complete the customer claimform in the Owner's Warranty Rights Notification booklet (found in yourglove box) and mail it to:

National Center for Dispute SettlementP.O. Box 561109Dallas, TX 75356-1109

If you would like to request a customer claim form, call the ToyotaCustomer Assistance Center at (800)331-4331. When you call, pleasehave your vehicle identification number, the current mileage on yourToyota and the names of your selling and servicing dealerships.

Important: You must use the Dispute Settlement Program before seekingremedies through a court action pursuant to the Magnuson-MossWarranty Act. You may also be required to use the Dispute SettlementProgram before seeking remedies under the “Lemon Laws” of your state.Please check the appropriate page of the Owner’s Warranty RightsNotification booklet for the requirements applicable to your state.

This information about the Dispute Settlement Program is correctas of the date of printing. However, the program may be changedwithout notice. For the most current information about the DisputeSettlement Program, call the Toyota Customer Assistance Center at(800)331-4331.

Introduction 5

If You Need Assistance

10 months

months

20 30 40 50 60 70 80

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80

36 months / 36,000 miles

60 months / 60,000 miles

60 months / 60,000 miles

60 months / Unlimited miles

Basic

Powertrain

Restraint Systems

Corrosion Perforation

New Vehicle Limited Warranty

Emission Control Warranty

24 months / 24,000 miles

1 Specific components may have longer coverage under terms of the Powertrain Warranty.

36 months / 36,000 miles1

96 months / 80,000 miles

96 months / 80,000 miles

36 months / 50,000 miles

36 months / 50,000 miles1

84 months / 70,000 miles

PerformanceSpecific Components

DefectSpecific Components

Performance

Short-Term Defect

Long-Term Defect

Fede

ral

Calif

orni

a2,3

2 Also applies to Massachusetts and Vermont vehicles equipped with a California Certified Emission Control System. Vehicles covered by this warranty are also covered by the Federal Emission Control Warranty.

3 For 4-cylinder Camry models certified as partial zero-emission vehicles (PZEV), if any, coverage is 15 years or 150,000 miles, whichever occurs first.

Introduction6

Warranty Coverages at a Glance

Who Is the WarrantorThe warrantor for these limited warranties is Toyota Motor Sales, U.S.A.,Inc. (“Toyota”), 19001 South Western Avenue, Torrance, California90509-2991, a California corporation.

Which Vehicles Are CoveredThese warranties apply to all 2003 model-year vehicles registered andnormally operated in the United States, U.S. territories and Canada.Warranty coverage is automatically transferred at no cost to subsequentvehicle owners.

Multiple Warranty ConditionsThis booklet contains warranty terms and conditions that may varydepending on the part covered. A warranty for specific parts or systems,such as the Powertrain Warranty or Emission Performance Warranty, isgoverned by the coverage set forth in that warranty as well as theGeneral Warranty Provisions.

When Warranty BeginsThe warranty period begins on the vehicle’s in-service date, which is thefirst date the vehicle is either delivered to an ultimate purchaser, leased,or used as a company car or demonstrator.

Repairs Made at No ChargeRepairs and adjustments covered by these warranties are made at nocharge for parts and labor.

Parts ReplacementAny needed parts replacement will be made using new or remanufac-tured parts. The decision whether a part should be repaired or replacedwill be made by the servicing Toyota dealership and/or Toyota. Partsscheduled to be replaced as required maintenance are warranted untiltheir first replacement only.

Your Warranties in Detail 7

General Warranty Provisions

LimitationsThe performance of necessary repairs and adjustments is the exclusiveremedy under these warranties or any implied warranties. Toyota doesnot authorize any person to create for it any other obligation or liabilityin connection with this vehicle.

Any implied warranty of merchantability or fitness for a particularpurpose is limited to the duration of these written warranties.Some states do not allow restrictions on how long an implied warrantylasts, so this limitation may not apply to you.

Your Rights Under State LawThese warranties give you specific legal rights. You may also have otherrights that vary from state to state.

Your Warranties in Detail8

General Warranty Provisions

Basic WarrantyThis warranty covers repairs and adjustments needed to correct defects inmaterials or workmanship of any part supplied by Toyota, subject to theexceptions indicated under “What Is Not Covered” on pages 11–12.

Coverage is for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, withthe exception of wheel alignment and wheel balancing, which are cov-ered for 12 months or 20,000 miles, whichever occurs first.

Powertrain WarrantyThis warranty covers repairs needed to correct defects in materials orworkmanship of any component listed in the next column and suppliedby Toyota, subject to the exceptions indicated under “What Is NotCovered” on pages 11–12.

Coverage is for 60 months or 60,000 miles, whichever occurs first.

EngineCylinder block and head and all internal parts, intake manifold, timinggears and gaskets, timing chain/belt and cover, flywheel, valve covers, oil pan, oil pump, engine mounts, turbocharger housing and all internalparts, supercharger housing and all internal parts, engine control com-puter, water pump, fuel pump, seals and gaskets.

Transmission and TransaxleCase and all internal parts, torque converter, clutch cover, transmissionmounts, transfer case and all internal parts, engine control computer,seals and gaskets.

Front-Wheel-Drive SystemFinal drive housing and all internal parts, axle shafts, drive shafts, constant velocity joints, front hub and bearings, seals and gaskets.

Rear-Wheel-Drive SystemAxle housing and all internal parts, propeller shafts, U-joints, axleshafts, drive shafts, bearings, supports, seals and gaskets.

WHAT IS COVERED AND HOW LONG

Your Warranties in Detail 9

New Vehicle Limited Warranty

Corrosion Perforation WarrantyThis warranty covers repair or replacement of any original body panelthat develops perforation from corrosion (rust-through), subject to theexceptions indicated under “What Is Not Covered” on pages 11–12.

Coverage is for 60 months, regardless of mileage.

For information on how to protect your vehicle from corrosion, see thesection entitled “Corrosion Prevention and Appearance Care” in theOwner’s Manual.

Restraint Systems WarrantyThis warranty covers repairs needed to correct defects in materials orworkmanship of any seatbelt or air bag system supplied by Toyota, subject to the exceptions indicated under “What Is Not Covered” onpages 11–12.

Coverage is for 60 months or 60,000 miles, whichever occurs first.

For vehicles sold and registered in the state of Kansas, the warranty forseatbelts and related components is 10 years, regardless of mileage.

TowingWhen your vehicle is inoperable due to failure of a warranted part, towing service to the nearest authorized Toyota dealership is covered.

Your Warranties in Detail10

New Vehicle Limited Warranty

This warranty does not cover damage or failures resulting directly orindirectly from any of the following:

• Fire, accidents or theft

• Abuse or negligence

• Misuse — for example, racing or overloading

• Improper repairs

• Alteration or tampering, including installation of non-Genuine Toyota Accessories

• Lack of or improper maintenance, including use of fluids otherthan those specified in the Owner’s Manual

• Installation of non-Genuine Toyota Parts

• Airborne chemicals, tree sap, road debris (including stone chips), rail dust, salt, hail, floods, wind storms, lightning and otherenvironmental conditions

• Water contamination

This warranty also does not cover the following:

Tires

Tires are covered by a separate warranty provided by the tire manufac-turer. See page 26.

Normal Wear and TearNoise, vibration, cosmetic conditions and other deterioration caused bynormal wear and tear.

Maintenance ExpenseNormal maintenance services such as:

• Engine tune-ups

• Replacement of fluids and filters

• Lubrication

• Cleaning and polishing

• Replacement of spark plugs and fuses

• Replacement of worn wiper blades, brake pads/linings and clutch linings

WHAT IS NOT COVERED

Your Warranties in Detail 11

New Vehicle Limited Warranty

Maintenance ExpenseNormal maintenance services such as:

• Engine tune-ups

• Replacement of fluids and filters

• Lubrication

• Cleaning and polishing

• Replacement of spark plugs and fuses

• Replacement of worn wiper blades, brake pads/linings and clutch linings

Noise, vibration, cosmetic conditions and other deterioration caused bynormal wear and tear.

Normal Wear and Tear

Tires are covered by a separate warranty provided by the tire manufac-turer. See page 26.

Vehicles With Altered OdometerFailure of a vehicle on which the odometer has been altered so thatactual vehicle mileage cannot be readily determined.

Salvage or Total-Loss VehiclesAny vehicle that has ever been issued a “salvage” title or similar titleunder any state’s law; or has ever been declared a “total loss” or equiva-lent by a financial institution or insurer, such as by payment for a claim inlieu of repairs because the cost of repairs exceeded the cash value of thevehicle. This exclusion does not apply to the emission control warranties.

Incidental DamagesIncidental or consequential damages associated with a vehicle failure.Such damages include but are not limited to inconvenience; the cost oftransportation, telephone calls and lodging; the loss of personal or com-mercial property; and the loss of pay or revenue.

Disclaimer of Extra Expenses and DamagesThe performance of necessary repairs and adjustments is the exclu-sive remedy under this warranty or any implied warranty. Toyotadoes not authorize any person to create for it any other obligationor liability in connection with this vehicle. Toyota shall not be liablefor incidental or consequential damages resulting from breach ofthis written warranty or any implied warranty. Any implied war-ranty of merchantability or fitness for a particular purpose is limitedto the duration of this written warranty, except in states where thislimitation is not allowed.

Your Warranties in Detail12

New Vehicle Limited Warranty

If a dispute arises regarding your warranty coverage, please follow thesteps described under “If You Need Assistance” on pages 4–5. Pleasenote that you must use the Dispute Settlement Program before seekingremedies through a court action pursuant to the Magnuson-MossWarranty Act. You may also be required to use the Dispute SettlementProgram before seeking remedies under the “Lemon Laws” of your state.Please check the appropriate page of the Owner’s Warranty RightsNotification booklet (located in your glove box) for the requirementsapplicable to your state.

Your Warranties in Detail 13

New Vehicle Limited Warranty

DISPUTE RESOLUTION

Emission Defect WarrantyToyota warrants that your vehicle:

• Was designed, built and equipped to conform at the time of sale withapplicable federal emissions standards.

• Is free from defects in materials and workmanship that may cause thevehicle to fail to meet these standards.

Federal regulations require that this warranty be in effect for two years or 24,000 miles from the vehicle’s in-service date, whichever occursfirst. However, under the terms of the Basic Warranty, Toyota providescoverage of three years or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first. Speci-fic components may have longer coverage under the terms of thePowertrain Warranty. Additionally, components marked “8/80” in theparts list on pages 15–16 have coverage of eight years or 80,000 miles,whichever occurs first.

Emission Performance WarrantySome states and localities have established vehicle inspection and main-tenance (I/M) programs to encourage proper vehicle maintenance. If anEPA-approved I/M program is in force in your area, you are eligible forEmission Performance Warranty coverage.

Under the terms of the Emission Performance Warranty and federal regulations, Toyota will make all necessary repairs if both of the following occur:

• Your vehicle fails to meet applicable emissions standards as determined by an EPA-approved emissions test.

• This failure results or will result in some penalty to you — such as a fine or denial of the right to use your vehicle — under local, state or federal law.

This warranty is in effect for two years or 24,000 miles from the vehicle’sin-service date, whichever occurs first. Additionally, components marked“8/80” in the parts list on pages 15–16 have coverage of eight years or80,000 miles, whichever occurs first.

WHAT IS COVERED AND HOW LONG

Your Warranties in Detail14

Federal Emission Control Warranty

These warranty obligations do not apply to failures or non-compliancecaused by:

• The use of replacement parts not certified in accordance with aftermarket parts certification regulations.

• The use of replacement parts not equivalent in quality or design to original equipment parts.

Provisions under the “What Is Not Covered” section of the New VehicleLimited Warranty also apply to this warranty.

Air/Fuel Metering System• Air/fuel ratio feedback control system

• Cold-start enrichment system

• Deceleration control system

• Electronic fuel injection system components— Airflow sensor— Engine control module (8/80)— Throttle body— Other components

Air Induction System• Intake manifold and intake air surge tank

Catalyst System• Catalytic converter and protector (8/80)

• Constricted fuel filler neck

• Exhaust manifold

• Exhaust pipe (manifold to catalyst and/or catalyst to catalyst)

WHAT IS NOT COVERED WARRANTY PARTS LIST

8/80 = Covered for eight years or 80,000 miles, whichever occurs first.

Your Warranties in Detail 15

Federal Emission Control Warranty

*

Evaporative Control System• Charcoal canister

• Diaphragm valve

• Fuel filler cap

• Fuel tank

• Vapor liquid separator

Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) System• EGR gas temperature sensor

• EGR valve

• Associated parts

Ignition System• Distributor and internal parts

• Ignition coil and ignitor

• Ignition wires

• Spark plugs*

Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) System• Oil filler cap

• PCV valve or orifice

Other Parts Used in Above Systems• Data link connector (8/80)

• Hoses, clamps, fittings, tubing and mounting hardware

• Malfunction indicator light and bulb (8/80)

• Pulleys, belts and idlers

• Sealing gaskets and devices

• Sensors, switches and valves

Warranted until first required maintenance under terms of theCalifornia Emission Control Warranty.

8/80 = Covered for eight years or 80,000 miles, whichever occurs first.

Your Warranties in Detail16

Federal Emission Control Warranty

You are responsible for performance of the required maintenance indi-cated in the Owner’s Manual and the Scheduled Maintenance Guide.Toyota will not deny a warranty claim solely because you do not haverecords to show that you maintained your vehicle. However, any failureor noncompliance caused by lack of maintenance is not covered by thiswarranty.

When maintenance and repairs are paid for by you, these servicesmay be performed by you or by any automotive service provider youchoose. Toyota will not deny a warranty claim simply because youused a service provider other than a Toyota dealership for mainte-nance and repairs. However, any failure or non-compliance caused byimproper maintenance or repairs is not covered by this warranty.

To ensure optimum performance and maintain the quality built intoyour vehicle’s emission control systems, Toyota recommends the use ofGenuine Toyota Parts when servicing or repairing the systems.

Warranty coverage is not dependent upon the use of any particularbrand of replacement parts and you may elect to use non–GenuineToyota Parts for maintenance and repairs. However, use of replace-ment parts that are not equivalent in quality to Genuine ToyotaParts may impair the effectiveness of the emission control systems.

If you use replacement parts that have maintenance or replacementschedules different from those of Genuine Toyota Parts, you must followthe maintenance and replacement schedules for the parts you are using.In addition, you should ensure that such parts are warranted by theirmanufacturers to be equivalent to Genuine Toyota Parts.

MAINTENANCE REPLACEMENT PARTS

Your Warranties in Detail 17

Federal Emission Control Warranty

If your vehicle fails an EPA-approved emissions test, you may make aclaim under the Emission Performance Warranty. To do so, take yourvehicle to an authorized Toyota dealership and present a copy of theemissions test report. Also, take your maintenance records in case theyare needed.

If your claim qualifies for coverage, the dealership will repair your vehi-cle within 30 days (unless a shorter period is required by law). If yourclaim is denied, Toyota will notify you in writing of the reason within the same period. If we fail to do so, we will repair your vehicle free ofcharge. The only exceptions allowed are when you request or agree to adelay, or a delay is caused by factors beyond the control of Toyota or thedealership.

For information on how to obtain service under the Emission DefectWarranty, see page 29, “Obtaining Warranty Service.”

If you have questions or concerns about your vehicle’s federal emissionwarranty coverage, please follow the steps described under “If You NeedAssistance” on pages 4–5. In the case of the Emission PerformanceWarranty, you may also request information from or report complaints to:

U.S. Environmental Protection AgencyVehicle Programs & Compliance Division (6405J)Attn: Warranty Complaints401 M Street SWWashington, D.C. 20460

Vehicles equipped with a California Certified Emission Control Systemthat are registered and operated in California or any state thatadopts California emission warranty provisions are also covered bythe California Emission Control Warranty (see page 20). Currently,Massachusetts and Vermont are the only other states to which theCalifornia Emission Control Warranty applies.

IF YOUR VEHICLE FAILS AN EMISSIONS TEST IF YOU HAVE QUESTIONS

Your Warranties in Detail18

Federal Emission Control Warranty

We (the dealership) want you to know that at the time your new Toyotavehicle is being delivered:

1) On the basis of written notification furnished by Toyota, we haveknowledge that the vehicle is covered by an EPA Certificate ofConformity.

2) We have visually inspected those emission control devices or portionsthereof that are visible without removing or adjusting any compo-nents or systems, emissions-related or otherwise. On the basis of thisinspection, there are no apparent deficiencies in the installation ofemission control devices by Toyota. (For purposes of this certificate,“emission control devices” is limited to devices installed on a vehiclefor the sole or primary purpose of controlling emissions and whichwere not in general use before 1968.)

3) We have performed all emission control system preparations requiredby Toyota prior to the sale of the vehicle as set forth in Toyota’s cur-rent pre-delivery service manual.

4) Except as may be provided in Paragraph 5, if this vehicle fails an EPA-approved emissions test within three months or 4,000 miles(whichever comes first) of delivery to the ultimate purchaser, and thevehicle has been maintained and used in accordance with the writ-ten instructions for proper maintenance and use, Toyota will remedy

the non-conformity free of charge under the terms of the EmissionPerformance Warranty.

5) If vehicle was used as a company car or demonstrator, check box andcomplete the following:

□ The vehicle with which this statement is delivered was placed into service as a company car or demonstrator prior to delivery.The Emission Performance Warranty period commenced on thedate the vehicle was first placed into service, which was:

Month Day Year

Note: The dealership makes no representation or warranty that theemission control system or any part thereof is without defect or thatthe system will perform properly. The Emission Performance Warrantyreferred to in Paragraph 4 and furnished with the vehicle is solely thatof the manufacturer.

This statement is required by section 207 of the Clean Air Act (42 U.S.C.7541) and the EPA regulations issued thereunder.

Dealership Name

DEALER CERTIFICATE

Your Warranties in Detail 19

Federal Emission Control Warranty

The California Air Resources Board (CARB) and Toyota are pleased toexplain the emission control system warranty for your 2003 vehicle. InCalifornia, new motor vehicles must be designed, built and equipped tomeet the state’s stringent anti-smog standards. CARB regulations requirethat Toyota must warrant the emission control system on your vehicle forthe time periods indicated on this page, provided there has been noabuse, neglect or improper maintenance of your vehicle.

Your emission control system may include parts such as the fuel injectionsystem, ignition system, catalytic converter and engine computer. Alsoincluded may be hoses, belts, connectors and other emissions-relatedassemblies.

Where a warrantable condition exists, Toyota will repair your vehicle atno cost to you, including diagnosis, parts and labor.

1) For three years or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first:*

• If your vehicle fails a smog-check test, all necessary repairs andadjustments will be made by Toyota to ensure that your vehiclepasses the test. This is your Emission Control System PERFORMANCEWARRANTY.

• If any emissions-related part on your vehicle is defective, the partwill be repaired or replaced by Toyota. This is your SHORT-TERMEmission Control System DEFECT WARRANTY. Covered parts are listedon pages 15–16. Specific components may have longer coverageunder the terms of the Powertrain Warranty.

2) For seven years or 70,000 miles, whichever occurs first:*

• If an emissions-related part listed on pages 22—23 is defective, the part will be repaired or replaced by Toyota. This is yourLONG-TERM Emission Control System DEFECT WARRANTY.

YOUR WARRANTY RIGHTS AND OBLIGATIONS

MANUFACTURER’S WARRANTY COVERAGE

Your Warranties in Detail20

California Emission Control Warranty

* For 4-cylinder Camry models certified as partial zero-emission vehicles (PZEV),if any, coverage is 15 years or 150,000 miles, whichever occurs first.

You are responsible for performance of the required maintenance indi-cated in the Owner’s Manual and the Scheduled Maintenance Guide.Toyota recommends that you retain all receipts covering maintenance onyour vehicle, but Toyota cannot deny warranty coverage solely for thelack of receipts or your failure to ensure the performance of all scheduledmaintenance.

You are responsible for presenting your vehicle to a Toyota dealership assoon as a problem exists. The warranty repairs should be completed in areasonable amount of time, not to exceed 30 days.

You should also be aware that Toyota may deny you warranty coverage ifyour vehicle or a part has failed due to abuse, neglect, improper main-tenance or unapproved modifications.

If you have any questions regarding your warranty rights and responsi-bilities, you should contact the Toyota Customer Assistance Center at(800)331-4331 or the California Air Resources Board, Mobile SourceControl Division, at 9528 Telstar Avenue, P.O. Box 8001, El Monte, CA91734-8001.

These warranty obligations do not apply to failures or noncompliancecaused by:

• The use of replacement parts not certified in accordance with aftermarket parts certification regulations.

• The use of replacement parts not equivalent in quality or design tooriginal equipment parts.

Provisions under the “What Is Not Covered” section of the New VehicleLimited Warranty also apply to this warranty.

OWNER’S WARRANTY RESPONSIBILITIES WHAT IS NOT COVERED

Your Warranties in Detail 21

California Emission Control Warranty

The parts listed here are covered for seven years or 70,000 miles fromthe vehicle’s in-service date, whichever occurs first.

Air/Fuel Metering System• Air-fuel ratio sensor on Highlander

• Engine control computer (engine control module)

• Fuel pump on Sienna

• Mass air flow sensor on Tacoma equipped with 2RZ-FE and 3RZ-FE

• Throttle body

Air Induction System• Intake manifold and intake air surge tank

• Intake manifold gasket on MR2 Spyder

Catalyst System• Catalytic converter (warm-up three-way catalyst)

• Exhaust center pipe on Avalon, Corolla Matrix 4WD, Highlanderequipped with 1MZ-FE, Tacoma and Tundra equipped with 5VZ-FE

• Exhaust front pipe on Avalon, Camry, Camry Solara, Celica, Corolla,Corolla Matrix 2WD, ECHO, Highlander equipped with 1MZ-FE, LandCruiser, MR2 Spyder, Sequoia, Sienna, Tacoma, Tundra and 4Runner

• Exhaust manifold on Avalon, Camry, Camry Solara, Highlander, LandCruiser, MR2 Spyder, RAV4, Sequoia, Sienna, Tundra equipped with2UZ-FE and 4Runner

• Exhaust manifold gasket on Land Cruiser, Sequoia, Tundra equippedwith 2UZ-FE and 4Runner

• Right exhaust manifold gasket on Sienna and on Avalon, Camry,Camry Solara and Highlander models equipped with 1MZ-FE

Your Warranties in Detail22

California Emission Control Warranty

PARTS LIST: LONG-TERM EMISSION DEFECT WARRANTY

Evaporative Control System• Charcoal canister on Highlander, Land Cruiser and 4Runner

• Fuel tank

Ignition System• Knock sensor on Land Cruiser, MR2 Spyder, Sequoia, Tacoma

equipped with 5VZ-FE, Tundra and 4Runner

You are responsible for performance of the required maintenance indi-cated in the Owner’s Manual and the Scheduled Maintenance Guide.Toyota will not deny a warranty claim solely because you do not haverecords to show that you maintained your vehicle. However, any failureor noncompliance caused by lack of maintenance is not covered by thiswarranty.

When maintenance and repairs are paid for by you, these servicesmay be performed by you or by any automotive service provider youchoose. Toyota will not deny a warranty claim simply because youused a service provider other than a Toyota dealership for mainte-nance and repairs. However, any failure or non-compliance caused byimproper maintenance or repairs is not covered by this warranty.

MAINTENANCE

Your Warranties in Detail 23

California Emission Control Warranty

To ensure optimum performance and maintain the quality built intoyour vehicle’s emission control systems, Toyota recommends the use ofGenuine Toyota Parts when servicing or repairing the systems.

Warranty coverage is not dependent upon the use of any particularbrand of replacement parts and you may elect to use non-GenuineToyota Parts for maintenance and repairs. However, use of replace–ment parts that are not equivalent in quality to Genuine ToyotaParts may impair the effectiveness of the emission control systems.

If you use replacement parts that have maintenance or replacementschedules different from those of Genuine Toyota Parts, you must followthe maintenance and replacement schedules for the parts you are using.In addition, you should ensure that such parts are warranted by theirmanufacturers to be equivalent to Genuine Toyota Parts.

If your vehicle fails a smog-check test, you may make a claim under theEmission Performance Warranty. To do so, take your vehicle to an autho-rized Toyota dealership and present a copy of the smog-check testreport. Also, take your maintenance records in case they are needed.

If your claim qualifies for coverage, the dealership will repair your vehi-cle within 30 days (unless a shorter period is required by law). If yourclaim is denied, Toyota will notify you in writing of the reason within the same period. If we fail to do so, we will repair your vehicle free ofcharge. The only exceptions allowed are when you request or agree to a delay, or a delay is caused by factors beyond the control of Toyota orthe dealership.

For information on how to obtain service under the Emission DefectWarranty, see page 29, “Obtaining Warranty Service.”

REPLACEMENT PARTS IF YOUR VEHICLE FAILS A SMOG-CHECK TEST

Your Warranties in Detail24

California Emission Control Warranty

If a Toyota dealership is unable to complete repairs on your vehicle within 30 days, you may have the repairs made under Toyota’s provisions for emergency warranty repairs. See page 29 for details.

If you have questions or concerns about your vehicle’s California emis-sion warranty coverage, please follow the steps described under “If YouNeed Assistance” on pages 4–5. You may also request information fromor report complaints to:

California Air Resources BoardMobile Source Control Division9528 Telstar AvenueP.O. Box 8001El Monte, CA 91734-8001(800)242-4450

Vehicles equipped with a California Certified Emission Control Systemthat are registered and operated in California or any state thatadopts California emission warranty provisions are covered by thiswarranty. Currently, Massachusetts and Vermont are the only otherstates to which this warranty applies. Vehicles covered by this warranty are also covered by the Federal Emission Control Warranty(see page 14).

REPAIR DELAYS IF YOU HAVE QUESTIONS

Your Warranties in Detail 25

California Emission Control Warranty

OBTAINING WARRANTY SERVICE ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT TIRE MANUFACTURERS

The tires that come as original equipment on your vehicle are warrantedby their manufacturer and not Toyota. A separate warranty statement forthe tires is in your glove box.

To obtain service for a tire defect, take the tire to an authorized dealerof the tire manufacturer. (Refer to your local phone directory for dealerlocations.) Your Toyota dealer may also be able to assist you in obtainingwarranty service from the manufacturer.

For additional warranty information or service assistance, contact the tire manufacturer directly.

Your Warranties in Detail26

Tire Limited Warranty

Bridgestone/FirestoneOne Bridgestone ParkNashville, TN 37214(800)847-3272

Continental General Tire1800 Continental Blvd.Charlotte, NC 28273(800)847-3349

Goodyear Dunlop TiresNorth America, Ltd.P.O. Box 1109Buffalo, NY 14240(800)548-4714

Goodyear Tire and Rubber Co.1144 East Market StreetAkron, OH 44316(800)321-2136

Michelin/BFGoodrichP.O. Box 19001Greenville, SC 29602(800)847-3435

Toyo Tire (U.S.A.) Corporation6261 Katella Ave., Ste. 2BCypress, CA 90630(800)442-8696

Yokohama Tire Corporation601 South Acacia AvenueFullerton, CA 92831(800)722-9888

You are responsible for ensuring that your Toyota is operated and main-tained according to the instructions in the Owner’s Manual and theScheduled Maintenance Guide.

You should keep detailed records of vehicle maintenance, since undersome circumstances they may be required for warranty coverage. Theserecords should include date of service, mileage at time of service and adescription of service performed and/or parts installed. For your conve-nience, a maintenance log is included in the Scheduled MaintenanceGuide. If you sell your vehicle, you should give your maintenance recordsto the new owner.

Toyota will not deny a warranty claim solely because you do not haverecords to show that you maintained your vehicle. However, damage orfailures caused by lack of proper maintenance are not covered underwarranty.

You may have maintenance performed on your vehicle by any qualifiedperson or facility. However, Toyota recommends having maintenanceperformed by an authorized Toyota dealership.

Toyota dealership technicians are specially trained to maintain and repairToyota vehicles. They stay current on the latest service informationthrough Toyota technical bulletins, service publications and trainingcourses. Many are also certified through the Toyota CertificationProgram, which involves a series of rigorous written examinations. Feelfree to ask any Toyota dealership to show you its technicians’ credentials.

You can be confident you’re getting the best possible service for yourvehicle when you take it to a Toyota dealership. Plus, a Toyota dealer-ship will always use Genuine Toyota Parts designed specifically for yourvehicle.

GENERAL INFORMATION WHERE TO GO FOR MAINTENANCE

Your Responsibilities 27

Operation and Maintenance

Warranty coverage is not dependent upon the use of any particularbrand of replacement parts. However, Toyota recommends using onlyGenuine Toyota Parts when you need to replace a part on your vehicle.Like all Toyota products, Genuine Toyota Parts are built to the higheststandards of quality, durability and performance. They are also designedto fit your vehicle’s exact specifications.

Your Toyota dealership maintains an extensive inventory of GenuineToyota Parts to meet your vehicle service needs. And because it is linkedelectronically to Toyota’s Parts Distribution Centers, the dealership hasquick access to any parts it may not have in stock.

Genuine Toyota Parts are covered by their own warranty (see your dealerfor details) or the remainder of any applicable New Vehicle LimitedWarranty, whichever is longer. Non–Genuine Toyota Parts, or anydamage or failures resulting from their use, are not covered by any Toyota warranty.

REPLACEMENT PARTS

Your Responsibilities28

Operation and Maintenance

In the United States, U.S. Territories and CanadaTo obtain warranty service in the United States, U.S. territories or Canada,take your vehicle to an authorized Toyota dealership. If your vehicle cannot be driven, contact your nearest Toyota dealership for towingassistance. You do not have to pay for towing to the nearest Toyota deal-ership if your vehicle is inoperable due to failure of a warranted part.

Outside the United States, U.S. Territories and CanadaIf you are using your vehicle outside the United States, U.S. territoriesand Canada and need warranty service, contact a local Toyota dealer-ship. Please note, however, that your vehicle may not be repaired free of charge because the local Toyota distributor may have no obligation toprovide warranty service for your vehicle, and/or your vehicle may notcomply with local regulatory or environmental requirements.

If your vehicle is inoperable or unsafe to drive and there is no Toyotadealership reasonably available to make repairs, you may perform therepairs yourself or have them performed by another automotive serviceprovider. Toyota will reimburse you for any of the repairs that are cov-ered by warranty. To receive reimbursement, present to an authorizedToyota dealership your paid repair invoices and any parts that wereremoved from the vehicle. You will be reimbursed for warranted parts at the manufacturer’s suggested retail price and warranted labor at ageographically appropriate hourly rate multiplied by Toyota’s recom-mended time allowance for the repair.

If your vehicle requires emergency repair, Toyota assumes no liability for subsequent failures caused by improper repairs or the use of non-Genuine Toyota Parts unless you have the vehicle properly repaired in atimely manner. To ensure that warranty coverage remains intact, haveyour vehicle inspected by an authorized Toyota dealership as soon aspossible after an emergency repair.

Obtaining Warranty Service

Your Responsibilities 29

BY GEOGRAPHIC REGION EMERGENCY REPAIRS

Notes

30

Notes

31

Notes

32

Check one: ■■ Same owner, name and/or address has changed ■■ New owner, purchased vehicle used

■■ Same owner, additional driver who should receive product/safety updates

■■ Mr. ■■ Mrs. ■■ Ms. ■■ Miss ■■ Dr.

Owner Information Change Form

EVV

First name M.I. Last name

Company name

Street address or P.O. Box Apt. or suite number

City State Zip code

Home phone number Work phone number Extension

Vehicle Identification Number (required to process change) Mo. Day Year

– – – –

– –

/ /

Check here if address belowis for company

■■

This information is obtained solely for the use of Toyota Motor Sales, U.S.A., Inc.Toyota occasionally sends special promotional offers to registered owners. Check here if you prefer not to receive these offers. ■■

/

Effective date ofthis information

Social Security Number(optional; for Toyota customer reference only)

If your name

or address has

changed or you

purchased your

Toyota as a used

vehicle, please

complete and

mail the attached

card, even if your

warranty coverage

has expired. This

will enable Toyota

to contact you

with important

product or safety

updates concern-

ing your vehicle.

If the card is no

longer attached,

please call the

Toyota Customer

Assistance Center at

(800) 331-4331.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2232003 AVALON (OM41401U)

STARTING AND DRIVINGBefore starting the engine 224. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . How to start the engine 224. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tips for driving in various conditions 225. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Winter driving tips 226. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dinghy towing 227. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Trailer towing 227. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . How to save fuel and make your vehicle last longer 233. . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 3

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

224 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Check the area around the vehicle be-fore entering it.

2. Adjust seat position, seatback angle,seat cushion angle, head restraintheight and steering wheel angle.

3. Adjust the inside and outside rear viewmirrors.

4. Lock all the doors.

5. Fasten seat belts.

1. Apply the parking brake firmly.

2. Turn off unnecessary lights and acces-sories.

3. Put the selector lever in “P”. If youneed to restart the engine while thevehicle is moving, put the selector le-ver in “N”. A starter safety device willprevent the starter from operating if theselector lever is in any drive position.

4. Depress the brake pedal and hold it tothe floor until driving off.

Before starting the engine, be sure to fol-low the instructions in “(a) Before crank-ing”.

Normal starting procedure

The multiport fuel injection system/sequen-tial multiport fuel injection system in yourengine automatically controls the properair−fuel mixture for starting. You can starta cold or hot engine as follows:

1. With your foot off the accelerator ped-al, crank the engine by turning the keyto “START”. Release it when the en-gine starts.

2. After the engine runs for about 10 se-conds, you are ready to drive.

If the weather is below freezing, let theengine warm up for a few minutes beforedriving.

If the engine stalls...

Simply restart it, using the correct proce-dure given in normal starting.

If the engine will not start...

See “If your vehicle will not start” in Sec-tion 4.

Before starting the engineHow to start the engine—(a) Before cranking (b) Starting the engine

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2252003 AVALON (OM41401U)

NOTICE

� Do not crank for more than 30 se-conds at a time. This may overheatthe starter and wiring systems.

� Do not race a cold engine.

� If the engine becomes difficult tostart or stalls frequently, have theengine checked immediately.

� Always slow down in gusty crosswinds.This will allow you much better control.

� Drive slowly onto curbs and, if pos-sible, at a right angle. Avoid drivingonto high, sharp−edged objects andother road hazards. Failure to do socan lead to severe tire damage result-ing in tire bursts.

Drive slowly when passing over bumpsor travelling on a bumpy road. Other-wise, the impact could cause severedamage to the tires and/or wheels.

� When parking on a hill, turn the frontwheels until they touch the curb sothat the vehicle will not roll. Apply theparking brake, and place the transmis-sion in “P”. If necessary, block thewheels.

� Washing your vehicle or driving throughdeep water may get the brakes wet. Tosee whether they are wet, check thatthere is no traffic near you, and thenpress the pedal lightly. If you do notfeel a normal braking force, the brakesare probably wet. To dry them, drivethe vehicle cautiously while lightlypressing the brake pedal with the park-ing brake applied. If they still do notwork safely, pull to the side of the roadand call a Toyota dealer for assistance.

CAUTION

� Before driving off, make sure theparking brake is fully released andthe parking brake reminder light isoff.

� Do not leave your vehicle unat-tended while the engine is running.

� Do not rest your foot on the brakepedal while driving. It can causedangerous overheating, needlesswear, and poor fuel economy.

� To drive down a long or steep hill,reduce your speed and downshift.Remember, if you ride the brakesexcessively, they may overheat andnot work properly.

� Be careful when accelerating, up-shifting, downshifting or braking ona slippery surface. Sudden accelera-tion or engine braking, could causethe vehicle to spin or skid.

Tips for driving in variousconditions

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

226 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Do not drive in excess of the speedlimit. Even if the legal speed limitpermits it, do not drive over 140km/h (85 mph) unless your vehiclehas high−speed capability tires.Driving over 140 km/h (85 mph) mayresult in tire failure, loss of controland possible injury. Be sure to con-sult a tire dealer to determinewhether the tires on your vehicleare high−speed capability tires ornot before driving at such speeds.

� Do not continue normal drivingwhen the brakes are wet. If they arewet, your vehicle will require alonger stopping distance, and itmay pull to one side when thebrakes are applied. Also, the park-ing brake will not hold the vehiclesecurely.

Make sure you have a proper freezeprotection of engine coolant.

Your coolant must contain ethylene−glycoltype coolant for a proper corrosionprotection of aluminum components. Use“Toyota Genuine Long Life Coolant” orequivalent.

See Section 7−2 for details about coolanttype selection.

NOTICE

Do not use alcohol type antifreeze orplain water alone.

When it is extremely cold, we recommendto use 60% solution for your Toyota, toprovide protection down to about −50�C(−58�F). Do not use more than 70% solu-tion for better coolant performance.

Check the condition of the battery andcables.

Cold temperatures reduce the capacity ofany battery, so it must be in top shapeto provide enough power for winter start-ing. Section 7−3 tells you how to visuallyinspect the battery. Your Toyota dealerand most service stations will be pleasedto check the level of charge.

Make sure the engine oil viscosity issuitable for the cold weather.

See Section 7−2 for recommended viscos-ity. Leaving a heavy summer oil in yourvehicle during winter months may causeharder starting. If you are not sure aboutwhich oil to use, call your Toyota deal-er—he will be pleased to help.

Keep the door locks from freezing.

Squirt lock de−icer or glycerine into thelocks to keep them from freezing.

Use a washer fluid containing an anti-freeze solution.

This product is available at your Toyotadealer and most auto parts stores. Followthe manufacturer’s directions for howmuch to mix with water.

NOTICE

Do not use engine antifreeze or anyother substitute because it may dam-age your vehicle’s paint.

Winter driving tips

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2272003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Do not use your parking brake whenthere is a possibility it could freeze.

When parking, put the transmission into“P” and block the rear wheels. Do not usethe parking brake, or snow or water accu-mulated in and around the parking brakemechanism may freeze, making it hard torelease.

Keep ice and snow from accumulatingunder the fenders.

Ice and snow built up under your fenderscan make steering difficult. During badwinter driving, stop and check under thefenders occasionally.

Depending on where you are driving,we recommend you carry some emer-gency equipment.

Some of the things you might put in thevehicle are tire chains, window scraper,bag of sand or salt, flares, small shovel,jumper cables, etc.

Your vehicle is not designed to bedinghy towed (with four wheels on theground) behind a motorhome.

NOTICE

Do not tow your vehicle with fourwheels on the ground. This maycause serious damage to your vehicle.

Your vehicle is designed primarily as apassenger−carrying vehicle. Towing atrailer will have an adverse effect onhandling, performance, braking, durabilityand driving economy (fuel consumption,etc.). Your safety and satisfaction dependon the proper use of correct equipmentand cautious driving habits. For yoursafety and the safety of others, you mustnot overload your vehicle or trailer. Toyotawarranties do not apply to damage ormalfunction caused by towing a trailer forcommercial purposes. Ask your localToyota dealer for further details beforetowing.

NOTICE

When towing a trailer, be sure to con-sult your Toyota dealer for further in-formation on additional requirementssuch as a towing kit, etc.

Dinghy towing Trailer towing

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

228 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

WEIGHT LIMITS

Before towing, make sure the total trail-er weight, gross vehicle weight, grossaxle weight and trailer tongue load areall within the limits.

The total trailer weight and tongue loadcan be measured with platform scalesfound at a highway weighing station, build-ing supply company, trucking company,junk yard, etc.

CAUTION

� The total trailer weight (trailerweight plus its cargo load) mustnot exceed 907 kg (2000 lb.). Ex-ceeding this weight is dangerous.

� Trailer hitch assemblies have differ-ent weight capacities established bythe hitch manufacturer. Even thoughthe vehicle may be physically capa-ble of towing a higher weight, theoperator must determine the maxi-mum weight rating of the particularhitch assembly and never exceedthe maximum weight rating speci-fied for the trailer−hitch. Exceedingthe maximum weight rating set bythe trailer hitch manufacturer cancause an accident resulting in seri-ous personal injuries.

� The gross vehicle weight must notexceed the Gross Vehicle WeightRating (GVWR) indicated on theCertification Label. The gross ve-hicle weight is the sum of weightsof the unloaded vehicle, driver, pas-sengers, luggage, hitch and trailertongue load. It also includes theweight of any special equipmentinstalled on your vehicle.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2292003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� The load on either the front or rearaxle resulting from distribution ofthe gross vehicle weight on bothaxles must not exceed the GrossAxle Weight Rating (GAWR) listedon the Certification Label.

Total trailer weight Tongue load

Tongue load� 100 = 9 to 11%

Total trailer weight

� The trailer cargo load should bedistributed so that the tongue loadis 9 to 11% of the total trailerweight, not exceeding the maximumof 90 kg (200 lb.). Never load thetrailer with more weight in the backthan in the front. About 60% of thetrailer load should be in the fronthalf of the trailer and the remaining40% in the rear.

HITCHES

� Use only a hitch which is recom-mended by the hitch manufacturer andconforms to the total trailer weight re-quirement.

� Follow the directions supplied by thehitch manufacturer, and bolt the hitchsecurely to the rear bumper. Lubricatethe hitch ball with a light coat ofgrease.

� Toyota recommends removing the trail-er hitch whenever you are not towinga trailer to reduce the possibility ofadditional damage caused by the hitchif your vehicle is struck from behind.After removing the hitch, seal anymounting holes in the vehicle body toprevent entry of pollutants such as ex-haust fumes, dirt, water, etc.

NOTICE

Do not use axle−mounted hitches asthey can cause damage to the axlehousing, wheel bearings, wheels ortires. Also, never install a hitch whichmay interfere with the normal functionof an Energy Absorbing Bumper.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

230 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

BRAKES AND SAFETY CHAINS

� Toyota recommends trailers with brakesthat conform to any applicable federaland state/provincial regulations.

� A safety chain must always be usedbetween the towing vehicle and thetrailer. Leave sufficient slack in thechain for turns. The chain should crossunder the trailer tongue to prevent thetongue from dropping to the ground incase it becomes damaged or sepa-rated. For correct safety chain proce-dures, follow the hitch or trailermanufacturer’s recommendations.

CAUTION

� If the total trailer weight exceeds453 kg (1000 lb.), trailer brakes arerequired.

� Never tap into your vehicle’s hy-draulic system as it would lower itsbraking effectiveness.

� Never tow a trailer without using asafety chain securely attached toboth the trailer and the vehicle. Ifdamage occurs to the coupling unitor hitch ball, there is danger of thetrailer wandering over into anotherlane.

TIRES

� Ensure that your vehicle’s tires areproperly inflated. See Section 7−2 andSection 8 for instructions.

� The trailer tires should be inflated tothe pressure recommended by the trail-er manufacturer in respect to the totaltrailer weight.

TRAILER LIGHTS

� Trailer lights must comply with federal,state/provincial and local regulations.See your local recreational vehicledealer or rental agency for the correcttype of wiring and relays for your trail-er. Check for correct operation of theturn signals and stop lights each timeyou hitch up. Direct splicing may dam-age your vehicle’s electrical systemand cause a malfunction of your lights.

BREAK−IN SCHEDULE

� Toyota recommends that you do nottow a trailer with a new vehicle or avehicle with any new power train com-ponent (engine, transmission, differen-tial, wheel bearing, etc.) for the first800 km (500 miles) of driving.

MAINTENANCE

� If you tow a trailer, your vehicle willrequire more frequent maintenance dueto the additional load. For this informa-tion, please refer to the scheduledmaintenance information in the “Sched-uled Maintenance Guide” or “Owner’sManual Supplement”.

� Retighten all fixing bolts of the towingball and bracket after approximately1000 km (600 miles) of trailer driving.

PRE−TOWING SAFETY CHECK

� Check that your vehicle remains levelwhen a loaded or unloaded trailer ishitched. Do not drive if the vehicle hasan abnormal nose−up or nose−downcondition, and check for impropertongue load, overload, worn suspensionor other possible causes.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2312003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Make sure the trailer cargo is securelyloaded so that it can not shift.

� Check that your rear view mirrors con-form to any applicable federal, state/provincial or local regulations. If not,install the rear view mirrors requiredfor towing purpose.

TRAILER TOWING TIPS

When towing a trailer, your vehicle willhandle differently than when not tow-ing. The three main causes of vehicle−trailer accidents are driver error, exces-sive speed and improper trailer loading.Keep these in mind when towing:

� Before starting out, check operation ofthe lights and all vehicle−trailer connec-tions. After driving a short distance,stop and recheck the lights and con-nections. Before actually towing a trail-er, practice turning, stopping and back-ing with a trailer in an area away fromtraffic until you learn the feel.

� Backing with a trailer is difficult andrequires practice. Grip the bottom ofthe steering wheel and move your handto the left to move the trailer to theleft. Move your hand to the right tomove the trailer to the right. (This pro-cedure is generally opposite to thatwhen backing without a trailer). Also,just turn the steering wheel a little ata time, avoiding sharp or prolongedturning. Have someone guide you whenbacking to reduce the risk of an acci-dent.

� Because stopping distance may be in-creased, vehicle−to−vehicle distanceshould be increased when towing atrailer. For each 16 km/h (10 mph) ofspeed, allow at least one vehicle andtrailer length between you and the ve-hicle ahead. Avoid sudden braking asyou may skid, resulting in jackknifingand loss of control. This is especiallytrue on wet or slippery surfaces.

� Avoid jerky starts or sudden accelera-tion.

� Avoid jerky steering and sharp turns.The trailer could hit your vehicle in atight turn. Slow down before making aturn to avoid the necessity of suddenbraking.

� Remember that when making a turn,the trailer wheels will be closer thanthe vehicle wheels to the inside of theturn. Therefore, compensate for this bymaking a larger than normal turningradius with your vehicle.

� Crosswinds and rough roads will ad-versely affect handling of your vehicleand trailer, causing sway. Pay attentionto the rear from time to time to pre-pare yourself for being passed by largetrucks or buses, which may cause yourvehicle and trailer to sway. If swayinghappens, firmly grip the steering wheeland reduce speed immediately butgradually. Never increase speed. Steerstraight ahead. If you make no extremecorrection with the steering or brakes,the vehicle and trailer will stabilize.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

232 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Be careful when passing other ve-hicles. Passing requires considerabledistance. After passing a vehicle, donot forget the length of your trailer andbe sure you have plenty of room be-fore changing lanes.

� In order to maintain engine braking effi-ciency do not use overdrive.

� Because of the added load of the trail-er, your vehicle’s engine may overheaton hot days (at temperatures over30�C [85�F]) when going up a long orsteep grade with a trailer. If the enginecoolant temperature gauge indicatesoverheating, immediately turn off the airconditioning (if in use), pull off the roadand stop in a safe spot. Refer to “Ifyour vehicle overheats” in Section 4.

� Always place wheel blocks under boththe vehicle and trailer wheels whenparking. Apply the parking brake firmly.Put the transmission in “P”. Avoid park-ing on a slope with a trailer, but if itcannot be avoided, do so only afterperforming the following:

1. Apply the brakes and hold.

2. Have someone place wheel blocks un-der both the vehicle and trailer wheels.

3. When the wheel blocks are in place,release your brakes slowly until theblocks absorb the load.

4. Apply the parking brake firmly.

5. Shift into “P” and turn off the engine.

When restarting out after parking on aslope:

1. With the transmission in “P” position,start the engine. Be sure to keep thebrake pedal depressed.

2. Shift into the “2”, “L” or “R” position.

3. Release the parking brake and brakepedal and slowly pull or back awayfrom the wheel blocks. Stop and applyyour brakes.

4. Have someone retrieve the blocks.

CAUTION

� Do not exceed 72 km/h (45 mph) orthe posted towing speed limit,whichever is lower. Because insta-bility (swaying) of a towing vehicle−trailer combination usually in-creases as the speed increases, ex-ceeding 72 km/h (45 mph) maycause loss of control.

� Slow down and downshift beforedescending steep or long downhillgrades. Do not make sudden down-shifts.

� Avoid holding the brake pedal downtoo long or too frequently. Thiscould cause the brakes to overheatand result in reduced braking effi-ciency.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2332003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Improving fuel economy is easy—just takeit easy. It will help make your vehicle lastlonger, too. Here are some specific tipson how to save money on both fuel andrepairs:

� Keep your tires inflated at the cor-rect pressure. Underinflation causestire wear and wastes fuel. See Section7−2 for instructions.

� Do not carry unneeded weight inyour vehicle. Excess weight puts aheavier load on the engine, causinggreater fuel consumption.

� Avoid lengthy warm−up idling. Oncethe engine is running smoothly, begindriving—but gently. Remember, howev-er, that on cold winter days this maytake a little longer.

� Keep the automatic transmissionoverdrive turned on when enginebraking is not required. Driving withthe overdrive off will reduce the fueleconomy. (For details, see “Automatictransmission” in Section 1−6.)

� Accelerate slowly and smoothly.Avoid jackrabbit starts.

� Avoid long engine idling. If you havea long wait and you are not in traffic,it is better to turn off the engine andstart again later.

� Avoid engine lugging or over−rev-ving. Use a gear position suitable forthe road on which you are travelling.

� Avoid continuous speeding up andslowing down. Stop−and−go drivingwastes fuel.

� Avoid unnecessary stopping andbraking. Maintain a steady pace. Tryto time the traffic signals so you onlyneed to stop as little as possible ortake advantage of through streets toavoid traffic lights. Keep a proper dis-tance from other vehicles to avoid sud-den braking. This will also reduce wearon your brakes.

� Avoid heavy traffic or traffic jamswhenever possible.

� Do not rest your foot on the brakepedal. This causes premature wear,overheating and poor fuel economy.

� Maintain a moderate speed on high-ways. The faster you drive, the greaterthe fuel consumption. By reducing yourspeed, you will cut down on fuel con-sumption.

� Keep the front wheels in properalignment. Avoid hitting the curb andslow down on rough roads. Improperalignment not only causes faster tirewear but also puts an extra load onthe engine, which, in turn, wastes fuel.

� Keep the bottom of your vehicle freefrom mud, etc. This not only lessensweight but also helps prevent corro-sion.

� Keep your vehicle tuned−up and intop shape. A dirty air cleaner, improp-er valve clearance, dirty plugs, dirty oiland grease, brakes not adjusted, etc.all lower engine performance and con-tribute to poor fuel economy. For longerlife of all parts and lower operatingcosts, keep all maintenance work onschedule, and if you often drive undersevere conditions, see that your vehiclereceives more frequent maintenance.(For scheduled maintenance informa-tion, please refer to the “ScheduledMaintenance Guide” or “Owner’s Manu-al Supplement”.)

How to save fuel and makeyour vehicle last longer

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

234 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

Never turn off the engine to coastdown hills. Your power steering andbrake booster will not function with-out the engine running. Also, theemission control system operatesproperly only when the engine is run-ning.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2352003 AVALON (OM41401U)

IN CASE OF AN EMERGENCYIf your vehicle will not start 236. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . If your engine stalls while driving 239. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . If your vehicle overheats 239. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . If you have a flat tire 240. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . If your vehicle becomes stuck 248. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . If your vehicle needs to be towed 249. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . If you cannot shift automatic transmission selector lever 251. . . . . . . . If you lose your keys 252. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . If you lose your wireless remote control transmitter 253. . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 4

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

236 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Before making these checks, make sureyou have followed the correct startingprocedure given in “How to start theengine” in Section 3 and that you havesufficient fuel. If your vehicle is equippedwith the engine immobiliser system, alsocheck whether the other keys will start theengine. If they work, your key may bebroken. Have the key checked at yourToyota dealer. If none of your keys work,the system is possibly broken. Call yourToyota dealer. (See “Keys (with engineimmobiliser system)” in Section 1−2.)

If the engine is not turning over or isturning over too slowly—

1. Check that the battery terminals aretight and clean.

2. If the battery terminals are O.K., switchon the interior light.

3. If the light is out, dim or goes outwhen the starter is cranked, the batteryis discharged. You may try jump start-ing. See “(c) Jump starting” for furtherinstructions.

If the light is O.K., but the engine still willnot start, it needs adjustment or repair.Call a Toyota dealer or qualified repairshop.

NOTICE

Do not pull− or push−start the ve-hicle. It may damage the vehicle orcause a collision when the enginestarts. Also the three−way catalyticconverter may overheat and become afire hazard.

If the engine turns over at its normalspeed but will not start—

1. The engine may be flooded because ofrepeated cranking. See “(b) Starting aflooded engine” for further instructions.

2. If the engine still will not start, it needsadjustment or repair. Call a Toyotadealer or qualified repair shop.

If the engine will not start, your enginemay be flooded because of repeatedcranking.

If this happens, turn the key to “START”with the accelerator pedal held down.Keep the key and accelerator pedal inthese positions for 15 seconds and re-lease them. Then try starting the enginewith your foot off the accelerator pedal.

If the engine does not start after 15 se-conds of cranking, release the key, waita few minutes and try again.

If the engine still will not start, it needsadjustment or repair. Call a Toyota dealeror qualified repair shop for assistance.

NOTICE

Do not crank for more than 30 se-conds at a time. This may overheatthe starter and wiring systems.

If your vehicle will not start—(a) Simple checks (b) Starting a flooded engine

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2372003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To avoid serious personal injury anddamage to your vehicle which might re-sult from battery explosion, acid burns,electrical burns, or damaged electroniccomponents, these instructions must befollowed precisely.

If you are unsure about how to follow thisprocedure, we strongly recommend thatyou seek the help of a competent me-chanic or towing service.

CAUTION

� Batteries contain sulfuric acidwhich is poisonous and corrosive.Wear protective safety glasses whenjump starting, and avoid spillingacid on your skin, clothing, or ve-hicle.

� If you should accidentally get acidon yourself or in your eyes, removeany contaminated clothing and flushthe affected area with water im-mediately. Then get immediate medi-cal attention. If possible, continueto apply water with a sponge orcloth while en route to the medicaloffice.

� The gas normally produced by abattery will explode if a flame orspark is brought near. Use onlystandardized jumper cables and donot smoke or light a match whilejump starting.

� Warning: Battery posts, terminalsand related accessories contain leadand lead compounds, chemicalsknown to the State of California tocause cancer and reproductiveharm. Wash hands after handling.

NOTICE

The battery used for boosting mustbe 12 V. Do not jump start unless youare sure that the booster battery iscorrect.

JUMP STARTING PROCEDURE

1. If the booster battery is installed inanother vehicle, make sure the vehiclesare not touching. Turn off all unneces-sary lights and accessories.

2. If required, remove all the vent plugsfrom the booster and discharged batter-ies. Lay a cloth over the open ventson the batteries. (This helps reduce theexplosion hazard, personal injuries andburns.)

3. If the engine in the vehicle with thebooster battery is not running, start itand let it run for a few minutes. Duringjump starting, run the engine at about2000 rpm with the accelerator pedallightly depressed.

(c) Jump starting

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

238 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Discharged battery

Boosterbattery

Positiveterminal(“+”mark)

Jumper cable Positive terminal(“+”mark)

4. Make the cable connections in the or-der a, b, c, d.

a. Connect the clamp of the positive(red) jumper cable to the positive (+)terminal on the discharged battery.

b. Connect the clamp at the other endof the positive (red) jumper cable tothe positive (+) terminal on the boosterbattery.

Jumper cable

Negative terminal(“−”mark)

Discharged battery Boosterbattery

c. Connect the clamp of the negative(black) jumper cable to the negative(−) terminal on the booster battery.

d. Connect the clamp at the other endof the negative (black) jumper cable toa solid, stationary, unpainted, metallicpoint of the vehicle with the dischargedbattery.

The recommended connecting point isshown in the following illustration:

Connecting point

Do not connect the cable to or nearany part that moves when the engineis cranked.

CAUTION

When making the connections, toavoid serious injury, do not lean overthe battery or accidentally let thejumper cables or clamps touch any-thing except the correct battery termi-nals or the ground.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2392003 AVALON (OM41401U)

5. Start your engine in the normal way.After starting, run it at about 2000 rpmfor several minutes with the acceleratorpedal lightly depressed.

6. Carefully disconnect the cables in theexact reverse order: the negative cableand then the positive cable.

7. Carefully dispose of the battery covercloths—they may now contain sulfuricacid.

8. If removed, replace all the battery ventplugs.

If the cause of your battery discharging isnot apparent (for example, lights left on),you should have it checked at your Toyotadealer.

If your engine stalls while driving...

1. Reduce your speed gradually, keepinga straight line. Move cautiously off theroad to a safe place.

2. Turn on your emergency flashers.

3. Try starting the engine again.

If the engine will not start, see “If yourvehicle will not start” in this section.

CAUTION

If the engine is not running, the pow-er assist for the brakes and steeringwill not work so steering and brakingwill be much harder than usual.

If your engine coolant temperaturegauge indicates overheating, if you ex-perience a loss of power, or if you heara loud knocking or pinging noise, theengine has probably overheated. Youshould follow this procedure...

1. Pull safely off the road, stop the ve-hicle and turn on your emergencyflashers. Put the transmission in “P”and apply the parking brake. Turn offthe air conditioning if it is being used.

2. If coolant or steam is boiling out of theradiator or reservoir, stop the engine.Wait until the steam subsides beforeopening the hood. If there is no coolantboiling over or steam, leave the enginerunning and make sure the electriccooling fan is operating. If it is not,turn the ignition off.

CAUTION

To help avoid personal injury, keepthe hood closed until there is nosteam. Escaping steam or coolant isa sign of very high pressure.

If your engine stalls whiledriving If your vehicle overheats

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

240 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

3. Look for obvious coolant leaks from theradiator, hoses, and under the vehicle.However, note that water draining fromthe air conditioning is normal if it hasbeen used.

CAUTION

When the engine is running, keephands and clothing away from themoving fan and engine drive belts.

4. If the coolant is leaking, stop the en-gine immediately. Call a Toyota dealerfor assistance.

5. If there are no obvious leaks, checkthe coolant reservoir. If it is dry, addcoolant to the reservoir while the en-gine is running. Fill it about half full.

CAUTION

Do not attempt to remove the radiatorcap when the engine and radiator arehot. Serious injury could result fromscalding hot fluid and steam blownout under pressure.

6. After the engine coolant temperaturehas cooled to normal, again check thecoolant level in the reservoir. If neces-sary, bring it up to half full again. Seri-ous coolant loss indicates a leak in thesystem. You should have it checked assoon as possible at your Toyota dealer.

1. Reduce your speed gradually, keepinga straight line. Move cautiously off theroad to a safe place well away fromthe traffic. Avoid stopping on the centerdivider of a highway. Park on a levelspot with firm ground.

2. Stop the engine and turn on youremergency flashers.

3. Firmly set the parking brake and putthe transmission in “P”.

4. Have everyone get out of the vehicleon the side away from traffic.

5. Read the following instructions thor-oughly.

CAUTION

When jacking, be sure to observe thefollowing to reduce the possibility ofpersonal injury:

� Follow jacking instructions.

� Do not put any part of your bodyunder the vehicle supported by thejack. Otherwise, personal injury mayoccur.

� Do not start or run the engine whileyour vehicle is supported by thejack.

If you have a flat tire—

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2412003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Stop the vehicle on a level firmground, firmly set the parking brakeand put the transmission in “P”.Block the wheel diagonally oppositeto the one being changed if neces-sary.

� Make sure to set the jack properlyin the jack point. Raising the ve-hicle with jack improperly posi-tioned will damage the vehicle ormay allow the vehicle to fall off thejack and cause personal injury.

� Never get under the vehicle whenthe vehicle is supported by the jackalone.

� Use the jack only for lifting yourvehicle during wheel changing.

� Do not raise the vehicle with some-one in the vehicle.

� When raising the vehicle, do notput an object on or under the jack.

� Raise the vehicle only high enoughto remove and change the tire.

NOTICE

Do not continue driving with a de-flated tire. Driving even a short dis-tance can damage a tire and wheelbeyond repair.

1. Get the required tools and sparetire.

1. Wheel nut wrench2. Jack3. Jack handle4. Spare tire

To prepare yourself for an emergency, youshould familiarize yourself with the use ofthe jack, each of the tools and their stor-age locations.

—Required tools and sparetire

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

242 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

To remove the jack, turn the jack joint byhand until the jack becomes free.

To store the jack, align the hole of thejack head with the vehicle hook. Turn thejack joint until the jack base fits securelywith the vehicle body.

This prevents the jack from flying forwardduring a collision or sudden stop.

To remove the spare tire:

1. Loosen the nut and remove it.

2. Remove the spare tire cover.

3. Loosen the bolt and remove it.

4. Remove the spacer.

Then take the spare tire out of the ve-hicle.

When storing the spare tire, put it in placewith the outer side of the wheel facing up.Then secure the tire by repeating theabove removal steps in reverse order toprevent it from flying forward during acollision or sudden braking.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2432003 AVALON (OM41401U)

2. Block the wheel diagonally oppositethe flat tire to keep the vehicle fromrolling when it is jacked up.

When blocking the wheel, place a wheelblock from the front for the front wheelsor from the rear for the rear wheels.

3. Remove the wheel ornament.

Pry off the wheel ornament, using thebeveled end of the wheel nut wrench asshown.

CAUTION

Do not try to pull off the ornament byhand. Take due care in handling theornament to avoid unexpected person-al injury.

4. Loosen all the wheel nuts.

Always loosen the wheel nuts before rais-ing the vehicle.

Turn the wheel nuts counterclockwise toloosen. To get maximum leverage, fit thewrench to the nut so that the handle ison the right side, as shown above. Grabthe wrench near the end of the handleand pull up on the handle. Be careful thatthe wrench does not slip off the nut.

Do not remove the nuts yet—just unscrewthem about one−half turn.

—Blocking the wheel—Removing wheel ornament(steel wheels only) —Loosening wheel nuts

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

244 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

Never use oil or grease on the boltsor nuts. The nuts may loose and thewheels may fall off, which could cau-se a serious accident.

5. Position the jack at the correct jackpoint as shown. Rotate the load rest90� from storage position to liftingposition.

Make sure the jack is positioned on alevel and solid place.

6. After making sure that no one is inthe vehicle, raise it high enough sothat the spare tire can be installed.

Remember you will need more groundclearance when putting on the spare tirethan when removing the flat tire.

To raise the vehicle, insert the jack handleinto the jack (it is a loose fit) and turn itclockwise. As the jack touches the vehicleand begins to lift, double−check that it isproperly positioned.

—Positioning the jack —Raising your vehicle

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2452003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

Never get under the vehicle when thevehicle is supported by the jackalone.

7. Remove the wheel nuts and changetires.

Lift the flat tire straight off and put itaside.

Roll the spare wheel into position andalign the holes in the wheel with the bolts.Then lift up the wheel and get at least thetop bolt started through its hole. Wigglethe tire and press it back over the otherbolts.

Before putting on wheels, remove any cor-rosion on the mounting surfaces with awire brush or such. Installation of wheelswithout good metal−to−metal contact at themounting surface can cause wheel nuts toloosen and eventually cause a wheel tocome off while driving.

—Changing wheels

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

246 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

8. Reinstall all the wheel nuts fingertight.

Reinstall the wheel nuts (tapered end in-ward) and tighten them as much as youcan by hand. Press back on the tire andsee if you can tighten them more.

CAUTION

Never use oil or grease on the boltsor nuts. Doing so may lead to over-tightening the nuts and damaging thebolts. The nuts may loose and thewheels may fall off, which could cau-se a serious accident. If there is oilor grease on any bolt or nut, cleanit.

9. Lower the vehicle completely andtighten the wheel nuts.

Turn the jack handle counterclockwise tolower the vehicle.

Use only the wheel nut wrench and turnit clockwise to tighten the nuts. Do notuse other tools or any additional leverageother than your hands, such as a hammer,pipe or your foot. Make sure the wrenchis securely engaged over the nut.

Tighten each nut a little at a time in theorder shown. Repeat the process until allthe nuts are tight.

—Reinstalling wheel nuts —Lowering your vehicle

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2472003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

� When lowering the vehicle, makesure all portions of your body andall other persons around will not beinjured as the vehicle is lowered tothe ground.

� Have the wheel nuts tightened bytorque wrench at 103 N·m (10.5kgf·m, 76 ft·lbf), as soon as pos-sible after changing wheels. Other-wise, the nuts may loosen and thewheels may fall off, which couldcause a serious accident. 10. Reinstall the wheel ornament.

Align the cutout of the wheel ornamentwith the valve stem as shown. Then tapit firmly with the side or heel of your handto snap it into place.

CAUTION

Take due care in handling the orna-ment to avoid unexpected personalinjury.

11. Check the air pressure of the re-placed tire.

Adjust the air pressure to the specificationdesignated in Section 8. If the pressure islower, drive slowly to the nearest servicestation and fill to the correct pressure.

Do not forget to reinstall the tire inflationvalve cap as dirt and moisture could getinto the valve core and possibly cause airleakage. If the cap is missing, have a newone put on as soon as possible.

12. Restow all the tools, jack and flattire securely.

As soon after changing wheels as pos-sible, tighten the wheel nuts to the torquespecified in Section 8 with a torquewrench. Have a technician repair the flattire and replace the spare tire with it.

—Reinstalling wheel ornament(steel wheels only) —After changing wheels

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

248 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

Before driving, make sure all thetools, jack and flat tire are securelyin place in their storage location toreduce the possibility of personal in-jury during a collision or suddenbraking.

If your vehicle becomes stuck in snow,mud, sand, etc., then you may attemptto rock the vehicle free by moving itforward and backward.

If your vehicle is equipped with thetraction control system, turn off thesystem to become unstuck. (For details,see “Traction control system” in Sec-tion 1−6.)

CAUTION

Do not attempt to rock the vehiclefree by moving it forward and back-ward if people or objects are any-where near the vehicle. During therocking operation the vehicle maysuddenly move forward or backwardas it becomes unstuck, causing injuryor damage to nearby people or ob-jects.

NOTICE

If you rock your vehicle, observe thefollowing precautions to prevent dam-age to the transmission and otherparts.

� Do not depress the accelerator ped-al while shifting the selector leveror before the transmission is com-pletely shifted to forward or reversegear.

� Do not race the engine and avoidspinning the wheels.

� If your vehicle remains stuck afterrocking the vehicle several times,consider other ways such as tow-ing.

If your vehicle becomes stuck

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2492003 AVALON (OM41401U)

(a) Towing with wheel lift type truck—

—From rear

(b) Using flat bed truck

—From front

If towing is necessary, we recommendyou to have it done by your Toyotadealer or a commercial tow truck ser-vice. In consultation with them, haveyour vehicle towed using either (a) or(b).

Only when you cannot receive a towingservice from a Toyota dealer or com-mercial tow truck service, tow your ve-hicle carefully in accordance with theinstructions given in “—Emergency tow-ing” in this section.

Proper equipment will help ensure thatyour vehicle is not damaged while beingtowed. Commercial operators are generallyaware of the state/provincial and locallaws pertaining to towing.

Your vehicle can be damaged if it istowed incorrectly. Although most operatorsknow the correct procedure, it is possibleto make a mistake. To avoid damage toyour vehicle, make sure the following pre-cautions are observed. If necessary, showthis page to the tow truck driver.

TOWING PRECAUTIONS:

Use a safety chain system for all towing,and abide by the state/provincial and locallaws. The wheels and axle on the groundmust be in good condition. If they aredamaged, use a towing dolly.

(a) Towing with wheel lift type truck

From front—Release the parking brake.

NOTICE

When lifting wheels, take care to en-sure adequate ground clearance fortowing at the opposite end of theraised vehicle. Otherwise, the bumperand/or underbody of the towed vehiclewill be damaged during towing.

From rear—Use a towing dolly under thefront wheels.

NOTICE

Never tow from the rear with the frontwheels on the ground, as this maycause serious damage to the trans-mission.

(b) Using flat bed truck

If your vehicle needs to betowed—

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

250 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

(c) Towing with sling type truck

(c) Towing with sling type truck

NOTICE

Do not tow with sling type truck, ei-ther from the front or rear. This maycause body damage.

Front

Rear (on some models)

If towing is necessary, we recommendyou to have it done by your Toyotadealer or a commercial tow truck ser-vice.

If towing service is not available in anemergency, your vehicle may be tempo-rarily towed by a cable or chain se-cured to one of the emergency towingeyelets under the vehicle. Use extremecaution when towing vehicles.

NOTICE

Only use specified towing eyelet;otherwise your vehicle may be dam-aged.

A driver must be in the vehicle to steerit and operate the brakes.

Towing in this manner may be done onlyon hard−surfaced roads for a short dis-tance and at low speeds. Also, thewheels, axles, drive train, steering andbrakes must all be in good condition.

—Emergency towing

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2512003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

Use extreme caution when towing ve-hicles. Avoid sudden starts or erraticdriving maneuvers which would placeexcessive stress on the emergencytowing eyelets and towing cable orchain. The eyelets and towing cableor chain may break and cause seriousinjury or damage.

NOTICE

Use only a cable or chain specificallyintended for use in towing vehicles.Securely fasten the cable or chain tothe towing eyelets provided.

Before towing, release the parking brakeand put the transmission in “N”. The keymust be in “ACC” (engine off) or “ON”(engine running).

CAUTION

If the engine is not running, the pow-er assist for the brakes and steeringwill not work so steering and brakingwill be much harder than usual.

If you cannot shift the selector leverout of “P” position to other positionseven though the brake pedal is de-pressed, use the shift lock override but-ton as follows:

1. Turn the ignition key to “LOCK”position. Make sure the parkingbrake is applied.

2. Pry up the cover with a flat−bladedscrewdriver or equivalent.

3. Insert your finger into the hole topush down the shift lock overridebutton. You can shift out of “P”position only while pushing the but-ton.

4. Shift into “N” position.

5. Insert the cover.

6. Start the engine. For your safety,keep the brake pedal depressed.

Be sure to have the system checked byyour Toyota dealer as soon as possible.

If you cannot shift automatictransmission selector lever(floor shift type)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

252 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If you cannot shift the selector leverout of “P” position to other positionseven though the brake pedal is de-pressed, use the shift lock override but-ton as follows:

1. Turn the ignition key to “LOCK”position. Make sure the parkingbrake is applied.

2. Pry up the cover with a flat−bladedscrewdriver or equivalent.

3. Insert the screwdriver or equivalentinto the hole to pull down the shiftlock override button. You can shiftout of “P” position only while push-ing the button.

4. Shift into “N” position.

5. Insert the cover.

6. Start the engine. For your safety,keep the brake pedal depressed.

Be sure to have the system checked byyour Toyota dealer as soon as possible.

You can purchase a new key at yourToyota dealer if you can give them thekey number. If your vehicle is equippedwith the engine immobiliser system, thedealer will also need your master key.

Vehicles with engine immobiliser system—Even if you lose only one key, contactyour Toyota dealer to make a new key. Ifyou lose all your master keys, you cannotmake new keys; the whole engine immobi-liser system must be replaced.

See the suggestion given in “Keys” inSection 1−2.

If your keys are locked in the vehicle andyou cannot get a duplicate, many Toyotadealers can still open the door for you,using their special tools. If you mustbreak a window to get in, we suggestbreaking the smallest side window be-cause it is the least expensive to replace.Be extremely cautious to avoid cuts fromthe glass.

If you cannot shift automatictransmission selector lever(column shift type) If you lose your keys

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2532003 AVALON (OM41401U)

You can purchase a new wireless re-mote control transmitter at your Toyotadealer.

Have the registered identification numbersof your transmitters deleted from your ve-hicle by your Toyota dealer as soon aspossible to avoid the possibility of theft oran accident. Then, have the identificationnumber of your new transmitter registered.At the same time, you must bring all ofthe remaining transmitters to have themregistered again as well.

You can use the wireless remote controlsystem with the new transmitter. Contactyour Toyota dealer for detailed information.

If you lose your wirelessremote control transmitter

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

254 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2552003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CORROSION PREVENTION ANDAPPEARANCE CAREProtecting your Toyota from corrosion 256. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Washing and waxing your Toyota 257. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning the interior 258. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 5

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

256 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Toyota, through its diligent research, de-sign and use of the most advancedtechnology available, has done its part tohelp prevent corrosion and has providedyou with the finest quality vehicleconstruction. Now, it is up to you. Propercare of your Toyota can help ensure long−term corrosion prevention.

The most common causes of corrosionto your vehicle are:

� The accumulation of road salt, dirt andmoisture in hard−to−reach areas underthe vehicle.

� Chipping of paint, or undercoatingcaused by minor accidents or bystones and gravel.

Care is especially important if you livein particular areas or operate your ve-hicle under certain environmental condi-tions:

� Road salt or dust control chemicals willaccelerate corrosion, as will the pres-ence of salt in the air near the sea−coast or in areas of industrial pollution.

� High humidity accelerates corrosion es-pecially when temperatures range justabove the freezing point.

� Wetness or dampness to certain partsof your vehicle for an extended periodof time, may cause corrosion eventhough other parts of the vehicle maybe dry.

� High ambient temperatures can causecorrosion to those components of thevehicle which are prevented fromquick−drying due to lack of proper ven-tilation.

The above signifies the necessity to keepyour vehicle, particularly the underside, asclean as possible and to repair any dam-age to paint or protective coatings assoon as possible.

To help prevent corrosion on yourToyota, follow these guidelines:

Wash your vehicle frequently. It is, ofcourse, necessary to keep your vehicleclean by regular washing, but to preventcorrosion, the following points should beobserved:

� If you drive on salted roads in thewinter or if you live near the ocean,you should hose off the undercarriageat least once a month to minimize cor-rosion.

� High pressure water or steam is effec-tive for cleaning the vehicle’s undersideand wheel housings. Pay particularattention to these areas as it is difficultto see all the mud and dirt. It will domore harm than good to simply wet themud and debris without removing them.The lower edge of doors, rocker panelsand frame members have drain holeswhich should not be allowed to clogwith dirt as trapped water in theseareas can cause corrosion.

� Wash the underside of the vehicle thor-oughly when winter is over.

See “Washing and waxing your Toyota” formore tips.

Check the condition of your vehicle’spaint and trim. If you find any chips orscratches in the paint, touch them up im-mediately to prevent corrosion from start-ing. If the chips or scratches have gonethrough the bare metal, have a qualifiedbody shop make the repair.

Protecting your Toyota fromcorrosion

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2572003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Check the interior of your vehicle. Wa-ter and dirt can accumulate under thefloor mats and could cause corrosion. Oc-casionally check under the mats to makesure the area is dry. Be particularly care-ful when transporting chemicals, cleans-ers, fertilizers, salt, etc.; these should betransported in proper containers. If a spillor leak should occur, immediately cleanand dry the area.

Use mud shields on your wheels. If youdrive on salted or gravel roads, mudshields help protect your vehicle. Full−sizeshields, which come as near to the groundas possible, are the best. We recommendthat the fittings and the area where theshields are installed be treated to resistcorrosion. Your Toyota dealer will behappy to assist in supplying and installingthe shields if they are recommended foryour area.

Keep your vehicle in a well ventilatedgarage or a roofed place. Do not parkyour vehicle in a damp, poorly venti-lated garage. If you wash your vehicle inthe garage, or if you drive it in coveredwith water or snow, your garage may beso damp it will cause corrosion. Even ifyour garage is heated, a wet vehicle cancorrode if the ventilation is poor.

Washing your Toyota

Keep your vehicle clean by regularwashing.

The following cases may cause weaknessto the paint or corrosion to the body andparts. Wash your vehicle as soon as pos-sible.

� When driving in a coastal area

� When driving on a road sprinkled withantifreeze

� When having coal tar, tree sap, birddroppings and carcass of an insect

� When driving in the areas where thereis a lot of smoke, soot, dust, iron dustand chemical substance

� When the vehicle becomes remarkablydirty with dust and mud

Hand−washing your Toyota

Work in the shade and wait until thevehicle body is not hot to the touch.

CAUTION

When cleaning under floor or chassis,be careful not to injure your hands.

1. Rinse off loose dirt with a hose. Re-move any mud or road salt from theunderside of the vehicle or in thewheel wells.

2. Wash with a mild car−wash soap,mixed according to the manufacturer’sinstructions. Use a soft cotton mitt andkeep it wet by dipping it frequently intothe wash water. Do not rub hard—letthe soap and water remove the dirt.

Plastic wheel ornaments: The plasticwheel ornaments are damaged easily byorganic substances. If any organic sub-stances splashes an ornament, be sure towash it off with water and check if theornament is damaged.

CAUTION

Do not attach the heavily damagedplastic wheel ornament. It may fly offthe wheel and cause accidents whilethe vehicle is moving.

Aluminum wheels: Use only a mild soapor neutral detergent.

Plastic bumpers: Wash carefully. Do notscrub with abrasive cleaners. The bumperfaces are soft.

Washing and waxing yourToyota

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

258 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Road tar: Remove with turpentine orcleaners that are marked safe for paintedsurfaces.

NOTICE

Do not use organic substances (gaso-line, kerosene, benzine or strong sol-vents), which may be toxic or causedamage.

3. Rinse thoroughly—dried soap cancause streaking. In hot weather youmay need to rinse each section rightafter you wash it.

4. To prevent water spots, dry the vehicleusing a clean soft cotton towel. Do notrub or press hard—you might scratchthe paint.

Automatic car wash

Your vehicle may be washed in an auto-matic car wash, but remember that thepaint can be scratched by some type ofbrushes, unfiltered washing water, or thewashing process itself. Scratching reducespaint durability and gloss, especially ondarker colors. The manager of the carwash should be able to advise you wheth-er the process is safe for the paint onyour vehicle.

Waxing your Toyota

Polishing and waxing is recommendedto maintain the original beauty of yourToyota’s finish.

Once a month or if the vehicle surfacedoes not repel water well, apply wax.

1. Always wash and dry the vehicle be-fore you begin waxing, even if you areusing a combined cleaner and wax.

2. Use a good quality polish and wax. Ifthe finish has become extremely weath-ered, use a car−cleaning polish, fol-lowed by a separate wax. Carefully fol-low the manufacturer’s instructions andprecautions. Be sure to polish and waxthe chrome trim as well as the paint.

3. Wax the vehicle again when waterdoes not bead but remains on the sur-face in large patches.

NOTICE

Always remove the plastic bumpers ifyour vehicle is re−painted and placedin a high heat paint waxing booth.High temperatures could damage thebumpers.

CAUTION

� Be careful not to splash water orspill liquid on the floor. This mayprevent the side airbags from acti-vating correctly, resulting in seriousinjury.

� Do not wash the vehicle floor withwater, or allow water to get ontothe floor when cleaning the vehicleinterior or exterior. Water may getinto audio components or otherelectrical components above or un-der the floor carpet (or mat) andcause a malfunction; and it maycause body corrosion.

Vinyl interior

The vinyl upholstery may be easilycleaned with a mild soap or detergentand water.

Cleaning the interior

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2592003 AVALON (OM41401U)

First vacuum over the upholstery to re-move loose dirt. Then, using a sponge orsoft cloth, apply the soap solution to thevinyl. After allowing it to soak in for a fewminutes to loosen the dirt, remove the dirtand wipe off the soap with a clean dampcloth. If all the dirt do not come off, re-peat the procedure. Commercial foaming−type vinyl cleaners are also availablewhich work well. Follow the manufacturer’sinstructions.

NOTICE

Do not use solvent, thinner, gasolineor window cleaner on the interior.

Carpets

Use a good foam−type shampoo toclean the carpets.

Begin by vacuuming thoroughly to removeas much dirt as possible. Several types offoam cleaners are available; some are inaerosol cans and others are powders orliquids which you mix with water to pro-duce a foam. To shampoo the carpets,use a sponge or brush to apply the foam.Rub in overlapping circles.

Do not apply water—the best results areobtained by keeping the carpet as dry aspossible. Read the shampoo instructionsand follow them closely.

Seat belts

The seat belts may be cleaned withmild soap and water or with lukewarmwater.

Use a cloth or sponge. As you are clean-ing, check the belts for excessive wear,fraying, or cuts.

NOTICE

� Do not use dye or bleach on thebelts—it may weaken them.

� Do not use the belts until they be-come dry.

Windows

The windows may be cleaned with anyhousehold window cleaner.

NOTICE

When cleaning the inside of the rearwindow, be careful not to scratch ordamage the heater wires or connec-tors.

Air conditioning control panel, car au-dio, instrument panel, console panel,and switches

Use a soft damp cloth for cleaning.

Soak a clean soft cloth in water or luke-warm water then lightly wipe off dirt.

NOTICE

� Do not use organic substances (sol-vents, kerosene, alcohol, gasoline,etc.) or alkaline or acidic solutions.These chemicals can cause discol-oring, staining or peeling of thesurface.

� If you use cleaners or polishingagents, make sure their ingredientsdo not include the substances men-tioned above.

� If you use a liquid car freshener, donot spill the liquid onto the ve-hicle’s interior surfaces. It may con-tain the ingredients mentionedabove. Immediately clean any spillusing the method mentioned above.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

260 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Leather Interior

The leather upholstery may be cleanedwith neutral detergent for wool.

Remove dirt using a soft cloth dampenedwith 5% solution of neutral detergent forwool. Then thoroughly wipe off all tracesof detergent with a clean damp cloth.

After cleaning or whenever any part of theleather gets wet, dry with a soft cleancloth. Allow the leather to dry in a venti-lated shaded area.

NOTICE

� If a stain should fail to come outwith a neutral detergent, apply acleaner that does not contain anorganic solvent.

� Never use organic substances suchas benzine, alcohol or gasoline, o ralkaline or acid solutions for clean-ing the leather as thesecould c ause discoloring.

� Use of a nylon brush or syntheticfiber cloth, etc. may scratch thefine grained surface of the leather.

� Mildew may develop on soiled leath-er upholstery. Be especially carefulto avoid oil spots. Try to keep yourupholstery always clean.

� Long exposure to direct sunlightmay cause the leather surface toharden and shrink. Keep your ve-hicle in a shaded area, especially inthe summer.

� The interior of your vehicle is aptto heat up on hot summer days, soavoid placing on the upholsteryitems made of vinyl or plastic orcontaining wax as these tend tostick to leather when warm.

� Improper cleaning of the leather up-holstery could result in discolor-ation or staining.

If you have any questions about thecleaning of your Toyota, your localToyota dealer will be pleased to answerthem.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2612003 AVALON (OM41401U)

VEHICLE MAINTENANCE AND CAREMaintenance requirements 262. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General maintenance 263. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Does your vehicle need repairing? 265. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Emissions Inspection and Maintenance (I/M) programs 266. . . . . . . . .

For scheduled maintenance information, please refer to the“Scheduled Maintenance Guide” or “Owner’s Manual Supplement”.

SECTION 6

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

262 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Your Toyota vehicle has been designed forfewer maintenance requirements with long-er service intervals to save both your timeand money. However, each regular mainte-nance, as well as day−to−day care, ismore important than ever before to ensuresmooth, and trouble−free, safe, and eco-nomical drivings.

It is the owner’s responsibility to makesure the specified maintenance, includinggeneral maintenance service, is performed.Note that both the new vehicle and emis-sion control system warranties specify thatproper maintenance and care must be per-formed. See “Owner’s Warranty Informa-tion Booklet” or “Owner’s Manual Supple-ment” for complete warranty information.

General maintenance

General maintenance items are those day−to−day care practices that are important toyour vehicle for proper operation. It is theowner’s responsibility to insure that thegeneral maintenance items are performedregularly.

These checks or inspections can be doneeither by yourself or a qualified technician,or if you prefer, your Toyota dealer will bepleased to do them at a nominal cost.

Scheduled maintenance

The scheduled maintenance items listed inthe “Scheduled Maintenance Guide” or“Owner’s Manual Supplement” are thoserequired to be serviced at regular inter-vals.

For details of your maintenance schedule,read the “Scheduled Maintenance Guide”or “Owner’s Manual Supplement”.

It is recommended that any replacementparts used for maintenance or for therepair of the emission control systembe Toyota supplied.

The owner may elect to use non−Toyotasupplied parts for replacement pur-poses without invalidating the emissioncontrol system warranty. However, useof replacement parts which are not ofequivalent quality may impair the effec-tiveness of the emission control sys-tems.

You may also elect to have mainte-nance, replacement, or repair of theemission control devices and systemperformed by any automotive repair es-tablishment or individual without invali-dating this warranty. See “Owner’s War-ranty Information Booklet” or “Owner’sManual Supplement” for complete war-ranty information.

Where to go for service?

Toyota technicians are well−trained spe-cialists and are kept up to date with thelatest service information through technicalbulletins, service tips, and in−dealershiptraining programs. They learn to work onToyotas before they work on your vehicle,rather than while they are working on it.

You can be confident that your Toyotadealer’s service department performs thebest job to meet the maintenance require-ments on your vehicle—reliably and eco-nomically.

Your copy of the repair order is proof thatall required maintenance has been per-formed for warranty coverage. And if anyproblems should arise with your vehiclewhile under warranty, your Toyota dealerwill promptly take care of it. Again, besure to keep a copy of the repair orderfor any service performed on your Toyota.

Maintenance requirements

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2632003 AVALON (OM41401U)

What about do−it−yourself maintenance?

Many of the maintenance items are easyto do yourself if you have a little mechani-cal ability and a few basic automotivetools. Simple instructions for how to per-form them are presented in Section 7.

If you are a skilled do−it−yourself mechan-ic, the Toyota service manuals are recom-mended. Please be aware that do−it−your-self maintenance can affect your warrantycoverage. See “Owner’s Warranty Informa-tion Booklet” or “Owner’s Manual Supple-ment” for the details.

Listed below are the general maintenanceitems that should be performed as fre-quently as specified. In addition to check-ing the items listed, if you notice anyunusual noise, smell or vibration, youshould investigate the cause or take yourvehicle to your Toyota dealer or a quali-fied service shop immediately. It is recom-mended that any problem you notice bebrought to the attention of your dealer orthe qualified service shop for their advice.

CAUTION

Make these checks only where ade-quate ventilation can be obtained ifyou run the engine.

OUTSIDE THE VEHICLE

Items listed below should be performedfrom time to time, unless otherwisespecified.

Tire pressureCheck the pressure with a gauge everytwo weeks, or at least once a month. SeeSection 7−2 for additional information.

Tire surface and wheel nutsCheck the tires carefully for cuts, damageor excessive wear. See Section 7−2 foradditional information. When checking thetires, make sure no nuts are missing, andcheck the nuts for looseness. Tightenthem if necessary.

Tire rotationRotate the tires according to the mainte-nance schedule. (For scheduled mainte-nance information, please refer to the“Scheduled Maintenance Guide” or “Own-er’s Manual Supplement”.) See Section7−2 for additional information.

Fluid leaksCheck underneath for leaking fuel, oil, wa-ter or other fluid after the vehicle hasbeen parked for a while. If you smell fuelfumes or notice any leak, have the causefound and corrected immediately.

Doors and engine hoodCheck that all doors including trunk lidoperate smoothly and all latches lock se-curely. Make sure the engine hood sec-ondary latch secures the hood from open-ing when the primary latch is released.

General maintenance

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

264 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

INSIDE THE VEHICLE

Items listed below should be checkedregularly, e.g. while performing periodicservices, cleaning the vehicle, etc.

LightsMake sure the headlights, stop lights, taillights, turn signal lights, and other lightsare all working. Check headlight aim.

Service reminder indicators and warningbuzzersCheck that all service reminder indicatorsand warning buzzers function properly.

Steering wheelCheck that it has the specified free play.Be alert for changes in steering condition,such as hard steering or strange noise.

SeatsCheck that all front seat controls such asseat adjusters, seatback recliner, etc. op-erate smoothly and that all latches locksecurely in any position. Check that thehead restraints move up and downsmoothly and that the locks hold securelyin any latched position.

Seat beltsCheck that the seat belt system such asbuckles, retractors and anchors operateproperly and smoothly. Make sure the beltwebbing is not cut, frayed, worn or dam-aged.

Accelerator pedalCheck the pedal for smooth operation anduneven pedal effort or catching.

Brake pedalCheck the pedal for smooth operation andthat the pedal has the proper clearance.Check the brake booster function.

BrakesAt a safe place, check that the brakes donot pull to one side when applied.

Parking brakeCheck that the pedal has the proper traveland that, on a safe incline, your vehicleis held securely with only the parkingbrake applied.

Automatic transmission “Park” mecha-nismCheck the lock release button of the se-lector lever for proper and smooth opera-tion. On a safe incline, check that yourvehicle is held securely with the selectorlever in “P” position and all brakes re-leased.

IN THE ENGINE COMPARTMENT

Items listed below should be checkedfrom time to time, e.g. each time whenrefueling.

Washer fluidMake sure there is sufficient fluid in thetank. See Section 7−3 for additional infor-mation.

Engine coolant levelMake sure the coolant level is betweenthe “FULL” and “LOW” lines on the see−through reservoir when the engine is cold.See Section 7−2 for additional information.

Radiator, condenser and hosesCheck that the front of the radiator andcondenser are clean and not blocked withleaves, dirt, or insects. See in Section7−2 for additional information.

Battery conditionCheck the battery condition by the indica-tor color. See Section 7−3 for additionalinformation.

Brake fluid levelMake sure the brake fluid level is correct.See Section 7−2 for additional information.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2652003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Engine oil levelCheck the level on the dipstick with theengine turned off and the vehicle parkedon a level spot. See Section 7−2 for addi-tional information.

Power steering fluid levelCheck the level through the reservoir. Thelevel should be in the “HOT” or “COLD”range depending on the fluid temperature.See Section 7−2 for additional information.

Exhaust systemIf you notice any change in the sound ofthe exhaust or smell exhaust fumes, havethe cause located and corrected immedi-ately. (See “Engine exhaust cautions” inSection 2.)

Be on the alert for changes in perfor-mance, sounds, and visual tip−offs thatindicate service is needed. Some impor-tant clues are as follows:

� Engine missing, stumbling, or pinging

� Appreciable loss of power

� Strange engine noises

� A leak under the vehicle (however, wa-ter dripping from the air conditioningafter use is normal.)

� Change in exhaust sound (This mayindicate a dangerous carbon monoxideleak. Drive with the windows open andhave the exhaust system checked im-mediately.)

� Flat−looking tire; excessive tire squealwhen cornering; uneven tire wear

� Vehicle pulls to one side when drivingstraight on a level road

� Strange noises related to suspensionmovement

� Loss of brake effectiveness; spongyfeeling brake; pedal almost touchesfloor; vehicle pulls to one side whenbraking

� Engine coolant temperature continuallyhigher than normal

If you notice any of these clues, take yourvehicle to your Toyota dealer as soon aspossible. It probably needs adjustment orrepair.

CAUTION

Do not continue driving with the ve-hicle unchecked. It could result in se-rious vehicle damage and possiblypersonal injury.

Does your vehicle needrepairing?

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

266 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Some states have vehicle emission in-spection programs which include OBD(On−Board Diagnostics) checks.

The OBD system monitors the operationof the emission control system. When theOBD system determines that a problemexists somewhere in the emission controlsystem, the malfunction indicator lampcomes on. In this case, your vehicle maynot pass the I/M test and need to berepaired. Contact your Toyota dealer toservice the vehicle.

Even if the malfunction indicator lampdoes not come on, your vehicle may notpass the I/M test as readiness codeshave not been set in the OBD system.

Readiness codes are automatically setduring ordinary driving. However, when thebattery is disconnected or run down, thecodes are erased. Also, depending onyour driving habits, the codes may not becompletely set.

Also, if the malfunction indicator lamp hadcome on recently due to temporary mal-function such as a loose fuel tank cap,your vehicle may not pass the I/M test.

The malfunction indicator lamp will go offafter taking several driving trips, but theerror code in the OBD system will not becleared unless about 40 trips or more aretaken.

If your vehicle does not pass the I/M testeven the malfunction indicator lamp doesnot come on, contact your Toyota dealerto prepare the vehicle for re−testing.

Emissions Inspection andMaintenance (I/M) programs

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2672003 AVALON (OM41401U)

DO−IT−YOURSELF MAINTENANCEIntroductionEngine compartment overview 268. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuse locations 269. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Do−it−yourself service precautions 270. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Positioning the jack 272. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parts and tools 273. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 7− 1

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

268 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Engine coolant reservoir

2. Power steering fluid reservoir

3. Engine oil level dipstick

4. Engine oil filler cap

5. Brake fluid reservoir

6. Fuse blocks

7. Battery

8. Radiator

9. Electric cooling fans

10. Condenser

11. Windshield washer fluid tank

Engine compartment overview

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2692003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Spare fuses

Fuse locations

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

270 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If you perform maintenance by yourself,be sure to follow the correct proceduregiven in this section.

You should be aware that improper or in-complete servicing may result in operatingproblems.

Performing do−it−yourself maintenanceduring the warranty period may affect yourwarranty coverage. Read the separateToyota Warranty statement for details andsuggestions.

This section gives instructions only forthose items that are relatively easy for anowner to perform. As explained in Section6, there are still a number of items thatmust be done by a qualified technicianwith special tools.

For information on tools and parts for do−it−yourself maintenance, see “Parts andtools” in this section.

Utmost care should be taken when work-ing on your vehicle to prevent accidentalinjury. Here are a few precautions thatyou should be especially careful to ob-serve:

CAUTION

� When the engine is running, keephands, clothing, and tools awayfrom the moving fan and enginedrive belts. (Removing rings,watches, and ties is advisable.)

� Right after driving, the enginecompartment—the engine, radiator,exhaust manifold and spark plugboots, etc.—will be hot. So be care-ful not to touch them. Oil, fluidsand spark plugs may also be hot.

� If the engine is hot, do not removethe radiator cap or loosen the drainplugs to prevent burning yourself.

� Do not smoke, cause sparks or al-low open flames around fuel or thebattery. Their fumes are flammable.

� Do not get under your vehicle withjust the body jack supporting it. Al-ways use automotive jack stands orother solid supports.

� Be sure that the ignition is off ifyou work near the electric coolingfans or radiator grille. With theignition on, the electric cooling fanswill automatically start to run if theengine coolant temperature is highand/or the air conditioning is on.

� Use eye protection whenever youwork on or under your vehiclewhere you may be exposed to flyingor falling material, fluid spray, etc.

� Used engine oil contains potentiallyharmful contaminants which maycause skin disorders such as in-flammation or skin cancer, so careshould be taken to avoid prolongedand repeated contact with it. To re-move used engine oil from yourskin, wash thoroughly with soapand water.

� Do not leave used oil within thereach of children.

� Dispose of used oil and filter onlyin a safe and acceptable manner.Do not dispose of used oil and fil-ter in household trash, in sewers oronto the ground. Call your dealer ora service station for informationconcerning recycling or disposal.

Do−it−yourself serviceprecautions

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2712003 AVALON (OM41401U)

� Be extremely cautious when work-ing on the battery. It contains poi-sonous and corrosive sulfuric acid.

� Warning: Battery posts, terminalsand related accessories contain leadand lead compounds, chemicalsknown to the State of California tocause cancer and reproductiveharm. Wash hands after handling.

NOTICE

� Remember that battery and ignitioncables carry high currents or volt-ages. Be careful of accidentallycausing a short circuit.

� Add only demineralized or distilledwater to fill the radiator. And if youspill some of the coolant, be sureto wash off with water to prevent itfrom damaging the parts or paint.

� Do not allow dirt or anything elseto fall through the spark plug holes.

� Do not pry the outer electrode of aspark plug against the center elec-trode.

� Use only spark plugs of the speci-fied type. Using other types willcause engine damage, loss of per-formance or radio noise.

� Do not reuse iridium−tipped sparkplugs by cleaning or regapping.

� Do not overfill automatic transmis-sion fluid, or the transmissioncould be damaged.

� Do not drive with the air cleanerfilter removed, or excessive enginewear could result. Also backfiringcould cause a fire in the enginecompartment.

� Be careful not to scratch the glasssurface with the wiper frame.

� When closing the engine hood,check to see that you have not for-gotten any tools, rags, etc.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

272 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Front

Rear

When jacking up your vehicle with thejack, position the jack correctly asshown in the illustrations.

CAUTION

When jacking, be sure to observe thefollowing to reduce the possibility ofpersonal injury:

� Follow jacking instructions.

� Do not put any part of your bodyunder the vehicle supported by thejack. Personal injury may occur.

� Do not start or run the engine whileyour vehicle is supported by thejack.

� Stop the vehicle on a level firmground, firmly set the parking brakeand put the transmission in “P”.Block the wheels on the oppositeside of the jack up point if neces-sary.

� Make sure to set the jack properlyin the jack point. Raising the ve-hicle with jack improperly posi-tioned will damage the vehicle ormay allow the vehicle to fall off thejack and cause personal injury.

� Never get under the vehicle whenthe vehicle is supported by the jackalone; use vehicle support stands.

� Do not raise the vehicle with some-one in the vehicle.

� When raising the vehicle, do notput an object on or under the jack.

NOTICE

Make sure to place the jack correctly,or your vehicle may be damaged.

Positioning the jack

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2732003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Here is a list of parts and tools you willneed on performing do−it−yourself mainte-nance. Remember all Toyota parts are de-signed in metric sizes, so your tools mustbe metric.

CHECKING THE ENGINE OIL LEVEL

Parts (if level is low):

� “Toyota Genuine Motor Oil” or equiva-lent

See Section 7−2 for details about en-gine oil selection.

Tools:

� Rag or paper towel

� Funnel (only for adding oil)

CHECKING THE ENGINE COOLANTLEVEL

Parts (if level is low):

� “Toyota Genuine Long Life Coolant” orequivalent

See Section 7−2 for details about cool-ant type selection.

� Demineralized or distilled water

Tools:

� Funnel (only for adding coolant)

CHECKING BRAKE FLUID

Parts (if level is low):

� SAE J1703 or FMVSS No.116 DOT 3brake fluid

Tools:

� Rag or paper towel

� Funnel (only for adding fluid)

CHECKING POWER STEERING FLUID

Parts (if level is low):

� Automatic transmission fluidDEXRON�II or III

Tools:

� Rag or paper towel

� Funnel (only for adding fluid)

CHECKING BATTERY CONDITION

Tools:

� Warm water

� Baking soda

� Grease

� Conventional wrench (for terminalclamp bolts)

CHECKING AND REPLACING FUSES

Parts (if replacement is necessary):

� Fuse with same amperage rating asoriginal

ADDING WASHER FLUID

Parts:

� Water

� Washer fluid containing antifreeze(for winter use)

Tools:

� Funnel

REPLACING LIGHT BULBS

Parts:

� Bulb with same number and wattagerating as original (See charts in “Re-placing light bulbs” in Section 7−3.)

Tools:

� Screwdriver

Parts and tools

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

274 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2752003 AVALON (OM41401U)

DO−IT−YOURSELF MAINTENANCEEngine and ChassisChecking the engine oil level 276. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking the engine coolant level 278. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking the radiator and condenser 280. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking brake fluid 280. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking power steering fluid 281. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking tire pressure 281. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking and replacing tires 282. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rotating tires 284. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installing snow tires and chains 284. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacing wheels 286. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Aluminum wheel precautions 286. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 7− 2

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

276 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Low level

Add oil O.K. Too full

Full level

With the engine at operating tempera-ture and turned off, check the oil levelon the dipstick.

1. To get a true reading, the vehicleshould be on a level spot. After turningoff the engine, wait a few minutes forthe oil to drain back into the bottom ofthe engine.

2. Pull the dipstick out, hold a rag underthe end and wipe it clean.

3. Reinsert the dipstick—push it in as faras it will go, or the reading will not becorrect.

4. Pull the dipstick out and look at the oillevel while holding a rag under theend.

CAUTION

Be careful not to touch the hot ex-haust manifold.

NOTICE

Be careful not to drop the engine oilon the vehicle components.

If the oil level is below or only slightlyabove the low level, add engine oil ofthe same type as already in the engine.

Remove the oil filler cap and add engineoil in small quantities at a time, checkingthe dipstick. We recommend that you usea funnel when adding oil.

The approximate quantity of oil needed tofill between the low level and the full levelon the dipstick is indicated below for ref-erence.

When the level reaches within the correctrange, install the filler cap hand−tight.

Oil quantity, L (qt., Imp. qt.):1.5 (1.6, 1.3)

NOTICE

� Be careful not to spill the engineoil on the vehicle components.

� Avoid overfilling, or the enginecould be damaged.

� Check the oil level on the dipstickonce again after adding the oil.

Checking the engine oil level

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2772003 AVALON (OM41401U)

ENGINE OIL SELECTION

“Toyota Genuine Motor Oil” is filled inyour Toyota vehicle. Use Toyota approved“Toyota Genuine Motor Oil” or equivalentto satisfy the following grade andviscosity.

Oil grade:API grade SL “Energy−Conserving” orILSAC multigrade engine oil

Recommended viscosity:SAE 5W−30

Outside temperature

SAE 5W−30 is the best choice for goodfuel economy and good starting in coldweather.

If SAE 5W−30 is not available, SAE10W−30 may be used. However, itshould be replaced with SAE 5W−30 atthe next oil change.

API service symbol

ILSAC certification mark

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

278 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Oil identification marks

Either or both API registered marks areadded to some oil containers to helpyou select the oil you should use.

The API Service Symbol is located any-where on the outside of the container.

The top portion of the label shows the oilquality by API (American Petroleum Insti-tute) designations such as SL. The centerportion of the label shows the SAE viscos-ity grade such as SAE 5W−30. “Energy−Conserving” shown in the lower portion,indicates that the oil has fuel−saving ca-pabilities.

The ILSAC (International Lubricant Stan-dardization and Approval Committee) Certi-fication Mark is displayed on the front ofthe container.

To ensure the best possible lubricationperformance for your engine, the “ToyotaGenuine Motor Oil” range is available,which has been specifically tested and ap-proved for all Toyota engines.

Please contact your Toyota dealer for fur-ther details of the “Toyota Genuine MotorOil” range.

Look at the see−through coolant reser-voir when the engine is cold. The cool-ant level is satisfactory if it is betweenthe “FULL” and “LOW” lines on thereservoir. If the level is low, add ethyl-ene−glycol type coolant for a propercorrosion protection of aluminum com-ponents.

The coolant level in the reservoir will varywith engine temperature. However, if thelevel is on or below the “LOW” line, addcoolant. Bring the level up to the “FULL”line.

Always use ethylene−glycol type coolantfor a proper corrosion protection of alumi-num components. See information in thenext column.

If the coolant level drops within a shorttime after replenishing, there may be aleak in the system. Visually check theradiator, hoses, radiator cap and draincock and water pump.

If you can find no leak, have your Toyotadealer test the cap pressure and checkfor leaks in the cooling system.

Checking the engine coolantlevel

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2792003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

To prevent burning yourself, do notremove the radiator cap when the en-gine is hot.

Coolant type selection

Use of improper coolants may damageyour engine cooling system. Your coolantmust contain ethylene−glycol type coolantfor a proper corrosion protection of yourengine that contains aluminumcomponents.

We have used “Toyota Genuine Long LifeCoolant” in your Toyota vehicle. In orderto avoid technical problems, we stronglyrecommend using “Toyota Genuine LongLife Coolant” or equivalent.

In addition to preventing freezing andsubsequent damage to the engine, thistype of coolant will also prevent corrosion.Further supplemental inhibitors or additivesare neither needed nor recommended.

Read the coolant container for informationon freeze protection. Follow the manufac-turer’s directions for how much to mixwith plain water (preferably demineralizedwater or distilled water). The total capacityof the cooling system is given in Section8.

We recommend to use 50% solution foryour Toyota, to provide protection down toabout −35�C (−31�F). When it is extreme-ly cold, to provide protection down toabout −50�C (−58�F), 60% solution is rec-ommended. Do not use more than 70%solution for better coolant performance.

NOTICE

Do not use alcohol type antifreeze orplain water alone.

The engine cooling system is integral tomaximizing performance of your Toyotavehicle. In line with this, it is stronglyrecommended that you use “ToyotaGenuine Long Life Coolant” for protectingthe system, as it is an ethylene−glycolbased premium antifreeze coolant withexcellent corrosion protection propertiesthat has been specifically formulated foruse in Toyota vehicles.

Please contact your Toyota dealer for fur-ther details of the “Toyota Genuine LongLife Coolant” range.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

280 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If any of the above parts are extremelydirty or you are not sure of their condi-tion, take your vehicle to Toyota dealer.

CAUTION

To prevent yourself from burning, becareful not to touch the radiator orcondenser when the engine is hot.

NOTICE

To prevent damage to the radiatorand condenser, do not perform thework by yourself.

To check the fluid level, simply look atthe see−through reservoir. The levelshould be between the “MAX” and“MIN” lines on the reservoir.

It is normal for the brake fluid level to godown slightly as the brake pads wear. Sobe sure to keep the reservoir filled.

If the reservoir needs frequent refilling, itmay indicate a serious mechanical prob-lem.

If the level is low, add SAE J1703 orFMVSS No.116 DOT 3 brake fluid to thebrake reservoir.

Remove and replace the reservoir cap byhand. Fill the brake fluid to the dottedline. This brings the fluid to the correctlevel when you put the cap back on.

Use only newly opened brake fluid. Onceopened, brake fluid absorbs moisture fromthe air, and excess moisture can cause adangerous loss of braking.

CAUTION

Take care when filling the reservoirbecause brake fluid can harm youreyes and damage painted surfaces. Iffluid gets in your eyes, flush youreyes with clean water immediately. Ifyou still feel uncomfortable with youreyes, go to the doctor.

NOTICE

If you spill the fluid, be sure to washit off with water to prevent it fromdamaging the parts or paint.

Checking the radiator andcondenser Checking brake fluid

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2812003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If hotO.K. Close Open

If coldO.K.

If coldadd

If hotadd

Check the fluid level through the reser-voir. If necessary, add automatic trans-mission fluid DEXRON�II or III.

If the vehicle has been driven around 80km/h (50 mph) for 20 minutes (a littlemore in frigid temperatures), the fluid ishot (60�C—80�C or 140�F—175�F). Youmay also check the level when the fluidis cold (about room temperature,10�C—30�C or 50�F—85�F) if the enginehas not been run for about five hours.

Clean all dirt from outside of the reservoirtank and look at the fluid level. If the fluidis cold, the level should be in the “COLD”range. Similarly, if it is hot, the fluid levelshould be in the “HOT” range. If the levelis at the low side of either range, addautomatic transmission fluid DEXRON�II orIII to bring the level within the range.

To remove the reservoir cap, turn it coun-terclockwise and lift up. To reinstall it,turn it clockwise. After replacing the reser-voir cap, visually check the steering boxcase, vane pump and hose connectionsfor leaks or damage.

CAUTION

The reservoir tank may be hot so becareful not to burn yourself.

NOTICE

Avoid overfilling, or the power steer-ing could be damaged.

Keep your tire pressures at the properlevel.

The recommended cold tire pressures, tiresize and the vehicle capacity weight aregiven in Section 8. They are also on thetire pressure label as shown.

You should check the tire pressures everytwo weeks, or at least once a month. Anddo not forget the spare!

Incorrect tire pressure may waste fuel,reduce the comfort of driving, reduce tirelife and make your vehicle less safe todrive.

Checking power steering fluid Checking tire pressure

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

282 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If a tire frequently needs refilling, have itchecked by your Toyota dealer.

CAUTION

Keep your tire pressure properly.Otherwise, the following conditionsmay occur and cause an accident re-sulting in death or serious injuries.

Low tire pressure (underinflation)—

� Excessive wear

� Uneven wear

� Poor handling

� Possibility of blowouts from over-heated tire

� Poor sealing of the tire bead

� Wheel deformation and/or tire sepa-ration

High tire pressure (overinflation)—

� Poor handling

� Excessive wear at the center of thetire tread

� A greater possibility of tire damagefrom road hazards

The following instructions for checkingtire pressure should be observed:

� The pressure should be checked onlywhen the tires are cold. If your ve-hicle has been parked for at least 3hours and has not been driven formore than 1.5 km or 1 mile since, youwill get an accurate cold tire pressurereading.

� Always use a tire pressure gauge.The appearance of a tire can be mis-leading. Besides, tire pressures thatare even just a few pounds off candegrade ride and handling.

� Do not bleed or reduce tire pressureafter driving. It is normal for the tirepressure to be higher after driving.

� Never exceed the vehicle capacityweight. The passenger and luggageweight should be located so that thevehicle is balanced.

� Be sure to reinstall the tire inflationvalve caps. Without the valve caps,dirt or moisture could get into the valvecore and cause air leakage. If the capshave been lost, have new ones put onas soon as possible.

Tread wear indicator

CHECKING YOUR TIRES

Check the tire tread for the tread wearindicators. If the indicators show, re-place the tires.

The tires on your Toyota have built−intread wear indicators to help you knowwhen the tires need replacement. Whenthe tread depth wears to 1.6 mm (0.06in.) or less, the indicators will appear. Ifyou can see the indicators in two or moreadjacent grooves, the tire should be re-placed. The lower the tread, the higherthe risk of skidding.

The effectiveness of snow tires is lostif the tread wears down below 4 mm(0.16 in.).

Checking and replacing tires

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2832003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Check the tires regularly for damagesuch as cuts, splits and cracks. If anydamage is found, consult with a techni-cian and have the tire repaired or re-placed.

Even if the damage does not appear seri-ous, a qualified technician should examinethe damage. Objects which have pene-trated the tire may have caused internaldamage.

Any tires which are over 6 years oldmust be checked by a qualified techni-cian even if damage is not obvious.

Tires deteriorate with age even if theyhave never or seldom been used.

This also applies to the spare tire andtires stored for future use.

REPLACING YOUR TIRES

When replacing a tire, use only thesame size and construction as original-ly installed and with the same or great-er load capacity.

Using any other size or type of tire mayseriously affect handling, ride, speedome-ter/odometer calibration, ground clearance,and clearance between the body and tiresor snow chains.

CAUTION

Observe the following instructions.Otherwise, an accident may occur re-sulting in death or serious injuries.

� Do not mix radial, bias belted, orbias−ply tires on your vehicle, asthis may cause dangerous handlingcharacteristics resulting in loss ofcontrol.

� Do not use tires other than themanufacturer’s recommended size,as this may cause dangerous han-dling characteristics resulting inloss of control.

Toyota recommends all four tires, or atleast both front or rear tires be re-placed as a set.

See “If you have a flat tire” in Section 4for tire change procedure.

When a tire is replaced, the wheelshould always be balanced.

An unbalanced wheel may affect vehiclehandling and tire life. Wheels can get outof balance with regular use and shouldtherefore be balanced occasionally.

When replacing a tubeless tire, the airvalve should also be replaced with anew one.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

284 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

With a spare tire of the same wheel typeas the installed tires

With a spare tire of different wheel typefrom the installed tires

To equalize the wear and help extendtire life, Toyota recommends that yourotate your tires according to the main-tenance schedule. (For scheduled main-tenance information, please refer to the“Scheduled Maintenance Guide” or“Owner’s Manual Supplement”.) Howev-er, the most appropriate timing for tirerotation may vary according to yourdriving habits and road surface condi-tions.

See “If you have a flat tire” in Section 4for tire change procedure.

When rotating tires, check for unevenwear and damage. Abnormal wear is usu-ally caused by incorrect tire pressure, im-proper wheel alignment, out−of−balancewheels, or severe braking.

WHEN TO USE SNOW TIRES ORCHAINS

Snow tires or chains are recommendedwhen driving on snow or ice.

On wet or dry roads, conventional tiresprovide better traction than snow tires.

SNOW TIRE SELECTION

If you need snow tires, select the samesize, construction and load capacity asthe original tires on your Toyota.

Do not use tires other than those men-tioned above. Do not install studded tireswithout first checking local regulations forpossible restrictions.

CAUTION

Do not use snow tires other than themanufacturer’s recommended size, asthis may cause dangerous handlingcharacteristics resulting in loss ofcontrol. Otherwise, an accident mayoccur resulting in death or seriousinjuries.

Rotating tiresInstalling snow tires andchains

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2852003 AVALON (OM41401U)

SNOW TIRE INSTALLATION

Snow tires should be installed on allwheels.

Installing snow tires on the front wheelsonly can lead to an excessive differencein road grip capability between the frontand rear tires which could cause loss ofvehicle control.

When storing removed tires, you shouldstore them in a cool dry place.

Mark the direction of rotation and be sureto install them in the same direction whenreplacing.

CAUTION

� Do not drive with the snow tiresincorrectly inflated.

� Never drive over 120 km/h (75 mph)with any type of snow tires.

TIRE CHAIN SELECTION

P205/65R15 92H tires—Use the tirechains of correct size and type.

Use SAE Class “S” type radial tire chainsexcept radial cable chains or V−bar typechains.

P205/60R16 91H tires—Use tire chainsof the correct size.

Use only genuine Toyota tire chains or equiv-alent for use on the AVALON.

NOTICE

If the wrong combination of tire andchain is used, the chains could dam-age the vehicle body.

� AVALON genuine tire chains (Part No. 08329−33801)

Laws about using tire chains vary ac-cording to locality and type of road, soalways check your local laws beforeyou install tire chains.

CHAIN INSTALLATION

Install the chains on the front tires astightly as possible. Do not use tirechains on the rear tires. Retightenchains after driving 0.5—1.0 km(1/4—1/2 mile).

When installing chains on your tires, care-fully follow the instructions of the chainmanufacturer.

If wheel covers are used, they will bescratched by the chain band, so removethe covers before putting on the chains.

CAUTION

� Do not exceed 50 km/h (30 mph) orthe chain manufacturer’s recom-mended speed limit, whichever islower.

� Drive carefully avoiding bumps,holes, and sharp turns, which maycause the vehicle to bounce.

� Avoid sharp turns or locked−wheelbraking, as use of chains may ad-versely affect vehicle handling.

� When driving with chains installed,be sure to drive carefully. Slowdown before entering the curves toavoid losing control of the vehicle.Otherwise an accident may occur.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

286 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

WHEN TO REPLACE YOUR WHEELS

If you have wheel damage such asbending, cracks or heavy corrosion, thewheel should be replaced.

If you fail to replace damaged wheels, thetire may slip off the wheel or cause lossof handling control.

WHEEL SELECTION

When replacing wheels, care should betaken to ensure that the wheels are re-placed by ones with the same load ca-pacity, diameter, rim width, and offset.

Correct replacement wheels are availableat your Toyota dealer.

A wheel of a different size or type mayadversely affect handling, wheel and bear-ing life, brake cooling, speedometer/odom-eter calibration, stopping ability, headlightaim, bumper height, vehicle ground clear-ance, and tire or snow chain clearance tothe body and chassis.

Replacement with used wheels is not rec-ommended as they may have been sub-jected to rough treatment or high mileageand could fail without warning. Also, bentwheels which have been straightened mayhave structural damage and thereforeshould not be used. Never use an innertube in a leaking wheel which is designedfor a tubeless tire.

CAUTION

Do not use wheels other than themanufacturer’s recommended size, asthis may cause dangerous handlingcharacteristics resulting in loss ofcontrol. Otherwise, an accident mayoccur resulting in death or seriousinjuries.

� When installing aluminum wheels,check that the wheel nuts are tightafter driving your vehicle the first 1600km (1000 miles).

� If you have rotated, repaired, orchanged your tires, check that thewheel nuts are still tight after driving1600 km (1000 miles).

� When using tire chains, be careful notto damage the aluminum wheels.

� Use only the Toyota wheel nuts andwrench designed for your aluminumwheels.

� When balancing your wheels, use onlyToyota balance weights or equivalentand a plastic or rubber hammer.

� As with any wheel, periodically checkyour aluminum wheels for damage. Ifdamaged, replace immediately.

Replacing wheels Aluminum wheel precautions

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2872003 AVALON (OM41401U)

DO−IT−YOURSELF MAINTENANCEElectrical componentsChecking battery condition 288. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Battery recharging precautions 289. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking and replacing fuses 290. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adding washer fluid 291. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacing light bulbs 291. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 7− 3

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

288 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

CAUTION

BATTERY PRECAUTIONS

The battery produces flammable andexplosive hydrogen gas.

� Do not cause a spark from the bat-tery with tools.

� Do not smoke or light a match nearthe battery.

The electrolyte contains poisonousand corrosive sulfuric acid.

� Avoid contact with eyes, skin orclothes.

� Never ingest electrolyte.

� Wear protective safety glasses whenworking near the battery.

� Keep children away from the bat-tery.

EMERGENCY MEASURES

� If electrolyte gets in your eyes,flush your eyes with clean waterimmediately and get immediatemedical attention. If possible, con-tinue to apply water with a spongeor cloth while en route to the medi-cal office.

� If electrolyte gets on your skin,thoroughly wash the contact area. Ifyou feel pain or burning, get medi-cal attention immediately.

� If electrolyte gets on your clothes,there is a possibility of its soakingthrough to your skin, so immediate-ly take off the exposed clothing andfollow the procedure above, if nec-essary.

� If you accidentally swallow electro-lyte, drink a large quantity of wateror milk. Follow with milk of magne-sia, beaten raw egg or vegetableoil. Then go immediately for emer-gency help.

� Warning: Battery posts, terminalsand related accessories contain leadand lead compounds, chemicalsknown to the State of California tocause cancer and reproductiveharm. Wash hands after handling.

TerminalsGround cable

Hold−downclamp

Check the battery for corroded or looseterminal connections, cracks, or loosehold−down clamp.

a. If the battery is corroded, wash it offwith a solution of warm water and bak-ing soda. Coat the outside of the termi-nals with grease to prevent further cor-rosion.

b. If the terminal connections are loose,tighten their clamp nuts—but do notovertighten.

c. Tighten the hold−down clamp onlyenough to keep the battery firmly inplace. Overtightening may damage thebattery case.

Checking battery condition——Precautions —Checking battery exterior

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2892003 AVALON (OM41401U)

NOTICE

� Be sure the engine and all accesso-ries are off before performing main-tenance.

� When checking the battery, removethe ground cable from the negativeterminal (“−” mark) first and rein-stall it last.

� Be careful not to cause a short cir-cuit with tools.

� Take care no solution gets into thebattery when washing it.

Type A

Green DarkClear or light yellow

Type B

Blue White Red

CHECKING BY INDICATOR

Check the battery condition by the indi-cator color.

Indicator colorCondition

Type A Type B

Green Blue Good

Dark White

Charging necessary.Have battery checked by your Toyota dealer.

Clear orlight

yellowRed

Have battery checked by your Toyota dealer.

During recharging, the battery is pro-ducing hydrogen gas.

Therefore, before recharging:

1. If recharging with the battery installedon the vehicle, be sure to disconnectthe ground cable.

2. Be sure the power switch on the re-charger is off when connecting thecharger cables to the battery and whendisconnecting them.

CAUTION

� Always charge the battery in an un-confined area. Do not charge thebattery in a garage or closed roomwhere there is not sufficient ventila-tion.

� Only do a slow charge (5 A orless). Charging at a quicker rate isdangerous. The battery may ex-plode, causing personal injuries.

NOTICE

Never recharge the battery while theengine is running. Also, be sure allaccessories are turned off.

—Checking battery condition Battery recharging precautions

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

290 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Type A

Good Blown

Type B

Good

Good

Blown

Blown

Type C

If the headlights or other electricalcomponents do not work, check thefuses. If any of the fuses are blown,they must be replaced.

See “Fuse locations” in Section 7−1 forlocations of the fuses.

Turn the ignition switch and inoperativecomponent off. Pull a suspected fusestraight out and check it.

Determine which fuse may be causing theproblem. The lid of the fuse box showsthe name of the circuit for each fuse. SeeSection 8 of this manual for the functionscontrolled by each circuit.

Type A fuses can be pulled out by thepull−out tool. The location of the pull−outtool is shown in the illustration.

If you are not sure whether the fuse hasblown, try replacing the suspected fusewith one that you know is good.

If the fuse has blown, push a new fuseinto the clip.

Only install a fuse with the amperage rat-ing designated on the fuse box lid.

If you do not have a spare fuse, in anemergency you can pull out the “RADIO”or “A/C” fuse, which may be dispensablefor normal driving, and use it if itsamperage rating is the same.

If you cannot use one of the same amper-age, use one that is lower, but as closeas possible to the rating. If the amperageis lower than that specified, the fusemight blow out again but this does notindicate anything wrong. Be sure to getthe correct fuse as soon as possible andreturn the substitute to its original clip.

It is a good idea to purchase a set ofspare fuses and keep them in your ve-hicle for emergencies.

Checking and replacing fuses

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2912003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If the new fuse immediately blows out,there is a problem with the electrical sys-tem. Have your Toyota dealer correct it assoon as possible.

CAUTION

Never use a fuse with a higher am-perage rating, or any other object, inplace of a fuse. This may cause ex-tensive damage and possibly a fire.

If any washer does not work or lowwindshield washer fluid level warninglight comes on, the washer tank may beempty. Add washer fluid.

You may use plain water as washer fluid.However, in cold areas where tempera-tures range below freezing point, usewasher fluid containing antifreeze. Thisproduct is available at your Toyota dealerand most auto parts stores. Follow themanufacturer’s directions for how much tomix with water.

NOTICE

Do not use engine antifreeze or anyother substitute because it may dam-age your vehicle’s paint.

The following illustrations show how togain access to the bulbs. When replacinga bulb, make sure the ignition switch andlight switch are off. Use bulbs with thewattage ratings given in the table.

CAUTION

� To prevent yourself from burning,do not replace the light bulbs whilethey are hot.

� Halogen bulbs have pressurized gasinside and require special handling.They can burst or shatter ifscratched or dropped. Hold a bulbonly by its plastic or metal case.Do not touch the glass part of abulb with bare hands.

NOTICE

Only use a bulb of the listed type.

Adding washer fluid Replacing light bulbs—

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

292 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

The inside of the lens of exterior lightssuch as headlights may temporarily fog upwhen the lens becomes wet in the rain orin a car wash. This is not a problembecause the fogging is caused by thetemperature difference between the outsideand inside of the lens, just like thewindshield fogged up in the rain. However,if there is a large drop of water on theinside of the lens, or if there is waterpooled inside the light, contact yourToyota dealer.

Light bulbs BulbNo.

W Type

Headlights (low beam)

9006 51 A

Headlights(high beam)

9005 60 B

Front fog lights 9006 51 A

Front turnsignal/parkinglights

1157NA 27/8 C

Rear turn signallights

— 21 D

Stop/tail lights 7443 21/5 E

Rear sidemarker lights

194 3.8 E

Back−up lights 921 18 E

Tail lights 168 5 E

License platelights

168 5 E

High mountedstoplight

921 18 E

Interior light — 7 F

Front personallights

— 7 F

Light bulbs BulbNo. W Type

Rear personallights

— 5 F

Vanity lights — 2 F

Glove box light — 1.2 E

Door courtesylights

— 6 F

Trunk light — 3 F

A: HB4 halogen bulbsB: HB3 halogen bulbsC: Single end bulbsD: Wedge base bulbs (amber)E: Wedge base bulbs (clear)F: Double end bulbs

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2932003 AVALON (OM41401U)

1. Unplug the connector while depress-ing the lock release.

If the connector is tight, wiggle it.

2. Turn the bulb and remove it. 3. Install a new bulb and the connectorinto the mounting hole.

Aiming is not necessary after replacingthe bulb. When aiming adjustment is nec-essary, contact your Toyota dealer.

—Headlights

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

294 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If either the left or right front fog orfront turn signal/parking lights burnsout, contact your Toyota dealer.

NOTICE

Do not try to replace the front fog orfront turn signal/parking light bulbsby yourself. You may damage the ve-hicle.

Use a flat−bladed screwdriver which iswrapped with a cloth.

a: Rear turn signal lightb: Stop/tail lightc: Rear side marker lightd: Back−up light

—Front fog and front turnsignal/parking lights

—Rear turn signal, stop/tail,rear side marker and back−uplights

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2952003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Remove and install the cover clips asshown in the following illustrations.

Removing cover clips

Installing cover clips

—Tail lights

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

296 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Remove and install the cover clips asshown in the following illustrations.

Removing cover clips

Installing cover clips

—License plate lights

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2972003 AVALON (OM41401U)

—High mounted stoplight(type A)

—High mounted stoplight(type B)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

298 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2992003 AVALON (OM41401U)

SPECIFICATIONSDimensions and weight 300. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Engine 300. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Fuel 301. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Service specifications 301. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Tires 303. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Fuses 304. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 8

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

300 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Model:1MZ−FE

Type:6 cylinder V type 4 cycle, gasoline

Bore and stroke, mm (in.):87.5 � 83.0 (3.44 � 3.27)

Displacement, cm3 (cu. in.):2995 (182.8)

Overall length mm (in.) 4865 (191.5)

Overall width mm (in.) 1820 (71.7)

Overall height mm (in.) 1465 (57.7)∗1

Wheelbase mm (in.) 2720 (107.0)

Front tread mm (in.) 1550 (61.0)

Rear tread mm (in.) 1525 (60.0)

∗1: Unladen vehicle∗2: With floor shift type automatic transmission∗3: With column shift type automatic transmission

Vehicle capacity weight (occupants � luggage) kg (lb.)

410 (900)∗2

475 (1050)∗3

Dimensions and weight Engine

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

3012003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Fuel type:Unleaded gasoline, Octane Rating 87(Research Octane Number 91) or higher.For improved vehicle performance, theuse of premium unleaded gasoline withan Octane Rating of 91 (Research Oc-tane Number 96) or higher is recom-mended.

Fuel tank capacity, L (gal., Imp. gal.):70 (18.5, 15.4)

ENGINE

Valve clearance (engine cold), mm (in.):Intake 0.15—0.25 (0.006—0.010)Exhaust 0.25—0.35 (0.010—0.014)

Spark plug type:DENSO SK20R11NGK IFR6A11

Spark plug gap, mm (in.):1.1 (0.043)

Drive belt tension measured withBorroughs drive belt tension gauge No.BT−33−73F (used belt), Ibf:

Generator belt 88�22Power steering pump belt 115�20

ENGINE LUBRICATION

Oil capacity (drain and refill), L (qt., Imp.qt.):

With filter 4.7 (5.0, 4.1)Without filter 4.5 (4.8, 4.0)

“Toyota Genuine Motor Oil” is filled inyour Toyota vehicle. Use Toyota approved“Toyota Genuine Motor Oil” or equivalentto satisfy the following grade andviscosity.

Oil grade:API grade SL “Energy−Conserving” orILSAC multigrade engine oil.

Recommended oil viscosity:SAE 5W−30

Outside temperature

Please contact your Toyota dealer for fur-ther details.

Fuel Service specifications

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

302 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

COOLING SYSTEM

Total capacity, L (qt., Imp. qt.):9.0 (9.5, 7.9)

Coolant type:

“Toyota Genuine Long Life Coolant” isfilled in your Toyota vehicle. In order toavoid technical problems, we stronglyrecommend using “Toyota Genuine LongLife Coolant” or equivalent.

With ethylene−glycol type coolant for aproper corrosion protection of aluminumcomponents

Do not use alcohol type antifreeze orplain water alone.

Please contact your Toyota dealer forfurther details.

BATTERY

Open voltage∗ at 20�C (68�F):12.6—12.8 V Fully charged12.2—12.4 V Half charged11.8—12.0 V Discharged

∗: Voltage that is checked 20 minutesafter the key is removed with all thelights turned off

Charging rates:5 A max.

AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE

Fluid capacity (drain and refill), L (qt.,Imp. qt.):

Up to 4.75 (5.0, 4.2)

Fluid type:Toyota Genuine ATF D−II orDEXRON�III (DEXRON�II)

Please contact your Toyota dealer for fur-ther details.

BRAKES

Minimum pedal clearance when depressedwith the force of 490 N (50 kgf, 110 lbf)with the engine running, mm (in.):

75 (3.0)

Pedal free play, mm (in.):1—6 (0.04—0.24)

Pad wear limit, mm (in.):1.0 (0.04)

Lining wear limit, mm (in.):1.0 (0.04)

Parking brake adjustment when depressedwith the force of 294 N (30 kgf, 66.1 lbf):

3—6 clicks

Fluid type:SAE J1703 or FMVSS No.116 DOT 3

STEERING

Wheel free play:Less than 30 mm (1.2 in.)

Power steering fluid type:Automatic transmission fluid DEXRON�IIor III

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

3032003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Tire size and pressure:Normal driving kPa (kgf/cm2 or bar, psi)

Tire sizeTire pressure

Wheel sizeFront Rear

P205/65R15 92H 210 (2.1, 31) 210 (2.1, 31) 15 � 6JJ

P205/60R16 91H 220 (2.2, 32) 220 (2.2, 32) 16 � 6JJ

Trailer driving kPa (kgf/cm2 or bar, psi)

Tire sizeTire pressure

Front Rear

P205/65R15 92H 220 (2.2, 32) 220 (2.2, 32)

P205/60R16 91H 240 (2.4, 35) 240 (2.4, 35)

When driving under the above vehicle load conditions at sustained high speeds above 160 km/h (100 mph), in countries where suchspeeds are permitted by−law, inflate the front and rear tires to 280 kPa (2.8 kgf/cm2 or bar, 41 psi) provided that it does not exceedthe maximum cold tire pressure molded on the tire sidewall.

Wheel nut torque, N·m (kgf·m, ft·Ibf):103 (10.5, 76)

NOTE: For a complete information on tires (e.g. replacing tires or replacing wheels), see “Checking tire pressure” through “Aluminumwheel precautions” in Section 7−2.

Tires

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

304 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Engine compartment

Engine compartment

Fuses (type A)

1. HEAD RH UPR 10 A: No circuit

2. HEAD LH UPR 10 A: No circuit

3. HEAD RH LWR 15 A: Right−handheadlight (low beam)

4. HEAD LH LWR 15 A: Left−hand head-light (low beam)

5. ABS NO.4 5 A: Vehicle skid controlsystem

6. DRL 7.5 A: Daytime running light sys-tem

7. SPARE 30 A: Spare fuse

8. SPARE 15 A: Spare fuse

Instrument panel

9. SPARE 25 A: Spare fuse

10. SPARE 10 A: Spare fuse

11. ALT−S 5 A: Charging system

12. DCC 30 A: “DOME”, “ECU−B” and“RADIO” fuses

13. SECURITY 10 A: Theft−deterrent sys-tem

14. HAZ 15 A: Turn signal lights

15. A/F 25 A: Air/fuel sensor

16. DOOR NO.2 15 A: Power door locksystem

17. HORN 10 A: Horn, theft−deterrent sys-tem

Fuses

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

3052003 AVALON (OM41401U)

18. AM2 10 A: SRS airbag system, multi-port fuel injection system/sequentialmultiport fuel injection system, startersystem, charging system, air/fuel sen-sor, fuel pump

19. EFI NO.2 7.5 A: Multiport fuel injectionsystem/sequential multiport fuel injec-tion system, air flow meter, oxygensensor, evaporative emission controlsystem, throttle positioner control sys-tem, engine control system

20. ABS NO.3 25 A: Anti−lock brake sys-tem

21. ABS NO.2 25 A: Vehicle skid controlsystem

22. EFI NO.1 15 A: Multiport fuel injectionsystem/sequential multiport fuel injec-tion system, fuel pump

23. IG2 15 A: Multiport fuel injection sys-tem/sequential multiport fuel injectionsystem

24. HEAD LH UPR 10 A: Left−hand head-light (high beam), high beam indicatorlight

25. HEAD RH UPR 10 A: Right−handheadlight (high beam)

26. ECU−IG NO.1 5 A: Electric coolingfans

27. ECU−B 7.5 A: Air conditioning system,theft deterrent system, power seats,meters, power windows (for driver andfront passenger), multiplex communica-tion system

28. TAIL 10 A: Parking lights, license platelights, tail lights, rear side markerlights, rear light failure warning light,engine control system

29. SEAT HTR 20 A: Seat heaters

30. FR P/W 20 A: Power window (for frontpassenger)

31. GAUGE NO.1 10 A: Vehicle skid con-trol system, rear window defogger,cruise control system, shift lock sys-tem, anti−lock brake system, auto anti−glare inside rear view mirror, automaticlight control system, power seats, rearlight failure warning light, automatictransmission indicator lights, power out-let, power window (for driver), brakesystem warning light, electric moonroof

32. HTR 10 A: Air conditioning system

33. FOG 15 A: Front fog lights

34. TURN 7.5 A: Turn signal lights

35. A/C 10 A: Air conditioning system

36. RADIO 15 A: Audio system, multi−in-formation display

37. PANEL 5 A: Gauges and meters, audiosystem, cigarette lighter, air condition-ing system, emergency flasher, elec-tronically controlled automatic transmis-sion system, power rear view mirrors,multi−information display, glove boxlight, instrument panel lights, instrumentpanel light control, power outlet

38. FL P/W 25 A: Power window (for driv-er)

39. PWR OUTLET NO.1 15 A: Power out-let (ACC)

40. ECU−ACC 5 A: Audio system, powerrear view mirrors, multi−information dis-play, shift lock system, multiplex com-munication system

41. SRS−ACC 10 A: SRS airbag system

42. MIR HTR 10 A: Outside rear view mir-ror defoggers, engine control system

43. PWR OUTLET NO.2 15 A: Power out-let (IG)

44. GAUGE NO.2 10 A: Back−up lights

45. OBD−II 7.5 A: On−board diagnosis sys-tem

46. STOP 15 A: Stop lights, high mountedstoplight, anti−lock brake system, shiftlock system, cruise control system, ve-hicle skid control system, engine con-trol system

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

306 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

47. DOME 7.5 A: Interior lights, front per-sonal lights, door courtesy lights, igni-tion switch light, vanity lights, garagedoor opener, open door warning light,illuminated entry system, rear personallights, automatic light control system,trunk light, wireless remote control sys-tem, multiplex communication system

48. OPNER 5 A: No circuit

49. RL P/W 20 A: Power window (for rearleft passenger)

50. RR P/W 20 A: Power window (for rearright passenger)

51. WIP 25 A: Windshield wipers andwasher

52. ECU−IG NO.2 10 A: Anti−lock brakesystem, cruise control system, multi−in-formation display, theft deterrent sys-tem, vehicle skid control system, me-ters, multiplex communication system

53. CIG 15 A: Cigarette lighter

54. DOOR NO.1 25 A: Theft deterrent sys-tem, trunk opener, multiplex commu-nication system

55. SUN ROOF 30 A: Electric moon roof

Fuses (type B)

56. AM1 40 A: Multiport fuel injection sys-tem/sequential multiport fuel injectionsystem

57. HTR 50 A: Air conditioning system

58. CDS 30 A: Electric cooling fans

59. RDI 30 A: Electric cooling fans

60. MAIN 40 A: Starter system

61. DEF 40 A: Rear window defogger,noise filter

62. PWR SEAT 30 A: Power seats

Fuses (type C)

63. ABS 60 A: Anti−lock brake system,“ABS NO.4” fuse

64. ALT 120 A: “HTR”, “A/C”, “ABS NO.2”,“ABS NO.3”, “RDI”, “CDS”, “AM1”,“ABS” and “ABS NO.4” fuses

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

3072003 AVALON (OM41401U)

REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS FOR U.S.OWNERS AND UNIFORM TIRE QUALITYGRADINGReporting safety defects for U.S. owners 308. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Uniform tire quality grading 308. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

SECTION 9

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

308 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

If you believe that your vehiclehas a defect which could cause acrash or could cause injury ordeath, you should immediately in-form the National Highway TrafficSafety Administration (NHTSA) inaddition to notifying Toyota MotorSales, U.S.A., Inc. (Toll−free: 1−800−331−4331).

If NHTSA receives similar com-plaints, it may open an investiga-tion, and if it finds that a safetydefect exists in a group of ve-hicles, it may order a recall andremedy campaign. However,NHTSA cannot become involvedin individual problems betweenyou, your dealer, or Toyota MotorSales, U.S.A., Inc.

To contact NHTSA, you may ei-ther call the Auto Safety Hotlinetoll−free at 1−800−424−9393 (or366−0123 in Washington, D.C.area) or write to: NHTSA, U.S.Department of Transportation,Washington, D.C. 20590. You canalso obtain other information aboutmotor vehicle safety from the Hot-line.

This information has been prepared in ac-cordance with regulations issued by theNational Highway Traffic Safety Adminis-tration of the U.S. Department of Trans-portation. It provides the purchasers and/or prospective purchasers of Toyotavehicles with information on uniform tirequality grading.

Your Toyota dealer will help answer anyquestions you may have as you read thisinformation.

DOT quality grades—All passenger cartires must conform to Federal SafetyRequirements in addition to thesegrades. Quality grades can be foundwhere applicable on the tire sidewallbetween tread shoulder and maximumsection width. For example: Treadwear200 Traction AA Temperature A

Reporting safety defects forU.S. owners Uniform tire quality grading

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

3092003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Treadwear—The treadwear grade is acomparative rating based on the wear rateof the tire when tested under controlledconditions on a specified government testcourse. For example, a tire graded 150would wear one and a half (1−1/2) timesas well on the government course as atire graded 100. The relative performanceof tires depends upon the actual condi-tions of their use, however, and may de-part significantly from the norm due tovariations in driving habits, service prac-tices and differences in road characteris-tics and climate.

Traction AA, A, B, C—The tractiongrades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A,B, and C, and they represent the tire’sability to stop on wet pavement as mea-sured under controlled conditions on spe-cified government test surfaces of asphaltand concrete. A tire marked C may havepoor traction performance.

Warning: The traction grade assigned tothis tire is based on braking (straightahead) traction tests and does not includecornering (turning) traction.

Temperature A, B, C—The temperaturegrades are A (the highest), B, and C,representing the tire’s resistance to thegeneration of heat and its ability to dissi-pate heat when tested under controlledconditions on a specified indoor laboratorytest wheel. Sustained high temperaturecan cause the material of the tire to de-generate and reduce tire life, and exces-sive temperature can lead to sudden tirefailure. The grade C corresponds to a lev-el of performance which all passenger cartires must meet under the Federal MotorVehicle Safety Standard No.109. Grades Band A represent higher levels of perfor-mance on the laboratory test wheel thanthe minimum required by law.

Warning: The temperature grades for thistire are established for a tire that is prop-erly inflated and not overloaded. Exces-sive speed, underinflation, or excessiveloading, either separately or in combina-tion, can cause heat buildup and possibletire failure.

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

310 2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

’03 AVALON U (L/O 0206)

2003 AVALON (OM41401U)

Publication No. OM41401UPart No. 01999-41401Printed in Japan 01−0206−00

( U)

Quick index

� If a service reminder indicator or warning buzzer comes on 116. . . . . . . .

� If your vehicle will not start 236. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� If your engine stalls while driving 239. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� If your vehicle overheats 239. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� If you have a flat tire 240. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� If your vehicle needs to be towed 249. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Tips for driving during break−in period 210. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� How to start the engine 224. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� General maintenance 263. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Gas station information

Fuel type:

UNLEADED gasoline, Octane Rating 87 (Research Octane Number 91) orhigher. For improved vehicle performance, the use of premium unleadedgasoline with an Octane Rating of 91 (Research Octane Number 96) orhigher is recommended.

See page 210 for detailed information.

Fuel tank capacity: 70 L (18.5 gal., 15.4 lmp. gal.)

Engine oil: API grade SL “Energy−Conserving” or ILSAC multigrade engine oil is recom-mended.

See page 277 for detailed information.

Automatic transmission fluid:Toyota Genuine ATF D−II or DEXRON�III (DEXRON�II)

Tire information: See pages 281 through 286.

Tire pressure: See page 303.

aU−7

B


Recommended